1 @c Copyright (C) 1988, 1989, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999,
2 @c 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
3 @c This is part of the GCC manual.
4 @c For copying conditions, see the file gcc.texi.
8 Copyright @copyright{} 1988, 1989, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1997,
9 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
11 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
12 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
13 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
14 Invariant Sections being ``GNU General Public License'' and ``Funding
15 Free Software'', the Front-Cover texts being (a) (see below), and with
16 the Back-Cover Texts being (b) (see below). A copy of the license is
17 included in the gfdl(7) man page.
19 (a) The FSF's Front-Cover Text is:
23 (b) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is:
25 You have freedom to copy and modify this GNU Manual, like GNU
26 software. Copies published by the Free Software Foundation raise
27 funds for GNU development.
29 @c Set file name and title for the man page.
31 @settitle GNU project C and C++ compiler
33 gcc [@option{-c}|@option{-S}|@option{-E}] [@option{-std=}@var{standard}]
34 [@option{-g}] [@option{-pg}] [@option{-O}@var{level}]
35 [@option{-W}@var{warn}@dots{}] [@option{-pedantic}]
36 [@option{-I}@var{dir}@dots{}] [@option{-L}@var{dir}@dots{}]
37 [@option{-D}@var{macro}[=@var{defn}]@dots{}] [@option{-U}@var{macro}]
38 [@option{-f}@var{option}@dots{}] [@option{-m}@var{machine-option}@dots{}]
39 [@option{-o} @var{outfile}] @var{infile}@dots{}
41 Only the most useful options are listed here; see below for the
42 remainder. @samp{g++} accepts mostly the same options as @samp{gcc}.
45 gpl(7), gfdl(7), fsf-funding(7),
46 cpp(1), gcov(1), g77(1), as(1), ld(1), gdb(1), adb(1), dbx(1), sdb(1)
47 and the Info entries for @file{gcc}, @file{cpp}, @file{g77}, @file{as},
48 @file{ld}, @file{binutils} and @file{gdb}.
51 For instructions on reporting bugs, see
52 @w{@uref{http://gcc.gnu.org/bugs.html}}. Use of the @command{gccbug}
53 script to report bugs is recommended.
56 See the Info entry for @command{gcc}, or
57 @w{@uref{http://gcc.gnu.org/onlinedocs/gcc/Contributors.html}},
58 for contributors to GCC@.
63 @chapter GCC Command Options
64 @cindex GCC command options
65 @cindex command options
66 @cindex options, GCC command
68 @c man begin DESCRIPTION
70 When you invoke GCC, it normally does preprocessing, compilation,
71 assembly and linking. The ``overall options'' allow you to stop this
72 process at an intermediate stage. For example, the @option{-c} option
73 says not to run the linker. Then the output consists of object files
74 output by the assembler.
76 Other options are passed on to one stage of processing. Some options
77 control the preprocessor and others the compiler itself. Yet other
78 options control the assembler and linker; most of these are not
79 documented here, since you rarely need to use any of them.
81 @cindex C compilation options
82 Most of the command line options that you can use with GCC are useful
83 for C programs; when an option is only useful with another language
84 (usually C++), the explanation says so explicitly. If the description
85 for a particular option does not mention a source language, you can use
86 that option with all supported languages.
88 @cindex C++ compilation options
89 @xref{Invoking G++,,Compiling C++ Programs}, for a summary of special
90 options for compiling C++ programs.
92 @cindex grouping options
93 @cindex options, grouping
94 The @command{gcc} program accepts options and file names as operands. Many
95 options have multi-letter names; therefore multiple single-letter options
96 may @emph{not} be grouped: @option{-dr} is very different from @w{@samp{-d
99 @cindex order of options
100 @cindex options, order
101 You can mix options and other arguments. For the most part, the order
102 you use doesn't matter. Order does matter when you use several options
103 of the same kind; for example, if you specify @option{-L} more than once,
104 the directories are searched in the order specified.
106 Many options have long names starting with @samp{-f} or with
107 @samp{-W}---for example, @option{-fforce-mem},
108 @option{-fstrength-reduce}, @option{-Wformat} and so on. Most of
109 these have both positive and negative forms; the negative form of
110 @option{-ffoo} would be @option{-fno-foo}. This manual documents
111 only one of these two forms, whichever one is not the default.
115 @xref{Option Index}, for an index to GCC's options.
118 * Option Summary:: Brief list of all options, without explanations.
119 * Overall Options:: Controlling the kind of output:
120 an executable, object files, assembler files,
121 or preprocessed source.
122 * Invoking G++:: Compiling C++ programs.
123 * C Dialect Options:: Controlling the variant of C language compiled.
124 * C++ Dialect Options:: Variations on C++.
125 * Objective-C Dialect Options:: Variations on Objective-C.
126 * Language Independent Options:: Controlling how diagnostics should be
128 * Warning Options:: How picky should the compiler be?
129 * Debugging Options:: Symbol tables, measurements, and debugging dumps.
130 * Optimize Options:: How much optimization?
131 * Preprocessor Options:: Controlling header files and macro definitions.
132 Also, getting dependency information for Make.
133 * Assembler Options:: Passing options to the assembler.
134 * Link Options:: Specifying libraries and so on.
135 * Directory Options:: Where to find header files and libraries.
136 Where to find the compiler executable files.
137 * Spec Files:: How to pass switches to sub-processes.
138 * Target Options:: Running a cross-compiler, or an old version of GCC.
139 * Submodel Options:: Specifying minor hardware or convention variations,
140 such as 68010 vs 68020.
141 * Code Gen Options:: Specifying conventions for function calls, data layout
143 * Environment Variables:: Env vars that affect GCC.
144 * Precompiled Headers:: Compiling a header once, and using it many times.
145 * Running Protoize:: Automatically adding or removing function prototypes.
151 @section Option Summary
153 Here is a summary of all the options, grouped by type. Explanations are
154 in the following sections.
157 @item Overall Options
158 @xref{Overall Options,,Options Controlling the Kind of Output}.
160 -c -S -E -o @var{file} -pipe -pass-exit-codes -x @var{language} @gol
161 -v -### --help --target-help --version}
163 @item C Language Options
164 @xref{C Dialect Options,,Options Controlling C Dialect}.
166 -ansi -std=@var{standard} -aux-info @var{filename} @gol
167 -fno-asm -fno-builtin -fno-builtin-@var{function} @gol
168 -fhosted -ffreestanding -fms-extensions @gol
169 -trigraphs -traditional -traditional-cpp @gol
170 -fallow-single-precision -fcond-mismatch @gol
171 -fsigned-bitfields -fsigned-char @gol
172 -funsigned-bitfields -funsigned-char @gol
175 @item C++ Language Options
176 @xref{C++ Dialect Options,,Options Controlling C++ Dialect}.
178 -fabi-version=@var{n} -fno-access-control -fcheck-new @gol
179 -fconserve-space -fno-const-strings -fdollars-in-identifiers @gol
180 -fno-elide-constructors @gol
181 -fno-enforce-eh-specs -fexternal-templates @gol
182 -falt-external-templates @gol
183 -ffor-scope -fno-for-scope -fno-gnu-keywords @gol
184 -fno-implicit-templates @gol
185 -fno-implicit-inline-templates @gol
186 -fno-implement-inlines -fms-extensions @gol
187 -fno-nonansi-builtins -fno-operator-names @gol
188 -fno-optional-diags -fpermissive @gol
189 -frepo -fno-rtti -fstats -ftemplate-depth-@var{n} @gol
190 -fuse-cxa-atexit -fvtable-gc -fno-weak -nostdinc++ @gol
191 -fno-default-inline -Wabi -Wctor-dtor-privacy @gol
192 -Wnon-virtual-dtor -Wreorder @gol
193 -Weffc++ -Wno-deprecated @gol
194 -Wno-non-template-friend -Wold-style-cast @gol
195 -Woverloaded-virtual -Wno-pmf-conversions @gol
196 -Wsign-promo -Wsynth}
198 @item Objective-C Language Options
199 @xref{Objective-C Dialect Options,,Options Controlling Objective-C Dialect}.
201 -fconstant-string-class=@var{class-name} @gol
202 -fgnu-runtime -fnext-runtime -gen-decls @gol
203 -Wno-protocol -Wselector -Wundeclared-selector}
205 @item Language Independent Options
206 @xref{Language Independent Options,,Options to Control Diagnostic Messages Formatting}.
208 -fmessage-length=@var{n} @gol
209 -fdiagnostics-show-location=@r{[}once@r{|}every-line@r{]}}
211 @item Warning Options
212 @xref{Warning Options,,Options to Request or Suppress Warnings}.
214 -fsyntax-only -pedantic -pedantic-errors @gol
215 -w -Wextra -Wall -Waggregate-return @gol
216 -Wcast-align -Wcast-qual -Wchar-subscripts -Wcomment @gol
217 -Wconversion -Wno-deprecated-declarations @gol
218 -Wdisabled-optimization -Wno-div-by-zero -Werror @gol
219 -Wfloat-equal -Wformat -Wformat=2 @gol
220 -Wformat-nonliteral -Wformat-security @gol
221 -Wimplicit -Wimplicit-int @gol
222 -Wimplicit-function-declaration @gol
223 -Werror-implicit-function-declaration @gol
224 -Wimport -Winline -Winvalid-pch -Wno-endif-labels @gol
225 -Wlarger-than-@var{len} -Wlong-long @gol
226 -Wmain -Wmissing-braces @gol
227 -Wmissing-format-attribute -Wmissing-noreturn @gol
228 -Wno-multichar -Wno-format-extra-args -Wno-format-y2k @gol
229 -Wno-import -Wnonnull -Wpacked -Wpadded @gol
230 -Wparentheses -Wpointer-arith -Wredundant-decls @gol
231 -Wreturn-type -Wsequence-point -Wshadow @gol
232 -Wsign-compare -Wstrict-aliasing @gol
233 -Wswitch -Wswitch-default -Wswitch-enum @gol
234 -Wsystem-headers -Wtrigraphs -Wundef -Wuninitialized @gol
235 -Wunknown-pragmas -Wunreachable-code @gol
236 -Wunused -Wunused-function -Wunused-label -Wunused-parameter @gol
237 -Wunused-value -Wunused-variable -Wwrite-strings}
239 @item C-only Warning Options
241 -Wbad-function-cast -Wmissing-declarations @gol
242 -Wmissing-prototypes -Wnested-externs @gol
243 -Wstrict-prototypes -Wtraditional}
245 @item Debugging Options
246 @xref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or GCC}.
248 -d@var{letters} -dumpspecs -dumpmachine -dumpversion @gol
249 -fdump-unnumbered -fdump-translation-unit@r{[}-@var{n}@r{]} @gol
250 -fdump-class-hierarchy@r{[}-@var{n}@r{]} @gol
251 -fdump-tree-original@r{[}-@var{n}@r{]} -fdump-tree-optimized@r{[}-@var{n}@r{]} @gol
252 -fdump-tree-inlined@r{[}-@var{n}@r{]} @gol
253 -feliminate-dwarf2-dups -fmem-report @gol
254 -fprofile-arcs -fsched-verbose=@var{n} @gol
255 -ftest-coverage -ftime-report @gol
256 -g -g@var{level} -gcoff -gdwarf -gdwarf-1 -gdwarf-1+ -gdwarf-2 @gol
257 -ggdb -gstabs -gstabs+ -gvms -gxcoff -gxcoff+ @gol
258 -p -pg -print-file-name=@var{library} -print-libgcc-file-name @gol
259 -print-multi-directory -print-multi-lib @gol
260 -print-prog-name=@var{program} -print-search-dirs -Q @gol
263 @item Optimization Options
264 @xref{Optimize Options,,Options that Control Optimization}.
266 -falign-functions=@var{n} -falign-jumps=@var{n} @gol
267 -falign-labels=@var{n} -falign-loops=@var{n} @gol
268 -fbranch-probabilities -fcaller-saves -fcprop-registers @gol
269 -fcse-follow-jumps -fcse-skip-blocks -fdata-sections @gol
270 -fdelayed-branch -fdelete-null-pointer-checks @gol
271 -fexpensive-optimizations -ffast-math -ffloat-store @gol
272 -fforce-addr -fforce-mem -ffunction-sections @gol
273 -fgcse -fgcse-lm -fgcse-sm -floop-optimize -fcrossjumping @gol
274 -fif-conversion -fif-conversion2 @gol
275 -finline-functions -finline-limit=@var{n} -fkeep-inline-functions @gol
276 -fkeep-static-consts -fmerge-constants -fmerge-all-constants @gol
277 -fmove-all-movables -fnew-ra -fno-branch-count-reg @gol
278 -fno-default-inline -fno-defer-pop @gol
279 -fno-function-cse -fno-guess-branch-probability @gol
280 -fno-inline -fno-math-errno -fno-peephole -fno-peephole2 @gol
281 -funsafe-math-optimizations -ffinite-math-only @gol
282 -fno-trapping-math -fno-zero-initialized-in-bss @gol
283 -fomit-frame-pointer -foptimize-register-move @gol
284 -foptimize-sibling-calls -fprefetch-loop-arrays @gol
285 -freduce-all-givs -fregmove -frename-registers @gol
286 -freorder-blocks -freorder-functions @gol
287 -frerun-cse-after-loop -frerun-loop-opt @gol
288 -fschedule-insns -fschedule-insns2 @gol
289 -fno-sched-interblock -fno-sched-spec -fsched-spec-load @gol
290 -fsched-spec-load-dangerous -fsignaling-nans @gol
291 -fsingle-precision-constant -fssa -fssa-ccp -fssa-dce @gol
292 -fstrength-reduce -fstrict-aliasing -ftracer -fthread-jumps @gol
293 -funroll-all-loops -funroll-loops @gol
294 --param @var{name}=@var{value}
295 -O -O0 -O1 -O2 -O3 -Os}
297 @item Preprocessor Options
298 @xref{Preprocessor Options,,Options Controlling the Preprocessor}.
300 -$ -A@var{question}=@var{answer} -A-@var{question}@r{[}=@var{answer}@r{]} @gol
301 -C -dD -dI -dM -dN @gol
302 -D@var{macro}@r{[}=@var{defn}@r{]} -E -H @gol
303 -idirafter @var{dir} @gol
304 -include @var{file} -imacros @var{file} @gol
305 -iprefix @var{file} -iwithprefix @var{dir} @gol
306 -iwithprefixbefore @var{dir} -isystem @var{dir} @gol
307 -M -MM -MF -MG -MP -MQ -MT -nostdinc -P -remap @gol
308 -trigraphs -undef -U@var{macro} -Wp,@var{option} -Xpreprocessor @var{option}}
310 @item Assembler Option
311 @xref{Assembler Options,,Passing Options to the Assembler}.
313 -Wa,@var{option} -Xassembler @var{option}}
316 @xref{Link Options,,Options for Linking}.
318 @var{object-file-name} -l@var{library} @gol
319 -nostartfiles -nodefaultlibs -nostdlib @gol
320 -s -static -static-libgcc -shared -shared-libgcc -symbolic @gol
321 -Wl,@var{option} -Xlinker @var{option} @gol
324 @item Directory Options
325 @xref{Directory Options,,Options for Directory Search}.
327 -B@var{prefix} -I@var{dir} -I- -L@var{dir} -specs=@var{file}}
330 @c I wrote this xref this way to avoid overfull hbox. -- rms
331 @xref{Target Options}.
333 -V @var{version} -b @var{machine}}
335 @item Machine Dependent Options
336 @xref{Submodel Options,,Hardware Models and Configurations}.
338 @emph{M680x0 Options}
340 -m68000 -m68020 -m68020-40 -m68020-60 -m68030 -m68040 @gol
341 -m68060 -mcpu32 -m5200 -m68881 -mbitfield -mc68000 -mc68020 @gol
342 -mfpa -mnobitfield -mrtd -mshort -msoft-float -mpcrel @gol
343 -malign-int -mstrict-align}
345 @emph{M68hc1x Options}
347 -m6811 -m6812 -m68hc11 -m68hc12 -m68hcs12 @gol
348 -mauto-incdec -minmax -mlong-calls -mshort @gol
349 -msoft-reg-count=@var{count}}
357 -mcpu=@var{cpu-type} @gol
358 -mtune=@var{cpu-type} @gol
359 -mcmodel=@var{code-model} @gol
361 -mapp-regs -mbroken-saverestore -mcypress @gol
362 -mfaster-structs -mflat @gol
363 -mfpu -mhard-float -mhard-quad-float @gol
364 -mimpure-text -mlive-g0 -mno-app-regs @gol
365 -mno-faster-structs -mno-flat -mno-fpu @gol
366 -mno-impure-text -mno-stack-bias -mno-unaligned-doubles @gol
367 -msoft-float -msoft-quad-float -msparclite -mstack-bias @gol
368 -msupersparc -munaligned-doubles -mv8}
372 -mapcs-frame -mno-apcs-frame @gol
373 -mapcs-26 -mapcs-32 @gol
374 -mapcs-stack-check -mno-apcs-stack-check @gol
375 -mapcs-float -mno-apcs-float @gol
376 -mapcs-reentrant -mno-apcs-reentrant @gol
377 -msched-prolog -mno-sched-prolog @gol
378 -mlittle-endian -mbig-endian -mwords-little-endian @gol
379 -malignment-traps -mno-alignment-traps @gol
380 -msoft-float -mhard-float -mfpe @gol
381 -mthumb-interwork -mno-thumb-interwork @gol
382 -mcpu=@var{name} -march=@var{name} -mfpe=@var{name} @gol
383 -mstructure-size-boundary=@var{n} @gol
384 -mabort-on-noreturn @gol
385 -mlong-calls -mno-long-calls @gol
386 -msingle-pic-base -mno-single-pic-base @gol
387 -mpic-register=@var{reg} @gol
388 -mnop-fun-dllimport @gol
389 -mpoke-function-name @gol
391 -mtpcs-frame -mtpcs-leaf-frame @gol
392 -mcaller-super-interworking -mcallee-super-interworking }
394 @emph{MN10200 Options}
398 @emph{MN10300 Options}
400 -mmult-bug -mno-mult-bug @gol
401 -mam33 -mno-am33 @gol
404 @emph{M32R/D Options}
406 -m32rx -m32r -mcode-model=@var{model-type} -msdata=@var{sdata-type} @gol
411 -m88000 -m88100 -m88110 -mbig-pic @gol
412 -mcheck-zero-division -mhandle-large-shift @gol
413 -midentify-revision -mno-check-zero-division @gol
414 -mno-ocs-debug-info -mno-ocs-frame-position @gol
415 -mno-optimize-arg-area -mno-serialize-volatile @gol
416 -mno-underscores -mocs-debug-info @gol
417 -mocs-frame-position -moptimize-arg-area @gol
418 -mserialize-volatile -mshort-data-@var{num} -msvr3 @gol
419 -msvr4 -mtrap-large-shift -muse-div-instruction @gol
420 -mversion-03.00 -mwarn-passed-structs}
422 @emph{RS/6000 and PowerPC Options}
424 -mcpu=@var{cpu-type} @gol
425 -mtune=@var{cpu-type} @gol
426 -mpower -mno-power -mpower2 -mno-power2 @gol
427 -mpowerpc -mpowerpc64 -mno-powerpc @gol
428 -maltivec -mno-altivec @gol
429 -mpowerpc-gpopt -mno-powerpc-gpopt @gol
430 -mpowerpc-gfxopt -mno-powerpc-gfxopt @gol
431 -mnew-mnemonics -mold-mnemonics @gol
432 -mfull-toc -mminimal-toc -mno-fp-in-toc -mno-sum-in-toc @gol
433 -m64 -m32 -mxl-call -mno-xl-call -mpe @gol
434 -msoft-float -mhard-float -mmultiple -mno-multiple @gol
435 -mstring -mno-string -mupdate -mno-update @gol
436 -mfused-madd -mno-fused-madd -mbit-align -mno-bit-align @gol
437 -mstrict-align -mno-strict-align -mrelocatable @gol
438 -mno-relocatable -mrelocatable-lib -mno-relocatable-lib @gol
439 -mtoc -mno-toc -mlittle -mlittle-endian -mbig -mbig-endian @gol
440 -mcall-aix -mcall-sysv -mcall-netbsd @gol
441 -maix-struct-return -msvr4-struct-return @gol
442 -mabi=altivec -mabi=no-altivec @gol
443 -mabi=spe -mabi=no-spe @gol
444 -misel=yes -misel=no @gol
445 -mprototype -mno-prototype @gol
446 -msim -mmvme -mads -myellowknife -memb -msdata @gol
447 -msdata=@var{opt} -mvxworks -mwindiss -G @var{num} -pthread}
449 @emph{Darwin Options}
451 -all_load -allowable_client -arch -arch_errors_fatal @gol
452 -arch_only -bind_at_load -bundle -bundle_loader @gol
453 -client_name -compatibility_version -current_version @gol
454 -dependency-file -dylib_file -dylinker_install_name @gol
455 -dynamic -dynamiclib -exported_symbols_list @gol
456 -filelist -flat_namespace -force_cpusubtype_ALL @gol
457 -force_flat_namespace -headerpad_max_install_names @gol
458 -image_base -init -install_name -keep_private_externs @gol
459 -multi_module -multiply_defined -multiply_defined_unused @gol
460 -noall_load -nomultidefs -noprebind -noseglinkedit @gol
461 -pagezero_size -prebind -prebind_all_twolevel_modules @gol
462 -private_bundle -read_only_relocs -sectalign @gol
463 -sectobjectsymbols -whyload -seg1addr @gol
464 -sectcreate -sectobjectsymbols -sectorder @gol
465 -seg_addr_table -seg_addr_table_filename -seglinkedit @gol
466 -segprot -segs_read_only_addr -segs_read_write_addr @gol
467 -single_module -static -sub_library -sub_umbrella @gol
468 -twolevel_namespace -umbrella -undefined @gol
469 -unexported_symbols_list -weak_reference_mismatches -whatsloaded}
473 -mcall-lib-mul -mfp-arg-in-fpregs -mfp-arg-in-gregs @gol
474 -mfull-fp-blocks -mhc-struct-return -min-line-mul @gol
475 -mminimum-fp-blocks -mnohc-struct-return}
479 -mabicalls -march=@var{cpu-type} -mtune=@var{cpu=type} @gol
480 -mcpu=@var{cpu-type} -membedded-data -muninit-const-in-rodata @gol
481 -membedded-pic -mfp32 -mfp64 -mfused-madd -mno-fused-madd @gol
482 -mgas -mgp32 -mgp64 @gol
483 -mgpopt -mhalf-pic -mhard-float -mint64 -mips1 @gol
484 -mips2 -mips3 -mips4 -mips32 -mips32r2 -mips64 @gol
485 -mlong64 -mlong32 -mlong-calls -mmemcpy @gol
486 -mmips-as -mmips-tfile -mno-abicalls @gol
487 -mno-embedded-data -mno-uninit-const-in-rodata @gol
488 -mno-embedded-pic -mno-gpopt -mno-long-calls @gol
489 -mno-memcpy -mno-mips-tfile -mno-rnames -mno-stats @gol
490 -mrnames -msoft-float @gol
491 -m4650 -msingle-float -mmad @gol
492 -mstats -EL -EB -G @var{num} -nocpp @gol
493 -mabi=32 -mabi=n32 -mabi=64 -mabi=eabi -mabi-fake-default @gol
494 -mfix7000 -mno-crt0 -mflush-func=@var{func} -mno-flush-func @gol
495 -mbranch-likely -mno-branch-likely}
497 @emph{i386 and x86-64 Options}
499 -mcpu=@var{cpu-type} -march=@var{cpu-type} -mfpmath=@var{unit} @gol
500 -masm=@var{dialect} -mno-fancy-math-387 @gol
501 -mno-fp-ret-in-387 -msoft-float -msvr3-shlib @gol
502 -mno-wide-multiply -mrtd -malign-double @gol
503 -mpreferred-stack-boundary=@var{num} @gol
504 -mmmx -msse -msse2 -m3dnow @gol
505 -mthreads -mno-align-stringops -minline-all-stringops @gol
506 -mpush-args -maccumulate-outgoing-args -m128bit-long-double @gol
507 -m96bit-long-double -mregparm=@var{num} -momit-leaf-frame-pointer @gol
509 -mcmodel=@var{code-model} @gol
514 -march=@var{architecture-type} @gol
515 -mbig-switch -mdisable-fpregs -mdisable-indexing @gol
516 -mfast-indirect-calls -mgas -mgnu-ld -mhp-ld @gol
517 -mjump-in-delay -mlinker-opt -mlong-calls @gol
518 -mlong-load-store -mno-big-switch -mno-disable-fpregs @gol
519 -mno-disable-indexing -mno-fast-indirect-calls -mno-gas @gol
520 -mno-jump-in-delay -mno-long-load-store @gol
521 -mno-portable-runtime -mno-soft-float @gol
522 -mno-space-regs -msoft-float -mpa-risc-1-0 @gol
523 -mpa-risc-1-1 -mpa-risc-2-0 -mportable-runtime @gol
524 -mschedule=@var{cpu-type} -mspace-regs -msio -mwsio}
526 @emph{Intel 960 Options}
528 -m@var{cpu-type} -masm-compat -mclean-linkage @gol
529 -mcode-align -mcomplex-addr -mleaf-procedures @gol
530 -mic-compat -mic2.0-compat -mic3.0-compat @gol
531 -mintel-asm -mno-clean-linkage -mno-code-align @gol
532 -mno-complex-addr -mno-leaf-procedures @gol
533 -mno-old-align -mno-strict-align -mno-tail-call @gol
534 -mnumerics -mold-align -msoft-float -mstrict-align @gol
537 @emph{DEC Alpha Options}
539 -mno-fp-regs -msoft-float -malpha-as -mgas @gol
540 -mieee -mieee-with-inexact -mieee-conformant @gol
541 -mfp-trap-mode=@var{mode} -mfp-rounding-mode=@var{mode} @gol
542 -mtrap-precision=@var{mode} -mbuild-constants @gol
543 -mcpu=@var{cpu-type} -mtune=@var{cpu-type} @gol
544 -mbwx -mmax -mfix -mcix @gol
545 -mfloat-vax -mfloat-ieee @gol
546 -mexplicit-relocs -msmall-data -mlarge-data -msmall-text -mlarge-text @gol
547 -mmemory-latency=@var{time}}
549 @emph{DEC Alpha/VMS Options}
553 @emph{H8/300 Options}
555 -mrelax -mh -ms -mn -mint32 -malign-300}
559 -m1 -m2 -m2e -m3 -m3e @gol
560 -m4-nofpu -m4-single-only -m4-single -m4 @gol
561 -m5-64media -m5-64media-nofpu @gol
562 -m5-32media -m5-32media-nofpu @gol
563 -m5-compact -m5-compact-nofpu @gol
564 -mb -ml -mdalign -mrelax @gol
565 -mbigtable -mfmovd -mhitachi -mnomacsave @gol
566 -mieee -misize -mpadstruct -mspace @gol
567 -mprefergot -musermode}
569 @emph{System V Options}
571 -Qy -Qn -YP,@var{paths} -Ym,@var{dir}}
576 -mmangle-cpu -mcpu=@var{cpu} -mtext=@var{text-section} @gol
577 -mdata=@var{data-section} -mrodata=@var{readonly-data-section}}
579 @emph{TMS320C3x/C4x Options}
581 -mcpu=@var{cpu} -mbig -msmall -mregparm -mmemparm @gol
582 -mfast-fix -mmpyi -mbk -mti -mdp-isr-reload @gol
583 -mrpts=@var{count} -mrptb -mdb -mloop-unsigned @gol
584 -mparallel-insns -mparallel-mpy -mpreserve-float}
588 -mlong-calls -mno-long-calls -mep -mno-ep @gol
589 -mprolog-function -mno-prolog-function -mspace @gol
590 -mtda=@var{n} -msda=@var{n} -mzda=@var{n} @gol
591 -mapp-regs -mno-app-regs @gol
592 -mdisable-callt -mno-disable-callt @gol
598 -m32032 -m32332 -m32532 -m32081 -m32381 @gol
599 -mmult-add -mnomult-add -msoft-float -mrtd -mnortd @gol
600 -mregparam -mnoregparam -msb -mnosb @gol
601 -mbitfield -mnobitfield -mhimem -mnohimem}
605 -mmcu=@var{mcu} -msize -minit-stack=@var{n} -mno-interrupts @gol
606 -mcall-prologues -mno-tablejump -mtiny-stack}
610 -mhardlit -mno-hardlit -mdiv -mno-div -mrelax-immediates @gol
611 -mno-relax-immediates -mwide-bitfields -mno-wide-bitfields @gol
612 -m4byte-functions -mno-4byte-functions -mcallgraph-data @gol
613 -mno-callgraph-data -mslow-bytes -mno-slow-bytes -mno-lsim @gol
614 -mlittle-endian -mbig-endian -m210 -m340 -mstack-increment}
618 -mlibfuncs -mno-libfuncs -mepsilon -mno-epsilon -mabi=gnu @gol
619 -mabi=mmixware -mzero-extend -mknuthdiv -mtoplevel-symbols @gol
620 -melf -mbranch-predict -mno-branch-predict -mbase-addresses @gol
621 -mno-base-addresses -msingle-exit -mno-single-exit}
625 -mbig-endian -mlittle-endian -mgnu-as -mgnu-ld -mno-pic @gol
626 -mvolatile-asm-stop -mb-step -mregister-names -mno-sdata @gol
627 -mconstant-gp -mauto-pic -minline-float-divide-min-latency @gol
628 -minline-float-divide-max-throughput -minline-int-divide-min-latency @gol
629 -minline-int-divide-max-throughput -mno-dwarf2-asm @gol
630 -mfixed-range=@var{register-range}}
634 -mextmem -mextmemory -monchip -mno-asm-optimize @gol
635 -masm-optimize -mbranch-cost=@var{n} -mcond-exec=@var{n}}
637 @emph{S/390 and zSeries Options}
639 -mtune=@var{cpu-type} -march=@var{cpu-type} @gol
640 -mhard-float -msoft-float -mbackchain -mno-backchain @gol
641 -msmall-exec -mno-small-exec -mmvcle -mno-mvcle @gol
642 -m64 -m31 -mdebug -mno-debug -mesa -mzarch}
646 -mcpu=@var{cpu} -march=@var{cpu} -mtune=@var{cpu} @gol
647 -mmax-stack-frame=@var{n} -melinux-stacksize=@var{n} @gol
648 -metrax4 -metrax100 -mpdebug -mcc-init -mno-side-effects @gol
649 -mstack-align -mdata-align -mconst-align @gol
650 -m32-bit -m16-bit -m8-bit -mno-prologue-epilogue -mno-gotplt @gol
651 -melf -maout -melinux -mlinux -sim -sim2}
653 @emph{PDP-11 Options}
655 -mfpu -msoft-float -mac0 -mno-ac0 -m40 -m45 -m10 @gol
656 -mbcopy -mbcopy-builtin -mint32 -mno-int16 @gol
657 -mint16 -mno-int32 -mfloat32 -mno-float64 @gol
658 -mfloat64 -mno-float32 -mabshi -mno-abshi @gol
659 -mbranch-expensive -mbranch-cheap @gol
660 -msplit -mno-split -munix-asm -mdec-asm}
662 @emph{Xstormy16 Options}
666 @emph{Xtensa Options}
668 -mbig-endian -mlittle-endian @gol
669 -mdensity -mno-density @gol
670 -mmac16 -mno-mac16 @gol
671 -mmul16 -mno-mul16 @gol
672 -mmul32 -mno-mul32 @gol
674 -mminmax -mno-minmax @gol
675 -msext -mno-sext @gol
676 -mbooleans -mno-booleans @gol
677 -mhard-float -msoft-float @gol
678 -mfused-madd -mno-fused-madd @gol
679 -mserialize-volatile -mno-serialize-volatile @gol
680 -mtext-section-literals -mno-text-section-literals @gol
681 -mtarget-align -mno-target-align @gol
682 -mlongcalls -mno-longcalls}
686 -mgpr-32 -mgpr-64 -mfpr-32 -mfpr-64 -mhard-float -msoft-float @gol
687 -malloc-cc -mfixed-cc -mdword -mno-dword -mdouble -mno-double @gol
688 -mmedia -mno-media -mmuladd -mno-muladd -mlibrary-pic -macc-4 @gol
689 -macc-8 -mpack -mno-pack -mno-eflags -mcond-move -mno-cond-move @gol
690 -mscc -mno-scc -mcond-exec -mno-cond-exec -mvliw-branch -mno-vliw-branch @gol
691 -mmulti-cond-exec -mno-multi-cond-exec -mnested-cond-exec @gol
692 -mno-nested-cond-exec -mtomcat-stats @gol
697 @item Code Generation Options
698 @xref{Code Gen Options,,Options for Code Generation Conventions}.
700 -fcall-saved-@var{reg} -fcall-used-@var{reg} @gol
701 -ffixed-@var{reg} -fexceptions @gol
702 -fnon-call-exceptions -funwind-tables @gol
703 -fasynchronous-unwind-tables @gol
704 -finhibit-size-directive -finstrument-functions @gol
705 -fno-common -fno-ident -fno-gnu-linker @gol
706 -fpcc-struct-return -fpic -fPIC @gol
707 -freg-struct-return -fshared-data -fshort-enums @gol
708 -fshort-double -fshort-wchar @gol
709 -fverbose-asm -fpack-struct -fstack-check @gol
710 -fstack-limit-register=@var{reg} -fstack-limit-symbol=@var{sym} @gol
711 -fargument-alias -fargument-noalias @gol
712 -fargument-noalias-global -fleading-underscore @gol
713 -ftls-model=@var{model} @gol
714 -ftrapv -fbounds-check}
718 * Overall Options:: Controlling the kind of output:
719 an executable, object files, assembler files,
720 or preprocessed source.
721 * C Dialect Options:: Controlling the variant of C language compiled.
722 * C++ Dialect Options:: Variations on C++.
723 * Objective-C Dialect Options:: Variations on Objective-C.
724 * Language Independent Options:: Controlling how diagnostics should be
726 * Warning Options:: How picky should the compiler be?
727 * Debugging Options:: Symbol tables, measurements, and debugging dumps.
728 * Optimize Options:: How much optimization?
729 * Preprocessor Options:: Controlling header files and macro definitions.
730 Also, getting dependency information for Make.
731 * Assembler Options:: Passing options to the assembler.
732 * Link Options:: Specifying libraries and so on.
733 * Directory Options:: Where to find header files and libraries.
734 Where to find the compiler executable files.
735 * Spec Files:: How to pass switches to sub-processes.
736 * Target Options:: Running a cross-compiler, or an old version of GCC.
739 @node Overall Options
740 @section Options Controlling the Kind of Output
742 Compilation can involve up to four stages: preprocessing, compilation
743 proper, assembly and linking, always in that order. The first three
744 stages apply to an individual source file, and end by producing an
745 object file; linking combines all the object files (those newly
746 compiled, and those specified as input) into an executable file.
748 @cindex file name suffix
749 For any given input file, the file name suffix determines what kind of
754 C source code which must be preprocessed.
757 C source code which should not be preprocessed.
760 C++ source code which should not be preprocessed.
763 Objective-C source code. Note that you must link with the library
764 @file{libobjc.a} to make an Objective-C program work.
767 Objective-C source code which should not be preprocessed.
770 C or C++ header file to be turned into a precompiled header.
774 @itemx @var{file}.cxx
775 @itemx @var{file}.cpp
776 @itemx @var{file}.CPP
777 @itemx @var{file}.c++
779 C++ source code which must be preprocessed. Note that in @samp{.cxx},
780 the last two letters must both be literally @samp{x}. Likewise,
781 @samp{.C} refers to a literal capital C@.
785 C++ header file to be turned into a precompiled header.
788 @itemx @var{file}.for
789 @itemx @var{file}.FOR
790 Fortran source code which should not be preprocessed.
793 @itemx @var{file}.fpp
794 @itemx @var{file}.FPP
795 Fortran source code which must be preprocessed (with the traditional
799 Fortran source code which must be preprocessed with a RATFOR
800 preprocessor (not included with GCC)@.
802 @xref{Overall Options,,Options Controlling the Kind of Output, g77,
803 Using and Porting GNU Fortran}, for more details of the handling of
806 @c FIXME: Descriptions of Java file types.
813 Ada source code file which contains a library unit declaration (a
814 declaration of a package, subprogram, or generic, or a generic
815 instantiation), or a library unit renaming declaration (a package,
816 generic, or subprogram renaming declaration). Such files are also
819 @itemx @var{file}.adb
820 Ada source code file containing a library unit body (a subprogram or
821 package body). Such files are also called @dfn{bodies}.
823 @c GCC also knows about some suffixes for languages not yet included:
832 Assembler code which must be preprocessed.
835 An object file to be fed straight into linking.
836 Any file name with no recognized suffix is treated this way.
840 You can specify the input language explicitly with the @option{-x} option:
843 @item -x @var{language}
844 Specify explicitly the @var{language} for the following input files
845 (rather than letting the compiler choose a default based on the file
846 name suffix). This option applies to all following input files until
847 the next @option{-x} option. Possible values for @var{language} are:
849 c c-header cpp-output
850 c++ c++-header c++-cpp-output
851 objective-c objc-cpp-output
852 assembler assembler-with-cpp
854 f77 f77-cpp-input ratfor
860 Turn off any specification of a language, so that subsequent files are
861 handled according to their file name suffixes (as they are if @option{-x}
862 has not been used at all).
864 @item -pass-exit-codes
865 @opindex pass-exit-codes
866 Normally the @command{gcc} program will exit with the code of 1 if any
867 phase of the compiler returns a non-success return code. If you specify
868 @option{-pass-exit-codes}, the @command{gcc} program will instead return with
869 numerically highest error produced by any phase that returned an error
873 If you only want some of the stages of compilation, you can use
874 @option{-x} (or filename suffixes) to tell @command{gcc} where to start, and
875 one of the options @option{-c}, @option{-S}, or @option{-E} to say where
876 @command{gcc} is to stop. Note that some combinations (for example,
877 @samp{-x cpp-output -E}) instruct @command{gcc} to do nothing at all.
882 Compile or assemble the source files, but do not link. The linking
883 stage simply is not done. The ultimate output is in the form of an
884 object file for each source file.
886 By default, the object file name for a source file is made by replacing
887 the suffix @samp{.c}, @samp{.i}, @samp{.s}, etc., with @samp{.o}.
889 Unrecognized input files, not requiring compilation or assembly, are
894 Stop after the stage of compilation proper; do not assemble. The output
895 is in the form of an assembler code file for each non-assembler input
898 By default, the assembler file name for a source file is made by
899 replacing the suffix @samp{.c}, @samp{.i}, etc., with @samp{.s}.
901 Input files that don't require compilation are ignored.
905 Stop after the preprocessing stage; do not run the compiler proper. The
906 output is in the form of preprocessed source code, which is sent to the
909 Input files which don't require preprocessing are ignored.
911 @cindex output file option
914 Place output in file @var{file}. This applies regardless to whatever
915 sort of output is being produced, whether it be an executable file,
916 an object file, an assembler file or preprocessed C code.
918 Since only one output file can be specified, it does not make sense to
919 use @option{-o} when compiling more than one input file, unless you are
920 producing an executable file as output.
922 If @option{-o} is not specified, the default is to put an executable file
923 in @file{a.out}, the object file for @file{@var{source}.@var{suffix}} in
924 @file{@var{source}.o}, its assembler file in @file{@var{source}.s}, and
925 all preprocessed C source on standard output.
929 Print (on standard error output) the commands executed to run the stages
930 of compilation. Also print the version number of the compiler driver
931 program and of the preprocessor and the compiler proper.
935 Like @option{-v} except the commands are not executed and all command
936 arguments are quoted. This is useful for shell scripts to capture the
937 driver-generated command lines.
941 Use pipes rather than temporary files for communication between the
942 various stages of compilation. This fails to work on some systems where
943 the assembler is unable to read from a pipe; but the GNU assembler has
948 Print (on the standard output) a description of the command line options
949 understood by @command{gcc}. If the @option{-v} option is also specified
950 then @option{--help} will also be passed on to the various processes
951 invoked by @command{gcc}, so that they can display the command line options
952 they accept. If the @option{-Wextra} option is also specified then command
953 line options which have no documentation associated with them will also
958 Print (on the standard output) a description of target specific command
959 line options for each tool.
963 Display the version number and copyrights of the invoked GCC.
967 @section Compiling C++ Programs
969 @cindex suffixes for C++ source
970 @cindex C++ source file suffixes
971 C++ source files conventionally use one of the suffixes @samp{.C},
972 @samp{.cc}, @samp{.cpp}, @samp{.CPP}, @samp{.c++}, @samp{.cp}, or
973 @samp{.cxx}; C++ header files often use @samp{.hh} or @samp{.H}; and
974 preprocessed C++ files use the suffix @samp{.ii}. GCC recognizes
975 files with these names and compiles them as C++ programs even if you
976 call the compiler the same way as for compiling C programs (usually
977 with the name @command{gcc}).
981 However, C++ programs often require class libraries as well as a
982 compiler that understands the C++ language---and under some
983 circumstances, you might want to compile programs or header files from
984 standard input, or otherwise without a suffix that flags them as C++
985 programs. You might also like to precompile a C header file with a
986 @samp{.h} extension to be used in C++ compilations. @command{g++} is a
987 program that calls GCC with the default language set to C++, and
988 automatically specifies linking against the C++ library. On many
989 systems, @command{g++} is also installed with the name @command{c++}.
991 @cindex invoking @command{g++}
992 When you compile C++ programs, you may specify many of the same
993 command-line options that you use for compiling programs in any
994 language; or command-line options meaningful for C and related
995 languages; or options that are meaningful only for C++ programs.
996 @xref{C Dialect Options,,Options Controlling C Dialect}, for
997 explanations of options for languages related to C@.
998 @xref{C++ Dialect Options,,Options Controlling C++ Dialect}, for
999 explanations of options that are meaningful only for C++ programs.
1001 @node C Dialect Options
1002 @section Options Controlling C Dialect
1003 @cindex dialect options
1004 @cindex language dialect options
1005 @cindex options, dialect
1007 The following options control the dialect of C (or languages derived
1008 from C, such as C++ and Objective-C) that the compiler accepts:
1011 @cindex ANSI support
1015 In C mode, support all ISO C90 programs. In C++ mode,
1016 remove GNU extensions that conflict with ISO C++.
1018 This turns off certain features of GCC that are incompatible with ISO
1019 C90 (when compiling C code), or of standard C++ (when compiling C++ code),
1020 such as the @code{asm} and @code{typeof} keywords, and
1021 predefined macros such as @code{unix} and @code{vax} that identify the
1022 type of system you are using. It also enables the undesirable and
1023 rarely used ISO trigraph feature. For the C compiler,
1024 it disables recognition of C++ style @samp{//} comments as well as
1025 the @code{inline} keyword.
1027 The alternate keywords @code{__asm__}, @code{__extension__},
1028 @code{__inline__} and @code{__typeof__} continue to work despite
1029 @option{-ansi}. You would not want to use them in an ISO C program, of
1030 course, but it is useful to put them in header files that might be included
1031 in compilations done with @option{-ansi}. Alternate predefined macros
1032 such as @code{__unix__} and @code{__vax__} are also available, with or
1033 without @option{-ansi}.
1035 The @option{-ansi} option does not cause non-ISO programs to be
1036 rejected gratuitously. For that, @option{-pedantic} is required in
1037 addition to @option{-ansi}. @xref{Warning Options}.
1039 The macro @code{__STRICT_ANSI__} is predefined when the @option{-ansi}
1040 option is used. Some header files may notice this macro and refrain
1041 from declaring certain functions or defining certain macros that the
1042 ISO standard doesn't call for; this is to avoid interfering with any
1043 programs that might use these names for other things.
1045 Functions which would normally be built in but do not have semantics
1046 defined by ISO C (such as @code{alloca} and @code{ffs}) are not built-in
1047 functions with @option{-ansi} is used. @xref{Other Builtins,,Other
1048 built-in functions provided by GCC}, for details of the functions
1053 Determine the language standard. This option is currently only
1054 supported when compiling C or C++. A value for this option must be
1055 provided; possible values are
1060 ISO C90 (same as @option{-ansi}).
1062 @item iso9899:199409
1063 ISO C90 as modified in amendment 1.
1069 ISO C99. Note that this standard is not yet fully supported; see
1070 @w{@uref{http://gcc.gnu.org/c99status.html}} for more information. The
1071 names @samp{c9x} and @samp{iso9899:199x} are deprecated.
1074 Default, ISO C90 plus GNU extensions (including some C99 features).
1078 ISO C99 plus GNU extensions. When ISO C99 is fully implemented in GCC,
1079 this will become the default. The name @samp{gnu9x} is deprecated.
1082 The 1998 ISO C++ standard plus amendments.
1085 The same as @option{-std=c++98} plus GNU extensions. This is the
1086 default for C++ code.
1089 Even when this option is not specified, you can still use some of the
1090 features of newer standards in so far as they do not conflict with
1091 previous C standards. For example, you may use @code{__restrict__} even
1092 when @option{-std=c99} is not specified.
1094 The @option{-std} options specifying some version of ISO C have the same
1095 effects as @option{-ansi}, except that features that were not in ISO C90
1096 but are in the specified version (for example, @samp{//} comments and
1097 the @code{inline} keyword in ISO C99) are not disabled.
1099 @xref{Standards,,Language Standards Supported by GCC}, for details of
1100 these standard versions.
1102 @item -aux-info @var{filename}
1104 Output to the given filename prototyped declarations for all functions
1105 declared and/or defined in a translation unit, including those in header
1106 files. This option is silently ignored in any language other than C@.
1108 Besides declarations, the file indicates, in comments, the origin of
1109 each declaration (source file and line), whether the declaration was
1110 implicit, prototyped or unprototyped (@samp{I}, @samp{N} for new or
1111 @samp{O} for old, respectively, in the first character after the line
1112 number and the colon), and whether it came from a declaration or a
1113 definition (@samp{C} or @samp{F}, respectively, in the following
1114 character). In the case of function definitions, a K&R-style list of
1115 arguments followed by their declarations is also provided, inside
1116 comments, after the declaration.
1120 Do not recognize @code{asm}, @code{inline} or @code{typeof} as a
1121 keyword, so that code can use these words as identifiers. You can use
1122 the keywords @code{__asm__}, @code{__inline__} and @code{__typeof__}
1123 instead. @option{-ansi} implies @option{-fno-asm}.
1125 In C++, this switch only affects the @code{typeof} keyword, since
1126 @code{asm} and @code{inline} are standard keywords. You may want to
1127 use the @option{-fno-gnu-keywords} flag instead, which has the same
1128 effect. In C99 mode (@option{-std=c99} or @option{-std=gnu99}), this
1129 switch only affects the @code{asm} and @code{typeof} keywords, since
1130 @code{inline} is a standard keyword in ISO C99.
1133 @itemx -fno-builtin-@var{function}
1134 @opindex fno-builtin
1135 @cindex built-in functions
1136 Don't recognize built-in functions that do not begin with
1137 @samp{__builtin_} as prefix. @xref{Other Builtins,,Other built-in
1138 functions provided by GCC}, for details of the functions affected,
1139 including those which are not built-in functions when @option{-ansi} or
1140 @option{-std} options for strict ISO C conformance are used because they
1141 do not have an ISO standard meaning.
1143 GCC normally generates special code to handle certain built-in functions
1144 more efficiently; for instance, calls to @code{alloca} may become single
1145 instructions that adjust the stack directly, and calls to @code{memcpy}
1146 may become inline copy loops. The resulting code is often both smaller
1147 and faster, but since the function calls no longer appear as such, you
1148 cannot set a breakpoint on those calls, nor can you change the behavior
1149 of the functions by linking with a different library.
1151 With the @option{-fno-builtin-@var{function}} option
1152 only the built-in function @var{function} is
1153 disabled. @var{function} must not begin with @samp{__builtin_}. If a
1154 function is named this is not built-in in this version of GCC, this
1155 option is ignored. There is no corresponding
1156 @option{-fbuiltin-@var{function}} option; if you wish to enable
1157 built-in functions selectively when using @option{-fno-builtin} or
1158 @option{-ffreestanding}, you may define macros such as:
1161 #define abs(n) __builtin_abs ((n))
1162 #define strcpy(d, s) __builtin_strcpy ((d), (s))
1167 @cindex hosted environment
1169 Assert that compilation takes place in a hosted environment. This implies
1170 @option{-fbuiltin}. A hosted environment is one in which the
1171 entire standard library is available, and in which @code{main} has a return
1172 type of @code{int}. Examples are nearly everything except a kernel.
1173 This is equivalent to @option{-fno-freestanding}.
1175 @item -ffreestanding
1176 @opindex ffreestanding
1177 @cindex hosted environment
1179 Assert that compilation takes place in a freestanding environment. This
1180 implies @option{-fno-builtin}. A freestanding environment
1181 is one in which the standard library may not exist, and program startup may
1182 not necessarily be at @code{main}. The most obvious example is an OS kernel.
1183 This is equivalent to @option{-fno-hosted}.
1185 @xref{Standards,,Language Standards Supported by GCC}, for details of
1186 freestanding and hosted environments.
1188 @item -fms-extensions
1189 @opindex fms-extensions
1190 Accept some non-standard constructs used in Microsoft header files.
1194 Support ISO C trigraphs. The @option{-ansi} option (and @option{-std}
1195 options for strict ISO C conformance) implies @option{-trigraphs}.
1197 @cindex traditional C language
1198 @cindex C language, traditional
1200 @itemx -traditional-cpp
1201 @opindex traditional-cpp
1202 @opindex traditional
1203 Formerly, these options caused GCC to attempt to emulate a pre-standard
1204 C compiler. They are now only supported with the @option{-E} switch.
1205 The preprocessor continues to support a pre-standard mode. See the GNU
1206 CPP manual for details.
1208 @item -fcond-mismatch
1209 @opindex fcond-mismatch
1210 Allow conditional expressions with mismatched types in the second and
1211 third arguments. The value of such an expression is void. This option
1212 is not supported for C++.
1214 @item -funsigned-char
1215 @opindex funsigned-char
1216 Let the type @code{char} be unsigned, like @code{unsigned char}.
1218 Each kind of machine has a default for what @code{char} should
1219 be. It is either like @code{unsigned char} by default or like
1220 @code{signed char} by default.
1222 Ideally, a portable program should always use @code{signed char} or
1223 @code{unsigned char} when it depends on the signedness of an object.
1224 But many programs have been written to use plain @code{char} and
1225 expect it to be signed, or expect it to be unsigned, depending on the
1226 machines they were written for. This option, and its inverse, let you
1227 make such a program work with the opposite default.
1229 The type @code{char} is always a distinct type from each of
1230 @code{signed char} or @code{unsigned char}, even though its behavior
1231 is always just like one of those two.
1234 @opindex fsigned-char
1235 Let the type @code{char} be signed, like @code{signed char}.
1237 Note that this is equivalent to @option{-fno-unsigned-char}, which is
1238 the negative form of @option{-funsigned-char}. Likewise, the option
1239 @option{-fno-signed-char} is equivalent to @option{-funsigned-char}.
1241 @item -fsigned-bitfields
1242 @itemx -funsigned-bitfields
1243 @itemx -fno-signed-bitfields
1244 @itemx -fno-unsigned-bitfields
1245 @opindex fsigned-bitfields
1246 @opindex funsigned-bitfields
1247 @opindex fno-signed-bitfields
1248 @opindex fno-unsigned-bitfields
1249 These options control whether a bit-field is signed or unsigned, when the
1250 declaration does not use either @code{signed} or @code{unsigned}. By
1251 default, such a bit-field is signed, because this is consistent: the
1252 basic integer types such as @code{int} are signed types.
1254 @item -fwritable-strings
1255 @opindex fwritable-strings
1256 Store string constants in the writable data segment and don't uniquize
1257 them. This is for compatibility with old programs which assume they can
1258 write into string constants.
1260 Writing into string constants is a very bad idea; ``constants'' should
1264 @node C++ Dialect Options
1265 @section Options Controlling C++ Dialect
1267 @cindex compiler options, C++
1268 @cindex C++ options, command line
1269 @cindex options, C++
1270 This section describes the command-line options that are only meaningful
1271 for C++ programs; but you can also use most of the GNU compiler options
1272 regardless of what language your program is in. For example, you
1273 might compile a file @code{firstClass.C} like this:
1276 g++ -g -frepo -O -c firstClass.C
1280 In this example, only @option{-frepo} is an option meant
1281 only for C++ programs; you can use the other options with any
1282 language supported by GCC@.
1284 Here is a list of options that are @emph{only} for compiling C++ programs:
1288 @item -fabi-version=@var{n}
1289 @opindex fabi-version
1290 Use version @var{n} of the C++ ABI. Version 1 is the version of the C++
1291 ABI that first appeared in G++ 3.2. Version 0 will always be the
1292 version that conforms most closely to the C++ ABI specification.
1293 Therefore, the ABI obtained using version 0 will change as ABI bugs are
1296 The default is version 1.
1298 @item -fno-access-control
1299 @opindex fno-access-control
1300 Turn off all access checking. This switch is mainly useful for working
1301 around bugs in the access control code.
1305 Check that the pointer returned by @code{operator new} is non-null
1306 before attempting to modify the storage allocated. The current Working
1307 Paper requires that @code{operator new} never return a null pointer, so
1308 this check is normally unnecessary.
1310 An alternative to using this option is to specify that your
1311 @code{operator new} does not throw any exceptions; if you declare it
1312 @samp{throw()}, G++ will check the return value. See also @samp{new
1315 @item -fconserve-space
1316 @opindex fconserve-space
1317 Put uninitialized or runtime-initialized global variables into the
1318 common segment, as C does. This saves space in the executable at the
1319 cost of not diagnosing duplicate definitions. If you compile with this
1320 flag and your program mysteriously crashes after @code{main()} has
1321 completed, you may have an object that is being destroyed twice because
1322 two definitions were merged.
1324 This option is no longer useful on most targets, now that support has
1325 been added for putting variables into BSS without making them common.
1327 @item -fno-const-strings
1328 @opindex fno-const-strings
1329 Give string constants type @code{char *} instead of type @code{const
1330 char *}. By default, G++ uses type @code{const char *} as required by
1331 the standard. Even if you use @option{-fno-const-strings}, you cannot
1332 actually modify the value of a string constant, unless you also use
1333 @option{-fwritable-strings}.
1335 This option might be removed in a future release of G++. For maximum
1336 portability, you should structure your code so that it works with
1337 string constants that have type @code{const char *}.
1339 @item -fdollars-in-identifiers
1340 @opindex fdollars-in-identifiers
1341 Accept @samp{$} in identifiers. You can also explicitly prohibit use of
1342 @samp{$} with the option @option{-fno-dollars-in-identifiers}. (GNU C allows
1343 @samp{$} by default on most target systems, but there are a few exceptions.)
1344 Traditional C allowed the character @samp{$} to form part of
1345 identifiers. However, ISO C and C++ forbid @samp{$} in identifiers.
1347 @item -fno-elide-constructors
1348 @opindex fno-elide-constructors
1349 The C++ standard allows an implementation to omit creating a temporary
1350 which is only used to initialize another object of the same type.
1351 Specifying this option disables that optimization, and forces G++ to
1352 call the copy constructor in all cases.
1354 @item -fno-enforce-eh-specs
1355 @opindex fno-enforce-eh-specs
1356 Don't check for violation of exception specifications at runtime. This
1357 option violates the C++ standard, but may be useful for reducing code
1358 size in production builds, much like defining @samp{NDEBUG}. The compiler
1359 will still optimize based on the exception specifications.
1361 @item -fexternal-templates
1362 @opindex fexternal-templates
1364 Cause @samp{#pragma interface} and @samp{implementation} to apply to
1365 template instantiation; template instances are emitted or not according
1366 to the location of the template definition. @xref{Template
1367 Instantiation}, for more information.
1369 This option is deprecated.
1371 @item -falt-external-templates
1372 @opindex falt-external-templates
1373 Similar to @option{-fexternal-templates}, but template instances are
1374 emitted or not according to the place where they are first instantiated.
1375 @xref{Template Instantiation}, for more information.
1377 This option is deprecated.
1380 @itemx -fno-for-scope
1382 @opindex fno-for-scope
1383 If @option{-ffor-scope} is specified, the scope of variables declared in
1384 a @i{for-init-statement} is limited to the @samp{for} loop itself,
1385 as specified by the C++ standard.
1386 If @option{-fno-for-scope} is specified, the scope of variables declared in
1387 a @i{for-init-statement} extends to the end of the enclosing scope,
1388 as was the case in old versions of G++, and other (traditional)
1389 implementations of C++.
1391 The default if neither flag is given to follow the standard,
1392 but to allow and give a warning for old-style code that would
1393 otherwise be invalid, or have different behavior.
1395 @item -fno-gnu-keywords
1396 @opindex fno-gnu-keywords
1397 Do not recognize @code{typeof} as a keyword, so that code can use this
1398 word as an identifier. You can use the keyword @code{__typeof__} instead.
1399 @option{-ansi} implies @option{-fno-gnu-keywords}.
1401 @item -fno-implicit-templates
1402 @opindex fno-implicit-templates
1403 Never emit code for non-inline templates which are instantiated
1404 implicitly (i.e.@: by use); only emit code for explicit instantiations.
1405 @xref{Template Instantiation}, for more information.
1407 @item -fno-implicit-inline-templates
1408 @opindex fno-implicit-inline-templates
1409 Don't emit code for implicit instantiations of inline templates, either.
1410 The default is to handle inlines differently so that compiles with and
1411 without optimization will need the same set of explicit instantiations.
1413 @item -fno-implement-inlines
1414 @opindex fno-implement-inlines
1415 To save space, do not emit out-of-line copies of inline functions
1416 controlled by @samp{#pragma implementation}. This will cause linker
1417 errors if these functions are not inlined everywhere they are called.
1419 @item -fms-extensions
1420 @opindex fms-extensions
1421 Disable pedantic warnings about constructs used in MFC, such as implicit
1422 int and getting a pointer to member function via non-standard syntax.
1424 @item -fno-nonansi-builtins
1425 @opindex fno-nonansi-builtins
1426 Disable built-in declarations of functions that are not mandated by
1427 ANSI/ISO C@. These include @code{ffs}, @code{alloca}, @code{_exit},
1428 @code{index}, @code{bzero}, @code{conjf}, and other related functions.
1430 @item -fno-operator-names
1431 @opindex fno-operator-names
1432 Do not treat the operator name keywords @code{and}, @code{bitand},
1433 @code{bitor}, @code{compl}, @code{not}, @code{or} and @code{xor} as
1434 synonyms as keywords.
1436 @item -fno-optional-diags
1437 @opindex fno-optional-diags
1438 Disable diagnostics that the standard says a compiler does not need to
1439 issue. Currently, the only such diagnostic issued by G++ is the one for
1440 a name having multiple meanings within a class.
1443 @opindex fpermissive
1444 Downgrade messages about nonconformant code from errors to warnings. By
1445 default, G++ effectively sets @option{-pedantic-errors} without
1446 @option{-pedantic}; this option reverses that. This behavior and this
1447 option are superseded by @option{-pedantic}, which works as it does for GNU C@.
1451 Enable automatic template instantiation at link time. This option also
1452 implies @option{-fno-implicit-templates}. @xref{Template
1453 Instantiation}, for more information.
1457 Disable generation of information about every class with virtual
1458 functions for use by the C++ runtime type identification features
1459 (@samp{dynamic_cast} and @samp{typeid}). If you don't use those parts
1460 of the language, you can save some space by using this flag. Note that
1461 exception handling uses the same information, but it will generate it as
1466 Emit statistics about front-end processing at the end of the compilation.
1467 This information is generally only useful to the G++ development team.
1469 @item -ftemplate-depth-@var{n}
1470 @opindex ftemplate-depth
1471 Set the maximum instantiation depth for template classes to @var{n}.
1472 A limit on the template instantiation depth is needed to detect
1473 endless recursions during template class instantiation. ANSI/ISO C++
1474 conforming programs must not rely on a maximum depth greater than 17.
1476 @item -fuse-cxa-atexit
1477 @opindex fuse-cxa-atexit
1478 Register destructors for objects with static storage duration with the
1479 @code{__cxa_atexit} function rather than the @code{atexit} function.
1480 This option is required for fully standards-compliant handling of static
1481 destructors, but will only work if your C library supports
1482 @code{__cxa_atexit}.
1486 Emit special relocations for vtables and virtual function references
1487 so that the linker can identify unused virtual functions and zero out
1488 vtable slots that refer to them. This is most useful with
1489 @option{-ffunction-sections} and @option{-Wl,--gc-sections}, in order to
1490 also discard the functions themselves.
1492 This optimization requires GNU as and GNU ld. Not all systems support
1493 this option. @option{-Wl,--gc-sections} is ignored without @option{-static}.
1497 Do not use weak symbol support, even if it is provided by the linker.
1498 By default, G++ will use weak symbols if they are available. This
1499 option exists only for testing, and should not be used by end-users;
1500 it will result in inferior code and has no benefits. This option may
1501 be removed in a future release of G++.
1505 Do not search for header files in the standard directories specific to
1506 C++, but do still search the other standard directories. (This option
1507 is used when building the C++ library.)
1510 In addition, these optimization, warning, and code generation options
1511 have meanings only for C++ programs:
1514 @item -fno-default-inline
1515 @opindex fno-default-inline
1516 Do not assume @samp{inline} for functions defined inside a class scope.
1517 @xref{Optimize Options,,Options That Control Optimization}. Note that these
1518 functions will have linkage like inline functions; they just won't be
1521 @item -Wabi @r{(C++ only)}
1523 Warn when G++ generates code that is probably not compatible with the
1524 vendor-neutral C++ ABI. Although an effort has been made to warn about
1525 all such cases, there are probably some cases that are not warned about,
1526 even though G++ is generating incompatible code. There may also be
1527 cases where warnings are emitted even though the code that is generated
1530 You should rewrite your code to avoid these warnings if you are
1531 concerned about the fact that code generated by G++ may not be binary
1532 compatible with code generated by other compilers.
1534 The known incompatibilities at this point include:
1539 Incorrect handling of tail-padding for bit-fields. G++ may attempt to
1540 pack data into the same byte as a base class. For example:
1543 struct A @{ virtual void f(); int f1 : 1; @};
1544 struct B : public A @{ int f2 : 1; @};
1548 In this case, G++ will place @code{B::f2} into the same byte
1549 as@code{A::f1}; other compilers will not. You can avoid this problem
1550 by explicitly padding @code{A} so that its size is a multiple of the
1551 byte size on your platform; that will cause G++ and other compilers to
1552 layout @code{B} identically.
1555 Incorrect handling of tail-padding for virtual bases. G++ does not use
1556 tail padding when laying out virtual bases. For example:
1559 struct A @{ virtual void f(); char c1; @};
1560 struct B @{ B(); char c2; @};
1561 struct C : public A, public virtual B @{@};
1565 In this case, G++ will not place @code{B} into the tail-padding for
1566 @code{A}; other compilers will. You can avoid this problem by
1567 explicitly padding @code{A} so that its size is a multiple of its
1568 alignment (ignoring virtual base classes); that will cause G++ and other
1569 compilers to layout @code{C} identically.
1572 Incorrect handling of bit-fields with declared widths greater than that
1573 of their underlying types, when the bit-fields appear in a union. For
1577 union U @{ int i : 4096; @};
1581 Assuming that an @code{int} does not have 4096 bits, G++ will make the
1582 union too small by the number of bits in an @code{int}.
1585 Empty classes can be placed at incorrect offsets. For example:
1595 struct C : public B, public A @{@};
1599 G++ will place the @code{A} base class of @code{C} at a nonzero offset;
1600 it should be placed at offset zero. G++ mistakenly believes that the
1601 @code{A} data member of @code{B} is already at offset zero.
1604 Names of template functions whose types involve @code{typename} or
1605 template template parameters can be mangled incorrectly.
1608 template <typename Q>
1609 void f(typename Q::X) @{@}
1611 template <template <typename> class Q>
1612 void f(typename Q<int>::X) @{@}
1616 Instantiations of these templates may be mangled incorrectly.
1620 @item -Wctor-dtor-privacy @r{(C++ only)}
1621 @opindex Wctor-dtor-privacy
1622 Warn when a class seems unusable, because all the constructors or
1623 destructors in a class are private and the class has no friends or
1624 public static member functions. This warning is enabled by default.
1626 @item -Wnon-virtual-dtor @r{(C++ only)}
1627 @opindex Wnon-virtual-dtor
1628 Warn when a class declares a non-virtual destructor that should probably
1629 be virtual, because it looks like the class will be used polymorphically.
1630 This warning is enabled by @option{-Wall}.
1632 @item -Wreorder @r{(C++ only)}
1634 @cindex reordering, warning
1635 @cindex warning for reordering of member initializers
1636 Warn when the order of member initializers given in the code does not
1637 match the order in which they must be executed. For instance:
1643 A(): j (0), i (1) @{ @}
1647 Here the compiler will warn that the member initializers for @samp{i}
1648 and @samp{j} will be rearranged to match the declaration order of the
1649 members. This warning is enabled by @option{-Wall}.
1652 The following @option{-W@dots{}} options are not affected by @option{-Wall}.
1655 @item -Weffc++ @r{(C++ only)}
1657 Warn about violations of the following style guidelines from Scott Meyers'
1658 @cite{Effective C++} book:
1662 Item 11: Define a copy constructor and an assignment operator for classes
1663 with dynamically allocated memory.
1666 Item 12: Prefer initialization to assignment in constructors.
1669 Item 14: Make destructors virtual in base classes.
1672 Item 15: Have @code{operator=} return a reference to @code{*this}.
1675 Item 23: Don't try to return a reference when you must return an object.
1679 and about violations of the following style guidelines from Scott Meyers'
1680 @cite{More Effective C++} book:
1684 Item 6: Distinguish between prefix and postfix forms of increment and
1685 decrement operators.
1688 Item 7: Never overload @code{&&}, @code{||}, or @code{,}.
1692 If you use this option, you should be aware that the standard library
1693 headers do not obey all of these guidelines; you can use @samp{grep -v}
1694 to filter out those warnings.
1696 @item -Wno-deprecated @r{(C++ only)}
1697 @opindex Wno-deprecated
1698 Do not warn about usage of deprecated features. @xref{Deprecated Features}.
1700 @item -Wno-non-template-friend @r{(C++ only)}
1701 @opindex Wno-non-template-friend
1702 Disable warnings when non-templatized friend functions are declared
1703 within a template. With the advent of explicit template specification
1704 support in G++, if the name of the friend is an unqualified-id (i.e.,
1705 @samp{friend foo(int)}), the C++ language specification demands that the
1706 friend declare or define an ordinary, nontemplate function. (Section
1707 14.5.3). Before G++ implemented explicit specification, unqualified-ids
1708 could be interpreted as a particular specialization of a templatized
1709 function. Because this non-conforming behavior is no longer the default
1710 behavior for G++, @option{-Wnon-template-friend} allows the compiler to
1711 check existing code for potential trouble spots, and is on by default.
1712 This new compiler behavior can be turned off with
1713 @option{-Wno-non-template-friend} which keeps the conformant compiler code
1714 but disables the helpful warning.
1716 @item -Wold-style-cast @r{(C++ only)}
1717 @opindex Wold-style-cast
1718 Warn if an old-style (C-style) cast to a non-void type is used within
1719 a C++ program. The new-style casts (@samp{static_cast},
1720 @samp{reinterpret_cast}, and @samp{const_cast}) are less vulnerable to
1721 unintended effects, and much easier to grep for.
1723 @item -Woverloaded-virtual @r{(C++ only)}
1724 @opindex Woverloaded-virtual
1725 @cindex overloaded virtual fn, warning
1726 @cindex warning for overloaded virtual fn
1727 Warn when a function declaration hides virtual functions from a
1728 base class. For example, in:
1735 struct B: public A @{
1740 the @code{A} class version of @code{f} is hidden in @code{B}, and code
1748 will fail to compile.
1750 @item -Wno-pmf-conversions @r{(C++ only)}
1751 @opindex Wno-pmf-conversions
1752 Disable the diagnostic for converting a bound pointer to member function
1755 @item -Wsign-promo @r{(C++ only)}
1756 @opindex Wsign-promo
1757 Warn when overload resolution chooses a promotion from unsigned or
1758 enumeral type to a signed type over a conversion to an unsigned type of
1759 the same size. Previous versions of G++ would try to preserve
1760 unsignedness, but the standard mandates the current behavior.
1762 @item -Wsynth @r{(C++ only)}
1764 @cindex warning for synthesized methods
1765 @cindex synthesized methods, warning
1766 Warn when G++'s synthesis behavior does not match that of cfront. For
1772 A& operator = (int);
1782 In this example, G++ will synthesize a default @samp{A& operator =
1783 (const A&);}, while cfront will use the user-defined @samp{operator =}.
1786 @node Objective-C Dialect Options
1787 @section Options Controlling Objective-C Dialect
1789 @cindex compiler options, Objective-C
1790 @cindex Objective-C options, command line
1791 @cindex options, Objective-C
1792 This section describes the command-line options that are only meaningful
1793 for Objective-C programs; but you can also use most of the GNU compiler
1794 options regardless of what language your program is in. For example,
1795 you might compile a file @code{some_class.m} like this:
1798 gcc -g -fgnu-runtime -O -c some_class.m
1802 In this example, only @option{-fgnu-runtime} is an option meant only for
1803 Objective-C programs; you can use the other options with any language
1806 Here is a list of options that are @emph{only} for compiling Objective-C
1810 @item -fconstant-string-class=@var{class-name}
1811 @opindex fconstant-string-class
1812 Use @var{class-name} as the name of the class to instantiate for each
1813 literal string specified with the syntax @code{@@"@dots{}"}. The default
1814 class name is @code{NXConstantString}.
1817 @opindex fgnu-runtime
1818 Generate object code compatible with the standard GNU Objective-C
1819 runtime. This is the default for most types of systems.
1821 @item -fnext-runtime
1822 @opindex fnext-runtime
1823 Generate output compatible with the NeXT runtime. This is the default
1824 for NeXT-based systems, including Darwin and Mac OS X@. The macro
1825 @code{__NEXT_RUNTIME__} is predefined if (and only if) this option is
1830 Dump interface declarations for all classes seen in the source file to a
1831 file named @file{@var{sourcename}.decl}.
1834 @opindex Wno-protocol
1835 If a class is declared to implement a protocol, a warning is issued for
1836 every method in the protocol that is not implemented by the class. The
1837 default behavior is to issue a warning for every method not explicitly
1838 implemented in the class, even if a method implementation is inherited
1839 from the superclass. If you use the @code{-Wno-protocol} option, then
1840 methods inherited from the superclass are considered to be implemented,
1841 and no warning is issued for them.
1845 Warn if multiple methods of different types for the same selector are
1846 found during compilation. The check is performed on the list of methods
1847 in the final stage of compilation. Additionally, a check is performed
1848 that for each selector appearing in a @code{@@selector(@dots{})}
1849 expression, a corresponding method with that selector has been found
1850 during compilation. Because these checks scan the method table only at
1851 the end of compilation, these warnings are not produced if the final
1852 stage of compilation is not reached, for example because an error is
1853 found during compilation, or because the @code{-fsyntax-only} option is
1856 @item -Wundeclared-selector
1857 @opindex Wundeclared-selector
1858 Warn if a @code{@@selector(@dots{})} expression referring to an
1859 undeclared selector is found. A selector is considered undeclared if no
1860 method with that name has been declared (explicitly, in an
1861 @code{@@interface} or @code{@@protocol} declaration, or implicitly, in
1862 an @code{@@implementation} section) before the
1863 @code{@@selector(@dots{})} expression. This option always performs its
1864 checks as soon as a @code{@@selector(@dots{})} expression is found
1865 (while @code{-Wselector} only performs its checks in the final stage of
1866 compilation), and so additionally enforces the coding style convention
1867 that methods and selectors must be declared before being used.
1869 @c not documented because only avail via -Wp
1870 @c @item -print-objc-runtime-info
1874 @node Language Independent Options
1875 @section Options to Control Diagnostic Messages Formatting
1876 @cindex options to control diagnostics formatting
1877 @cindex diagnostic messages
1878 @cindex message formatting
1880 Traditionally, diagnostic messages have been formatted irrespective of
1881 the output device's aspect (e.g.@: its width, @dots{}). The options described
1882 below can be used to control the diagnostic messages formatting
1883 algorithm, e.g.@: how many characters per line, how often source location
1884 information should be reported. Right now, only the C++ front end can
1885 honor these options. However it is expected, in the near future, that
1886 the remaining front ends would be able to digest them correctly.
1889 @item -fmessage-length=@var{n}
1890 @opindex fmessage-length
1891 Try to format error messages so that they fit on lines of about @var{n}
1892 characters. The default is 72 characters for @command{g++} and 0 for the rest of
1893 the front ends supported by GCC@. If @var{n} is zero, then no
1894 line-wrapping will be done; each error message will appear on a single
1897 @opindex fdiagnostics-show-location
1898 @item -fdiagnostics-show-location=once
1899 Only meaningful in line-wrapping mode. Instructs the diagnostic messages
1900 reporter to emit @emph{once} source location information; that is, in
1901 case the message is too long to fit on a single physical line and has to
1902 be wrapped, the source location won't be emitted (as prefix) again,
1903 over and over, in subsequent continuation lines. This is the default
1906 @item -fdiagnostics-show-location=every-line
1907 Only meaningful in line-wrapping mode. Instructs the diagnostic
1908 messages reporter to emit the same source location information (as
1909 prefix) for physical lines that result from the process of breaking
1910 a message which is too long to fit on a single line.
1914 @node Warning Options
1915 @section Options to Request or Suppress Warnings
1916 @cindex options to control warnings
1917 @cindex warning messages
1918 @cindex messages, warning
1919 @cindex suppressing warnings
1921 Warnings are diagnostic messages that report constructions which
1922 are not inherently erroneous but which are risky or suggest there
1923 may have been an error.
1925 You can request many specific warnings with options beginning @samp{-W},
1926 for example @option{-Wimplicit} to request warnings on implicit
1927 declarations. Each of these specific warning options also has a
1928 negative form beginning @samp{-Wno-} to turn off warnings;
1929 for example, @option{-Wno-implicit}. This manual lists only one of the
1930 two forms, whichever is not the default.
1932 The following options control the amount and kinds of warnings produced
1933 by GCC; for further, language-specific options also refer to
1934 @ref{C++ Dialect Options} and @ref{Objective-C Dialect Options}.
1937 @cindex syntax checking
1939 @opindex fsyntax-only
1940 Check the code for syntax errors, but don't do anything beyond that.
1944 Issue all the warnings demanded by strict ISO C and ISO C++;
1945 reject all programs that use forbidden extensions, and some other
1946 programs that do not follow ISO C and ISO C++. For ISO C, follows the
1947 version of the ISO C standard specified by any @option{-std} option used.
1949 Valid ISO C and ISO C++ programs should compile properly with or without
1950 this option (though a rare few will require @option{-ansi} or a
1951 @option{-std} option specifying the required version of ISO C)@. However,
1952 without this option, certain GNU extensions and traditional C and C++
1953 features are supported as well. With this option, they are rejected.
1955 @option{-pedantic} does not cause warning messages for use of the
1956 alternate keywords whose names begin and end with @samp{__}. Pedantic
1957 warnings are also disabled in the expression that follows
1958 @code{__extension__}. However, only system header files should use
1959 these escape routes; application programs should avoid them.
1960 @xref{Alternate Keywords}.
1962 Some users try to use @option{-pedantic} to check programs for strict ISO
1963 C conformance. They soon find that it does not do quite what they want:
1964 it finds some non-ISO practices, but not all---only those for which
1965 ISO C @emph{requires} a diagnostic, and some others for which
1966 diagnostics have been added.
1968 A feature to report any failure to conform to ISO C might be useful in
1969 some instances, but would require considerable additional work and would
1970 be quite different from @option{-pedantic}. We don't have plans to
1971 support such a feature in the near future.
1973 Where the standard specified with @option{-std} represents a GNU
1974 extended dialect of C, such as @samp{gnu89} or @samp{gnu99}, there is a
1975 corresponding @dfn{base standard}, the version of ISO C on which the GNU
1976 extended dialect is based. Warnings from @option{-pedantic} are given
1977 where they are required by the base standard. (It would not make sense
1978 for such warnings to be given only for features not in the specified GNU
1979 C dialect, since by definition the GNU dialects of C include all
1980 features the compiler supports with the given option, and there would be
1981 nothing to warn about.)
1983 @item -pedantic-errors
1984 @opindex pedantic-errors
1985 Like @option{-pedantic}, except that errors are produced rather than
1990 Inhibit all warning messages.
1994 Inhibit warning messages about the use of @samp{#import}.
1996 @item -Wchar-subscripts
1997 @opindex Wchar-subscripts
1998 Warn if an array subscript has type @code{char}. This is a common cause
1999 of error, as programmers often forget that this type is signed on some
2004 Warn whenever a comment-start sequence @samp{/*} appears in a @samp{/*}
2005 comment, or whenever a Backslash-Newline appears in a @samp{//} comment.
2009 Check calls to @code{printf} and @code{scanf}, etc., to make sure that
2010 the arguments supplied have types appropriate to the format string
2011 specified, and that the conversions specified in the format string make
2012 sense. This includes standard functions, and others specified by format
2013 attributes (@pxref{Function Attributes}), in the @code{printf},
2014 @code{scanf}, @code{strftime} and @code{strfmon} (an X/Open extension,
2015 not in the C standard) families.
2017 The formats are checked against the format features supported by GNU
2018 libc version 2.2. These include all ISO C90 and C99 features, as well
2019 as features from the Single Unix Specification and some BSD and GNU
2020 extensions. Other library implementations may not support all these
2021 features; GCC does not support warning about features that go beyond a
2022 particular library's limitations. However, if @option{-pedantic} is used
2023 with @option{-Wformat}, warnings will be given about format features not
2024 in the selected standard version (but not for @code{strfmon} formats,
2025 since those are not in any version of the C standard). @xref{C Dialect
2026 Options,,Options Controlling C Dialect}.
2028 Since @option{-Wformat} also checks for null format arguments for
2029 several functions, @option{-Wformat} also implies @option{-Wnonnull}.
2031 @option{-Wformat} is included in @option{-Wall}. For more control over some
2032 aspects of format checking, the options @option{-Wno-format-y2k},
2033 @option{-Wno-format-extra-args}, @option{-Wno-format-zero-length},
2034 @option{-Wformat-nonliteral}, @option{-Wformat-security}, and
2035 @option{-Wformat=2} are available, but are not included in @option{-Wall}.
2037 @item -Wno-format-y2k
2038 @opindex Wno-format-y2k
2039 If @option{-Wformat} is specified, do not warn about @code{strftime}
2040 formats which may yield only a two-digit year.
2042 @item -Wno-format-extra-args
2043 @opindex Wno-format-extra-args
2044 If @option{-Wformat} is specified, do not warn about excess arguments to a
2045 @code{printf} or @code{scanf} format function. The C standard specifies
2046 that such arguments are ignored.
2048 Where the unused arguments lie between used arguments that are
2049 specified with @samp{$} operand number specifications, normally
2050 warnings are still given, since the implementation could not know what
2051 type to pass to @code{va_arg} to skip the unused arguments. However,
2052 in the case of @code{scanf} formats, this option will suppress the
2053 warning if the unused arguments are all pointers, since the Single
2054 Unix Specification says that such unused arguments are allowed.
2056 @item -Wno-format-zero-length
2057 @opindex Wno-format-zero-length
2058 If @option{-Wformat} is specified, do not warn about zero-length formats.
2059 The C standard specifies that zero-length formats are allowed.
2061 @item -Wformat-nonliteral
2062 @opindex Wformat-nonliteral
2063 If @option{-Wformat} is specified, also warn if the format string is not a
2064 string literal and so cannot be checked, unless the format function
2065 takes its format arguments as a @code{va_list}.
2067 @item -Wformat-security
2068 @opindex Wformat-security
2069 If @option{-Wformat} is specified, also warn about uses of format
2070 functions that represent possible security problems. At present, this
2071 warns about calls to @code{printf} and @code{scanf} functions where the
2072 format string is not a string literal and there are no format arguments,
2073 as in @code{printf (foo);}. This may be a security hole if the format
2074 string came from untrusted input and contains @samp{%n}. (This is
2075 currently a subset of what @option{-Wformat-nonliteral} warns about, but
2076 in future warnings may be added to @option{-Wformat-security} that are not
2077 included in @option{-Wformat-nonliteral}.)
2081 Enable @option{-Wformat} plus format checks not included in
2082 @option{-Wformat}. Currently equivalent to @samp{-Wformat
2083 -Wformat-nonliteral -Wformat-security}.
2087 Enable warning about passing a null pointer for arguments marked as
2088 requiring a non-null value by the @code{nonnull} function attribute.
2090 @option{-Wnonnull} is included in @option{-Wall} and @option{-Wformat}. It
2091 can be disabled with the @option{-Wno-nonnull} option.
2093 @item -Wimplicit-int
2094 @opindex Wimplicit-int
2095 Warn when a declaration does not specify a type.
2097 @item -Wimplicit-function-declaration
2098 @itemx -Werror-implicit-function-declaration
2099 @opindex Wimplicit-function-declaration
2100 @opindex Werror-implicit-function-declaration
2101 Give a warning (or error) whenever a function is used before being
2106 Same as @option{-Wimplicit-int} and @option{-Wimplicit-function-declaration}.
2110 Warn if the type of @samp{main} is suspicious. @samp{main} should be a
2111 function with external linkage, returning int, taking either zero
2112 arguments, two, or three arguments of appropriate types.
2114 @item -Wmissing-braces
2115 @opindex Wmissing-braces
2116 Warn if an aggregate or union initializer is not fully bracketed. In
2117 the following example, the initializer for @samp{a} is not fully
2118 bracketed, but that for @samp{b} is fully bracketed.
2121 int a[2][2] = @{ 0, 1, 2, 3 @};
2122 int b[2][2] = @{ @{ 0, 1 @}, @{ 2, 3 @} @};
2126 @opindex Wparentheses
2127 Warn if parentheses are omitted in certain contexts, such
2128 as when there is an assignment in a context where a truth value
2129 is expected, or when operators are nested whose precedence people
2130 often get confused about.
2132 Also warn about constructions where there may be confusion to which
2133 @code{if} statement an @code{else} branch belongs. Here is an example of
2148 In C, every @code{else} branch belongs to the innermost possible @code{if}
2149 statement, which in this example is @code{if (b)}. This is often not
2150 what the programmer expected, as illustrated in the above example by
2151 indentation the programmer chose. When there is the potential for this
2152 confusion, GCC will issue a warning when this flag is specified.
2153 To eliminate the warning, add explicit braces around the innermost
2154 @code{if} statement so there is no way the @code{else} could belong to
2155 the enclosing @code{if}. The resulting code would look like this:
2171 @item -Wsequence-point
2172 @opindex Wsequence-point
2173 Warn about code that may have undefined semantics because of violations
2174 of sequence point rules in the C standard.
2176 The C standard defines the order in which expressions in a C program are
2177 evaluated in terms of @dfn{sequence points}, which represent a partial
2178 ordering between the execution of parts of the program: those executed
2179 before the sequence point, and those executed after it. These occur
2180 after the evaluation of a full expression (one which is not part of a
2181 larger expression), after the evaluation of the first operand of a
2182 @code{&&}, @code{||}, @code{? :} or @code{,} (comma) operator, before a
2183 function is called (but after the evaluation of its arguments and the
2184 expression denoting the called function), and in certain other places.
2185 Other than as expressed by the sequence point rules, the order of
2186 evaluation of subexpressions of an expression is not specified. All
2187 these rules describe only a partial order rather than a total order,
2188 since, for example, if two functions are called within one expression
2189 with no sequence point between them, the order in which the functions
2190 are called is not specified. However, the standards committee have
2191 ruled that function calls do not overlap.
2193 It is not specified when between sequence points modifications to the
2194 values of objects take effect. Programs whose behavior depends on this
2195 have undefined behavior; the C standard specifies that ``Between the
2196 previous and next sequence point an object shall have its stored value
2197 modified at most once by the evaluation of an expression. Furthermore,
2198 the prior value shall be read only to determine the value to be
2199 stored.''. If a program breaks these rules, the results on any
2200 particular implementation are entirely unpredictable.
2202 Examples of code with undefined behavior are @code{a = a++;}, @code{a[n]
2203 = b[n++]} and @code{a[i++] = i;}. Some more complicated cases are not
2204 diagnosed by this option, and it may give an occasional false positive
2205 result, but in general it has been found fairly effective at detecting
2206 this sort of problem in programs.
2208 The present implementation of this option only works for C programs. A
2209 future implementation may also work for C++ programs.
2211 The C standard is worded confusingly, therefore there is some debate
2212 over the precise meaning of the sequence point rules in subtle cases.
2213 Links to discussions of the problem, including proposed formal
2214 definitions, may be found on our readings page, at
2215 @w{@uref{http://gcc.gnu.org/readings.html}}.
2218 @opindex Wreturn-type
2219 Warn whenever a function is defined with a return-type that defaults to
2220 @code{int}. Also warn about any @code{return} statement with no
2221 return-value in a function whose return-type is not @code{void}.
2223 For C++, a function without return type always produces a diagnostic
2224 message, even when @option{-Wno-return-type} is specified. The only
2225 exceptions are @samp{main} and functions defined in system headers.
2229 Warn whenever a @code{switch} statement has an index of enumeral type
2230 and lacks a @code{case} for one or more of the named codes of that
2231 enumeration. (The presence of a @code{default} label prevents this
2232 warning.) @code{case} labels outside the enumeration range also
2233 provoke warnings when this option is used.
2235 @item -Wswitch-default
2236 @opindex Wswitch-switch
2237 Warn whenever a @code{switch} statement does not have a @code{default}
2241 @opindex Wswitch-enum
2242 Warn whenever a @code{switch} statement has an index of enumeral type
2243 and lacks a @code{case} for one or more of the named codes of that
2244 enumeration. @code{case} labels outside the enumeration range also
2245 provoke warnings when this option is used.
2249 Warn if any trigraphs are encountered that might change the meaning of
2250 the program (trigraphs within comments are not warned about).
2252 @item -Wunused-function
2253 @opindex Wunused-function
2254 Warn whenever a static function is declared but not defined or a
2255 non\-inline static function is unused.
2257 @item -Wunused-label
2258 @opindex Wunused-label
2259 Warn whenever a label is declared but not used.
2261 To suppress this warning use the @samp{unused} attribute
2262 (@pxref{Variable Attributes}).
2264 @item -Wunused-parameter
2265 @opindex Wunused-parameter
2266 Warn whenever a function parameter is unused aside from its declaration.
2268 To suppress this warning use the @samp{unused} attribute
2269 (@pxref{Variable Attributes}).
2271 @item -Wunused-variable
2272 @opindex Wunused-variable
2273 Warn whenever a local variable or non-constant static variable is unused
2274 aside from its declaration
2276 To suppress this warning use the @samp{unused} attribute
2277 (@pxref{Variable Attributes}).
2279 @item -Wunused-value
2280 @opindex Wunused-value
2281 Warn whenever a statement computes a result that is explicitly not used.
2283 To suppress this warning cast the expression to @samp{void}.
2287 All the above @option{-Wunused} options combined.
2289 In order to get a warning about an unused function parameter, you must
2290 either specify @samp{-Wextra -Wunused} (note that @samp{-Wall} implies
2291 @samp{-Wunused}), or separately specify @option{-Wunused-parameter}.
2293 @item -Wuninitialized
2294 @opindex Wuninitialized
2295 Warn if an automatic variable is used without first being initialized or
2296 if a variable may be clobbered by a @code{setjmp} call.
2298 These warnings are possible only in optimizing compilation,
2299 because they require data flow information that is computed only
2300 when optimizing. If you don't specify @option{-O}, you simply won't
2303 These warnings occur only for variables that are candidates for
2304 register allocation. Therefore, they do not occur for a variable that
2305 is declared @code{volatile}, or whose address is taken, or whose size
2306 is other than 1, 2, 4 or 8 bytes. Also, they do not occur for
2307 structures, unions or arrays, even when they are in registers.
2309 Note that there may be no warning about a variable that is used only
2310 to compute a value that itself is never used, because such
2311 computations may be deleted by data flow analysis before the warnings
2314 These warnings are made optional because GCC is not smart
2315 enough to see all the reasons why the code might be correct
2316 despite appearing to have an error. Here is one example of how
2337 If the value of @code{y} is always 1, 2 or 3, then @code{x} is
2338 always initialized, but GCC doesn't know this. Here is
2339 another common case:
2344 if (change_y) save_y = y, y = new_y;
2346 if (change_y) y = save_y;
2351 This has no bug because @code{save_y} is used only if it is set.
2353 @cindex @code{longjmp} warnings
2354 This option also warns when a non-volatile automatic variable might be
2355 changed by a call to @code{longjmp}. These warnings as well are possible
2356 only in optimizing compilation.
2358 The compiler sees only the calls to @code{setjmp}. It cannot know
2359 where @code{longjmp} will be called; in fact, a signal handler could
2360 call it at any point in the code. As a result, you may get a warning
2361 even when there is in fact no problem because @code{longjmp} cannot
2362 in fact be called at the place which would cause a problem.
2364 Some spurious warnings can be avoided if you declare all the functions
2365 you use that never return as @code{noreturn}. @xref{Function
2368 @item -Wunknown-pragmas
2369 @opindex Wunknown-pragmas
2370 @cindex warning for unknown pragmas
2371 @cindex unknown pragmas, warning
2372 @cindex pragmas, warning of unknown
2373 Warn when a #pragma directive is encountered which is not understood by
2374 GCC@. If this command line option is used, warnings will even be issued
2375 for unknown pragmas in system header files. This is not the case if
2376 the warnings were only enabled by the @option{-Wall} command line option.
2378 @item -Wstrict-aliasing
2379 @opindex Wstrict-aliasing
2380 This option is only active when @option{-fstrict-aliasing} is active.
2381 It warns about code which might break the strict aliasing rules that the
2382 compiler is using for optimization. The warning does not catch all
2383 cases, but does attempt to catch the more common pitfalls. It is
2384 included in @option{-Wall}.
2388 All of the above @samp{-W} options combined. This enables all the
2389 warnings about constructions that some users consider questionable, and
2390 that are easy to avoid (or modify to prevent the warning), even in
2391 conjunction with macros. This also enables some language-specific
2392 warnings described in @ref{C++ Dialect Options} and
2393 @ref{Objective-C Dialect Options}.
2396 The following @option{-W@dots{}} options are not implied by @option{-Wall}.
2397 Some of them warn about constructions that users generally do not
2398 consider questionable, but which occasionally you might wish to check
2399 for; others warn about constructions that are necessary or hard to avoid
2400 in some cases, and there is no simple way to modify the code to suppress
2407 (This option used to be called @option{-W}. The older name is still
2408 supported, but the newer name is more descriptive.) Print extra warning
2409 messages for these events:
2413 A function can return either with or without a value. (Falling
2414 off the end of the function body is considered returning without
2415 a value.) For example, this function would evoke such a
2429 An expression-statement or the left-hand side of a comma expression
2430 contains no side effects.
2431 To suppress the warning, cast the unused expression to void.
2432 For example, an expression such as @samp{x[i,j]} will cause a warning,
2433 but @samp{x[(void)i,j]} will not.
2436 An unsigned value is compared against zero with @samp{<} or @samp{>=}.
2439 A comparison like @samp{x<=y<=z} appears; this is equivalent to
2440 @samp{(x<=y ? 1 : 0) <= z}, which is a different interpretation from
2441 that of ordinary mathematical notation.
2444 Storage-class specifiers like @code{static} are not the first things in
2445 a declaration. According to the C Standard, this usage is obsolescent.
2448 The return type of a function has a type qualifier such as @code{const}.
2449 Such a type qualifier has no effect, since the value returned by a
2450 function is not an lvalue. (But don't warn about the GNU extension of
2451 @code{volatile void} return types. That extension will be warned about
2452 if @option{-pedantic} is specified.)
2455 If @option{-Wall} or @option{-Wunused} is also specified, warn about unused
2459 A comparison between signed and unsigned values could produce an
2460 incorrect result when the signed value is converted to unsigned.
2461 (But don't warn if @option{-Wno-sign-compare} is also specified.)
2464 An aggregate has an initializer which does not initialize all members.
2465 For example, the following code would cause such a warning, because
2466 @code{x.h} would be implicitly initialized to zero:
2469 struct s @{ int f, g, h; @};
2470 struct s x = @{ 3, 4 @};
2474 A function parameter is declared without a type specifier in K&R-style
2482 An empty body occurs in an @samp{if} or @samp{else} statement.
2485 A pointer is compared against integer zero with @samp{<}, @samp{<=},
2486 @samp{>}, or @samp{>=}.
2489 A variable might be changed by @samp{longjmp} or @samp{vfork}.
2492 Any of several floating-point events that often indicate errors, such as
2493 overflow, underflow, loss of precision, etc.
2495 @item @r{(C++ only)}
2496 An enumerator and a non-enumerator both appear in a conditional expression.
2498 @item @r{(C++ only)}
2499 A non-static reference or non-static @samp{const} member appears in a
2500 class without constructors.
2502 @item @r{(C++ only)}
2503 Ambiguous virtual bases.
2505 @item @r{(C++ only)}
2506 Subscripting an array which has been declared @samp{register}.
2508 @item @r{(C++ only)}
2509 Taking the address of a variable which has been declared @samp{register}.
2511 @item @r{(C++ only)}
2512 A base class is not initialized in a derived class' copy constrcutor.
2515 @item -Wno-div-by-zero
2516 @opindex Wno-div-by-zero
2517 @opindex Wdiv-by-zero
2518 Do not warn about compile-time integer division by zero. Floating point
2519 division by zero is not warned about, as it can be a legitimate way of
2520 obtaining infinities and NaNs.
2522 @item -Wsystem-headers
2523 @opindex Wsystem-headers
2524 @cindex warnings from system headers
2525 @cindex system headers, warnings from
2526 Print warning messages for constructs found in system header files.
2527 Warnings from system headers are normally suppressed, on the assumption
2528 that they usually do not indicate real problems and would only make the
2529 compiler output harder to read. Using this command line option tells
2530 GCC to emit warnings from system headers as if they occurred in user
2531 code. However, note that using @option{-Wall} in conjunction with this
2532 option will @emph{not} warn about unknown pragmas in system
2533 headers---for that, @option{-Wunknown-pragmas} must also be used.
2536 @opindex Wfloat-equal
2537 Warn if floating point values are used in equality comparisons.
2539 The idea behind this is that sometimes it is convenient (for the
2540 programmer) to consider floating-point values as approximations to
2541 infinitely precise real numbers. If you are doing this, then you need
2542 to compute (by analyzing the code, or in some other way) the maximum or
2543 likely maximum error that the computation introduces, and allow for it
2544 when performing comparisons (and when producing output, but that's a
2545 different problem). In particular, instead of testing for equality, you
2546 would check to see whether the two values have ranges that overlap; and
2547 this is done with the relational operators, so equality comparisons are
2550 @item -Wtraditional @r{(C only)}
2551 @opindex Wtraditional
2552 Warn about certain constructs that behave differently in traditional and
2553 ISO C@. Also warn about ISO C constructs that have no traditional C
2554 equivalent, and/or problematic constructs which should be avoided.
2558 Macro parameters that appear within string literals in the macro body.
2559 In traditional C macro replacement takes place within string literals,
2560 but does not in ISO C@.
2563 In traditional C, some preprocessor directives did not exist.
2564 Traditional preprocessors would only consider a line to be a directive
2565 if the @samp{#} appeared in column 1 on the line. Therefore
2566 @option{-Wtraditional} warns about directives that traditional C
2567 understands but would ignore because the @samp{#} does not appear as the
2568 first character on the line. It also suggests you hide directives like
2569 @samp{#pragma} not understood by traditional C by indenting them. Some
2570 traditional implementations would not recognize @samp{#elif}, so it
2571 suggests avoiding it altogether.
2574 A function-like macro that appears without arguments.
2577 The unary plus operator.
2580 The @samp{U} integer constant suffix, or the @samp{F} or @samp{L} floating point
2581 constant suffixes. (Traditional C does support the @samp{L} suffix on integer
2582 constants.) Note, these suffixes appear in macros defined in the system
2583 headers of most modern systems, e.g.@: the @samp{_MIN}/@samp{_MAX} macros in @code{<limits.h>}.
2584 Use of these macros in user code might normally lead to spurious
2585 warnings, however gcc's integrated preprocessor has enough context to
2586 avoid warning in these cases.
2589 A function declared external in one block and then used after the end of
2593 A @code{switch} statement has an operand of type @code{long}.
2596 A non-@code{static} function declaration follows a @code{static} one.
2597 This construct is not accepted by some traditional C compilers.
2600 The ISO type of an integer constant has a different width or
2601 signedness from its traditional type. This warning is only issued if
2602 the base of the constant is ten. I.e.@: hexadecimal or octal values, which
2603 typically represent bit patterns, are not warned about.
2606 Usage of ISO string concatenation is detected.
2609 Initialization of automatic aggregates.
2612 Identifier conflicts with labels. Traditional C lacks a separate
2613 namespace for labels.
2616 Initialization of unions. If the initializer is zero, the warning is
2617 omitted. This is done under the assumption that the zero initializer in
2618 user code appears conditioned on e.g.@: @code{__STDC__} to avoid missing
2619 initializer warnings and relies on default initialization to zero in the
2623 Conversions by prototypes between fixed/floating point values and vice
2624 versa. The absence of these prototypes when compiling with traditional
2625 C would cause serious problems. This is a subset of the possible
2626 conversion warnings, for the full set use @option{-Wconversion}.
2629 Use of ISO C style function definitions. This warning intentionally is
2630 @emph{not} issued for prototype declarations or variadic functions
2631 because these ISO C features will appear in your code when using
2632 libiberty's traditional C compatibility macros, @code{PARAMS} and
2633 @code{VPARAMS}. This warning is also bypassed for nested functions
2634 because that feature is already a gcc extension and thus not relevant to
2635 traditional C compatibility.
2640 Warn if an undefined identifier is evaluated in an @samp{#if} directive.
2642 @item -Wendif-labels
2643 @opindex Wendif-labels
2644 Warn whenever an @samp{#else} or an @samp{#endif} are followed by text.
2648 Warn whenever a local variable shadows another local variable, parameter or
2649 global variable or whenever a built-in function is shadowed.
2651 @item -Wlarger-than-@var{len}
2652 @opindex Wlarger-than
2653 Warn whenever an object of larger than @var{len} bytes is defined.
2655 @item -Wpointer-arith
2656 @opindex Wpointer-arith
2657 Warn about anything that depends on the ``size of'' a function type or
2658 of @code{void}. GNU C assigns these types a size of 1, for
2659 convenience in calculations with @code{void *} pointers and pointers
2662 @item -Wbad-function-cast @r{(C only)}
2663 @opindex Wbad-function-cast
2664 Warn whenever a function call is cast to a non-matching type.
2665 For example, warn if @code{int malloc()} is cast to @code{anything *}.
2669 Warn whenever a pointer is cast so as to remove a type qualifier from
2670 the target type. For example, warn if a @code{const char *} is cast
2671 to an ordinary @code{char *}.
2674 @opindex Wcast-align
2675 Warn whenever a pointer is cast such that the required alignment of the
2676 target is increased. For example, warn if a @code{char *} is cast to
2677 an @code{int *} on machines where integers can only be accessed at
2678 two- or four-byte boundaries.
2680 @item -Wwrite-strings
2681 @opindex Wwrite-strings
2682 When compiling C, give string constants the type @code{const
2683 char[@var{length}]} so that
2684 copying the address of one into a non-@code{const} @code{char *}
2685 pointer will get a warning; when compiling C++, warn about the
2686 deprecated conversion from string constants to @code{char *}.
2687 These warnings will help you find at
2688 compile time code that can try to write into a string constant, but
2689 only if you have been very careful about using @code{const} in
2690 declarations and prototypes. Otherwise, it will just be a nuisance;
2691 this is why we did not make @option{-Wall} request these warnings.
2694 @opindex Wconversion
2695 Warn if a prototype causes a type conversion that is different from what
2696 would happen to the same argument in the absence of a prototype. This
2697 includes conversions of fixed point to floating and vice versa, and
2698 conversions changing the width or signedness of a fixed point argument
2699 except when the same as the default promotion.
2701 Also, warn if a negative integer constant expression is implicitly
2702 converted to an unsigned type. For example, warn about the assignment
2703 @code{x = -1} if @code{x} is unsigned. But do not warn about explicit
2704 casts like @code{(unsigned) -1}.
2706 @item -Wsign-compare
2707 @opindex Wsign-compare
2708 @cindex warning for comparison of signed and unsigned values
2709 @cindex comparison of signed and unsigned values, warning
2710 @cindex signed and unsigned values, comparison warning
2711 Warn when a comparison between signed and unsigned values could produce
2712 an incorrect result when the signed value is converted to unsigned.
2713 This warning is also enabled by @option{-Wextra}; to get the other warnings
2714 of @option{-Wextra} without this warning, use @samp{-Wextra -Wno-sign-compare}.
2716 @item -Waggregate-return
2717 @opindex Waggregate-return
2718 Warn if any functions that return structures or unions are defined or
2719 called. (In languages where you can return an array, this also elicits
2722 @item -Wstrict-prototypes @r{(C only)}
2723 @opindex Wstrict-prototypes
2724 Warn if a function is declared or defined without specifying the
2725 argument types. (An old-style function definition is permitted without
2726 a warning if preceded by a declaration which specifies the argument
2729 @item -Wmissing-prototypes @r{(C only)}
2730 @opindex Wmissing-prototypes
2731 Warn if a global function is defined without a previous prototype
2732 declaration. This warning is issued even if the definition itself
2733 provides a prototype. The aim is to detect global functions that fail
2734 to be declared in header files.
2736 @item -Wmissing-declarations
2737 @opindex Wmissing-declarations
2738 Warn if a global function is defined without a previous declaration.
2739 Do so even if the definition itself provides a prototype.
2740 Use this option to detect global functions that are not declared in
2743 @item -Wmissing-noreturn
2744 @opindex Wmissing-noreturn
2745 Warn about functions which might be candidates for attribute @code{noreturn}.
2746 Note these are only possible candidates, not absolute ones. Care should
2747 be taken to manually verify functions actually do not ever return before
2748 adding the @code{noreturn} attribute, otherwise subtle code generation
2749 bugs could be introduced. You will not get a warning for @code{main} in
2750 hosted C environments.
2752 @item -Wmissing-format-attribute
2753 @opindex Wmissing-format-attribute
2755 If @option{-Wformat} is enabled, also warn about functions which might be
2756 candidates for @code{format} attributes. Note these are only possible
2757 candidates, not absolute ones. GCC will guess that @code{format}
2758 attributes might be appropriate for any function that calls a function
2759 like @code{vprintf} or @code{vscanf}, but this might not always be the
2760 case, and some functions for which @code{format} attributes are
2761 appropriate may not be detected. This option has no effect unless
2762 @option{-Wformat} is enabled (possibly by @option{-Wall}).
2764 @item -Wno-multichar
2765 @opindex Wno-multichar
2767 Do not warn if a multicharacter constant (@samp{'FOOF'}) is used.
2768 Usually they indicate a typo in the user's code, as they have
2769 implementation-defined values, and should not be used in portable code.
2771 @item -Wno-deprecated-declarations
2772 @opindex Wno-deprecated-declarations
2773 Do not warn about uses of functions, variables, and types marked as
2774 deprecated by using the @code{deprecated} attribute.
2775 (@pxref{Function Attributes}, @pxref{Variable Attributes},
2776 @pxref{Type Attributes}.)
2780 Warn if a structure is given the packed attribute, but the packed
2781 attribute has no effect on the layout or size of the structure.
2782 Such structures may be mis-aligned for little benefit. For
2783 instance, in this code, the variable @code{f.x} in @code{struct bar}
2784 will be misaligned even though @code{struct bar} does not itself
2785 have the packed attribute:
2792 @} __attribute__((packed));
2802 Warn if padding is included in a structure, either to align an element
2803 of the structure or to align the whole structure. Sometimes when this
2804 happens it is possible to rearrange the fields of the structure to
2805 reduce the padding and so make the structure smaller.
2807 @item -Wredundant-decls
2808 @opindex Wredundant-decls
2809 Warn if anything is declared more than once in the same scope, even in
2810 cases where multiple declaration is valid and changes nothing.
2812 @item -Wnested-externs @r{(C only)}
2813 @opindex Wnested-externs
2814 Warn if an @code{extern} declaration is encountered within a function.
2816 @item -Wunreachable-code
2817 @opindex Wunreachable-code
2818 Warn if the compiler detects that code will never be executed.
2820 This option is intended to warn when the compiler detects that at
2821 least a whole line of source code will never be executed, because
2822 some condition is never satisfied or because it is after a
2823 procedure that never returns.
2825 It is possible for this option to produce a warning even though there
2826 are circumstances under which part of the affected line can be executed,
2827 so care should be taken when removing apparently-unreachable code.
2829 For instance, when a function is inlined, a warning may mean that the
2830 line is unreachable in only one inlined copy of the function.
2832 This option is not made part of @option{-Wall} because in a debugging
2833 version of a program there is often substantial code which checks
2834 correct functioning of the program and is, hopefully, unreachable
2835 because the program does work. Another common use of unreachable
2836 code is to provide behavior which is selectable at compile-time.
2840 Warn if a function can not be inlined and it was declared as inline.
2843 @opindex Winvalid-pch
2844 Warn if a precompiled header (@pxref{Precompiled Headers}) is found in
2845 the search path but can't be used.
2849 @opindex Wno-long-long
2850 Warn if @samp{long long} type is used. This is default. To inhibit
2851 the warning messages, use @option{-Wno-long-long}. Flags
2852 @option{-Wlong-long} and @option{-Wno-long-long} are taken into account
2853 only when @option{-pedantic} flag is used.
2855 @item -Wdisabled-optimization
2856 @opindex Wdisabled-optimization
2857 Warn if a requested optimization pass is disabled. This warning does
2858 not generally indicate that there is anything wrong with your code; it
2859 merely indicates that GCC's optimizers were unable to handle the code
2860 effectively. Often, the problem is that your code is too big or too
2861 complex; GCC will refuse to optimize programs when the optimization
2862 itself is likely to take inordinate amounts of time.
2866 Make all warnings into errors.
2869 @node Debugging Options
2870 @section Options for Debugging Your Program or GCC
2871 @cindex options, debugging
2872 @cindex debugging information options
2874 GCC has various special options that are used for debugging
2875 either your program or GCC:
2880 Produce debugging information in the operating system's native format
2881 (stabs, COFF, XCOFF, or DWARF)@. GDB can work with this debugging
2884 On most systems that use stabs format, @option{-g} enables use of extra
2885 debugging information that only GDB can use; this extra information
2886 makes debugging work better in GDB but will probably make other debuggers
2888 refuse to read the program. If you want to control for certain whether
2889 to generate the extra information, use @option{-gstabs+}, @option{-gstabs},
2890 @option{-gxcoff+}, @option{-gxcoff}, @option{-gdwarf-1+}, @option{-gdwarf-1},
2891 or @option{-gvms} (see below).
2893 Unlike most other C compilers, GCC allows you to use @option{-g} with
2894 @option{-O}. The shortcuts taken by optimized code may occasionally
2895 produce surprising results: some variables you declared may not exist
2896 at all; flow of control may briefly move where you did not expect it;
2897 some statements may not be executed because they compute constant
2898 results or their values were already at hand; some statements may
2899 execute in different places because they were moved out of loops.
2901 Nevertheless it proves possible to debug optimized output. This makes
2902 it reasonable to use the optimizer for programs that might have bugs.
2904 The following options are useful when GCC is generated with the
2905 capability for more than one debugging format.
2909 Produce debugging information for use by GDB@. This means to use the
2910 most expressive format available (DWARF 2, stabs, or the native format
2911 if neither of those are supported), including GDB extensions if at all
2916 Produce debugging information in stabs format (if that is supported),
2917 without GDB extensions. This is the format used by DBX on most BSD
2918 systems. On MIPS, Alpha and System V Release 4 systems this option
2919 produces stabs debugging output which is not understood by DBX or SDB@.
2920 On System V Release 4 systems this option requires the GNU assembler.
2924 Produce debugging information in stabs format (if that is supported),
2925 using GNU extensions understood only by the GNU debugger (GDB)@. The
2926 use of these extensions is likely to make other debuggers crash or
2927 refuse to read the program.
2931 Produce debugging information in COFF format (if that is supported).
2932 This is the format used by SDB on most System V systems prior to
2937 Produce debugging information in XCOFF format (if that is supported).
2938 This is the format used by the DBX debugger on IBM RS/6000 systems.
2942 Produce debugging information in XCOFF format (if that is supported),
2943 using GNU extensions understood only by the GNU debugger (GDB)@. The
2944 use of these extensions is likely to make other debuggers crash or
2945 refuse to read the program, and may cause assemblers other than the GNU
2946 assembler (GAS) to fail with an error.
2950 Produce debugging information in DWARF version 1 format (if that is
2951 supported). This is the format used by SDB on most System V Release 4
2954 This option is deprecated.
2958 Produce debugging information in DWARF version 1 format (if that is
2959 supported), using GNU extensions understood only by the GNU debugger
2960 (GDB)@. The use of these extensions is likely to make other debuggers
2961 crash or refuse to read the program.
2963 This option is deprecated.
2967 Produce debugging information in DWARF version 2 format (if that is
2968 supported). This is the format used by DBX on IRIX 6.
2972 Produce debugging information in VMS debug format (if that is
2973 supported). This is the format used by DEBUG on VMS systems.
2976 @itemx -ggdb@var{level}
2977 @itemx -gstabs@var{level}
2978 @itemx -gcoff@var{level}
2979 @itemx -gxcoff@var{level}
2980 @itemx -gvms@var{level}
2981 Request debugging information and also use @var{level} to specify how
2982 much information. The default level is 2.
2984 Level 1 produces minimal information, enough for making backtraces in
2985 parts of the program that you don't plan to debug. This includes
2986 descriptions of functions and external variables, but no information
2987 about local variables and no line numbers.
2989 Level 3 includes extra information, such as all the macro definitions
2990 present in the program. Some debuggers support macro expansion when
2991 you use @option{-g3}.
2993 Note that in order to avoid confusion between DWARF1 debug level 2,
2994 and DWARF2, neither @option{-gdwarf} nor @option{-gdwarf-2} accept
2995 a concatenated debug level. Instead use an additional @option{-g@var{level}}
2996 option to change the debug level for DWARF1 or DWARF2.
2998 @item -feliminate-dwarf2-dups
2999 @opindex feliminate-dwarf2-dups
3000 Compress DWARF2 debugging information by eliminating duplicated
3001 information about each symbol. This option only makes sense when
3002 generating DWARF2 debugging information with @option{-gdwarf-2}.
3004 @cindex @command{prof}
3007 Generate extra code to write profile information suitable for the
3008 analysis program @command{prof}. You must use this option when compiling
3009 the source files you want data about, and you must also use it when
3012 @cindex @command{gprof}
3015 Generate extra code to write profile information suitable for the
3016 analysis program @command{gprof}. You must use this option when compiling
3017 the source files you want data about, and you must also use it when
3022 Makes the compiler print out each function name as it is compiled, and
3023 print some statistics about each pass when it finishes.
3026 @opindex ftime-report
3027 Makes the compiler print some statistics about the time consumed by each
3028 pass when it finishes.
3031 @opindex fmem-report
3032 Makes the compiler print some statistics about permanent memory
3033 allocation when it finishes.
3035 @item -fprofile-arcs
3036 @opindex fprofile-arcs
3037 Add code so that program flow @dfn{arcs} are instrumented. During
3038 execution the program records how many times each branch and call is
3039 executed and how many times it is taken or returns. When the compiled
3040 program exits it saves this data to a file called
3041 @file{@var{auxname}.da} for each source file. The data may be used for
3042 profile-directed optimizations (@option{-fbranch-probabilities}), or for
3043 test coverage analysis (@option{-ftest-coverage}). Each object file's
3044 @var{auxname} is generated from the name of the output file, if
3045 explicitly specified and it is not the final executable, otherwise it is
3046 the basename of the source file. In both cases any suffix is removed
3047 (e.g. @file{foo.da} for input file @file{dir/foo.c}, or
3048 @file{dir/foo.da} for output file specified as @option{-o dir/foo.o}).
3053 Compile the source files with @option{-fprofile-arcs} plus optimization
3054 and code generation options. For test coverage analysis, use the
3055 additional @option{-ftest-coverage} option. You do not need to profile
3056 every source file in a program.
3059 Link your object files as normal.
3062 Run the program on a representative workload to generate the arc profile
3063 information. This may be repeated any number of times.
3066 For profile-directed optimizations, compile the source files again with
3067 the same optimization and code generation options plus
3068 @option{-fbranch-probabilities} (@pxref{Optimize Options,,Options that
3069 Control Optimization}).
3072 For test coverage analysis, use @command{gcov} to produce human readable
3073 information from the @file{.bbg} and @file{.da} files. Refer to the
3074 @command{gcov} documentation for further information.
3078 With @option{-fprofile-arcs}, for each function of your program GCC
3079 creates a program flow graph, then finds a spanning tree for the graph.
3080 Only arcs that are not on the spanning tree have to be instrumented: the
3081 compiler adds code to count the number of times that these arcs are
3082 executed. When an arc is the only exit or only entrance to a block, the
3083 instrumentation code can be added to the block; otherwise, a new basic
3084 block must be created to hold the instrumentation code.
3087 @item -ftest-coverage
3088 @opindex ftest-coverage
3089 Produce a graph file that the @command{gcov} code-coverage utility
3090 (@pxref{Gcov,, @command{gcov}---a Test Coverage Program}) can use to
3091 show program coverage. Each source file's data file is called
3092 @file{@var{auxname}.bbg}. Refer to the @option{-fprofile-arcs} option
3093 above for a description of @var{auxname} and instructions on how to
3094 generate test coverage data. Coverage data will match the source files
3095 more closely, if you do not optimize.
3097 @item -d@var{letters}
3099 Says to make debugging dumps during compilation at times specified by
3100 @var{letters}. This is used for debugging the compiler. The file names
3101 for most of the dumps are made by appending a pass number and a word to
3102 the @var{dumpname}. @var{dumpname} is generated from the name of the
3103 output file, if explicitly specified and it is not an executable,
3104 otherwise it is the basename of the source file. In both cases any
3105 suffix is removed (e.g. @file{foo.00.rtl} or @file{foo.01.sibling}).
3106 Here are the possible letters for use in @var{letters}, and their
3112 Annotate the assembler output with miscellaneous debugging information.
3115 Dump after computing branch probabilities, to @file{@var{file}.14.bp}.
3118 Dump after block reordering, to @file{@var{file}.32.bbro}.
3121 Dump after instruction combination, to the file @file{@var{file}.19.combine}.
3124 Dump after the first if conversion, to the file @file{@var{file}.15.ce1}.
3127 Dump after delayed branch scheduling, to @file{@var{file}.34.dbr}.
3130 Dump all macro definitions, at the end of preprocessing, in addition to
3134 Dump after SSA optimizations, to @file{@var{file}.04.ssa} and
3135 @file{@var{file}.07.ussa}.
3138 Dump after the second if conversion, to @file{@var{file}.29.ce3}.
3141 Dump after life analysis, to @file{@var{file}.18.life}.
3144 Dump after purging @code{ADDRESSOF} codes, to @file{@var{file}.10.addressof}.
3147 Dump after global register allocation, to @file{@var{file}.24.greg}.
3150 Dump after finalization of EH handling code, to @file{@var{file}.02.eh}.
3153 Dump after reg-to-stack conversion, to @file{@var{file}.31.stack}.
3156 Dump after post-reload optimizations, to @file{@var{file}.25.postreload}.
3159 Dump after GCSE, to @file{@var{file}.11.gcse}.
3162 Dump after sibling call optimizations, to @file{@var{file}.01.sibling}.
3165 Dump after the first jump optimization, to @file{@var{file}.03.jump}.
3168 Dump after conversion from registers to stack, to @file{@var{file}.31.stack}.
3171 Dump after local register allocation, to @file{@var{file}.23.lreg}.
3174 Dump after loop optimization, to @file{@var{file}.12.loop}.
3177 Dump after performing the machine dependent reorganization pass, to
3178 @file{@var{file}.33.mach}.
3181 Dump after register renumbering, to @file{@var{file}.28.rnreg}.
3184 Dump after the register move pass, to @file{@var{file}.21.regmove}.
3187 Dump after RTL generation, to @file{@var{file}.00.rtl}.
3190 Dump after the second scheduling pass, to @file{@var{file}.30.sched2}.
3193 Dump after CSE (including the jump optimization that sometimes follows
3194 CSE), to @file{@var{file}.09.cse}.
3197 Dump after the first scheduling pass, to @file{@var{file}.22.sched}.
3200 Dump after the second CSE pass (including the jump optimization that
3201 sometimes follows CSE), to @file{@var{file}.17.cse2}.
3204 Dump after null pointer elimination pass to @file{@var{file}.08.null}.
3207 Dump after the second flow pass, to @file{@var{file}.26.flow2}.
3210 Dump after SSA dead code elimination, to @file{@var{file}.06.ssadce}.
3213 Dump after the peephole pass, to @file{@var{file}.27.peephole2}.
3216 Produce all the dumps listed above.
3219 Print statistics on memory usage, at the end of the run, to
3223 Annotate the assembler output with a comment indicating which
3224 pattern and alternative was used. The length of each instruction is
3228 Dump the RTL in the assembler output as a comment before each instruction.
3229 Also turns on @option{-dp} annotation.
3232 For each of the other indicated dump files (except for
3233 @file{@var{file}.00.rtl}), dump a representation of the control flow graph
3234 suitable for viewing with VCG to @file{@var{file}.@var{pass}.vcg}.
3237 Just generate RTL for a function instead of compiling it. Usually used
3241 Dump debugging information during parsing, to standard error.
3244 @item -fdump-unnumbered
3245 @opindex fdump-unnumbered
3246 When doing debugging dumps (see @option{-d} option above), suppress instruction
3247 numbers and line number note output. This makes it more feasible to
3248 use diff on debugging dumps for compiler invocations with different
3249 options, in particular with and without @option{-g}.
3251 @item -fdump-translation-unit @r{(C and C++ only)}
3252 @itemx -fdump-translation-unit-@var{options} @r{(C and C++ only)}
3253 @opindex fdump-translation-unit
3254 Dump a representation of the tree structure for the entire translation
3255 unit to a file. The file name is made by appending @file{.tu} to the
3256 source file name. If the @samp{-@var{options}} form is used, @var{options}
3257 controls the details of the dump as described for the
3258 @option{-fdump-tree} options.
3260 @item -fdump-class-hierarchy @r{(C++ only)}
3261 @itemx -fdump-class-hierarchy-@var{options} @r{(C++ only)}
3262 @opindex fdump-class-hierarchy
3263 Dump a representation of each class's hierarchy and virtual function
3264 table layout to a file. The file name is made by appending @file{.class}
3265 to the source file name. If the @samp{-@var{options}} form is used,
3266 @var{options} controls the details of the dump as described for the
3267 @option{-fdump-tree} options.
3269 @item -fdump-tree-@var{switch} @r{(C++ only)}
3270 @itemx -fdump-tree-@var{switch}-@var{options} @r{(C++ only)}
3272 Control the dumping at various stages of processing the intermediate
3273 language tree to a file. The file name is generated by appending a switch
3274 specific suffix to the source file name. If the @samp{-@var{options}}
3275 form is used, @var{options} is a list of @samp{-} separated options that
3276 control the details of the dump. Not all options are applicable to all
3277 dumps, those which are not meaningful will be ignored. The following
3278 options are available
3282 Print the address of each node. Usually this is not meaningful as it
3283 changes according to the environment and source file. Its primary use
3284 is for tying up a dump file with a debug environment.
3286 Inhibit dumping of members of a scope or body of a function merely
3287 because that scope has been reached. Only dump such items when they
3288 are directly reachable by some other path.
3290 Turn on all options.
3293 The following tree dumps are possible:
3296 Dump before any tree based optimization, to @file{@var{file}.original}.
3298 Dump after all tree based optimization, to @file{@var{file}.optimized}.
3300 Dump after function inlining, to @file{@var{file}.inlined}.
3303 @item -fsched-verbose=@var{n}
3304 @opindex fsched-verbose
3305 On targets that use instruction scheduling, this option controls the
3306 amount of debugging output the scheduler prints. This information is
3307 written to standard error, unless @option{-dS} or @option{-dR} is
3308 specified, in which case it is output to the usual dump
3309 listing file, @file{.sched} or @file{.sched2} respectively. However
3310 for @var{n} greater than nine, the output is always printed to standard
3313 For @var{n} greater than zero, @option{-fsched-verbose} outputs the
3314 same information as @option{-dRS}. For @var{n} greater than one, it
3315 also output basic block probabilities, detailed ready list information
3316 and unit/insn info. For @var{n} greater than two, it includes RTL
3317 at abort point, control-flow and regions info. And for @var{n} over
3318 four, @option{-fsched-verbose} also includes dependence info.
3322 Store the usual ``temporary'' intermediate files permanently; place them
3323 in the current directory and name them based on the source file. Thus,
3324 compiling @file{foo.c} with @samp{-c -save-temps} would produce files
3325 @file{foo.i} and @file{foo.s}, as well as @file{foo.o}. This creates a
3326 preprocessed @file{foo.i} output file even though the compiler now
3327 normally uses an integrated preprocessor.
3331 Report the CPU time taken by each subprocess in the compilation
3332 sequence. For C source files, this is the compiler proper and assembler
3333 (plus the linker if linking is done). The output looks like this:
3340 The first number on each line is the ``user time,'' that is time spent
3341 executing the program itself. The second number is ``system time,''
3342 time spent executing operating system routines on behalf of the program.
3343 Both numbers are in seconds.
3345 @item -print-file-name=@var{library}
3346 @opindex print-file-name
3347 Print the full absolute name of the library file @var{library} that
3348 would be used when linking---and don't do anything else. With this
3349 option, GCC does not compile or link anything; it just prints the
3352 @item -print-multi-directory
3353 @opindex print-multi-directory
3354 Print the directory name corresponding to the multilib selected by any
3355 other switches present in the command line. This directory is supposed
3356 to exist in @env{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX}.
3358 @item -print-multi-lib
3359 @opindex print-multi-lib
3360 Print the mapping from multilib directory names to compiler switches
3361 that enable them. The directory name is separated from the switches by
3362 @samp{;}, and each switch starts with an @samp{@@} instead of the
3363 @samp{-}, without spaces between multiple switches. This is supposed to
3364 ease shell-processing.
3366 @item -print-prog-name=@var{program}
3367 @opindex print-prog-name
3368 Like @option{-print-file-name}, but searches for a program such as @samp{cpp}.
3370 @item -print-libgcc-file-name
3371 @opindex print-libgcc-file-name
3372 Same as @option{-print-file-name=libgcc.a}.
3374 This is useful when you use @option{-nostdlib} or @option{-nodefaultlibs}
3375 but you do want to link with @file{libgcc.a}. You can do
3378 gcc -nostdlib @var{files}@dots{} `gcc -print-libgcc-file-name`
3381 @item -print-search-dirs
3382 @opindex print-search-dirs
3383 Print the name of the configured installation directory and a list of
3384 program and library directories gcc will search---and don't do anything else.
3386 This is useful when gcc prints the error message
3387 @samp{installation problem, cannot exec cpp0: No such file or directory}.
3388 To resolve this you either need to put @file{cpp0} and the other compiler
3389 components where gcc expects to find them, or you can set the environment
3390 variable @env{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} to the directory where you installed them.
3391 Don't forget the trailing '/'.
3392 @xref{Environment Variables}.
3395 @opindex dumpmachine
3396 Print the compiler's target machine (for example,
3397 @samp{i686-pc-linux-gnu})---and don't do anything else.
3400 @opindex dumpversion
3401 Print the compiler version (for example, @samp{3.0})---and don't do
3406 Print the compiler's built-in specs---and don't do anything else. (This
3407 is used when GCC itself is being built.) @xref{Spec Files}.
3410 @node Optimize Options
3411 @section Options That Control Optimization
3412 @cindex optimize options
3413 @cindex options, optimization
3415 These options control various sorts of optimizations.
3417 Without any optimization option, the compiler's goal is to reduce the
3418 cost of compilation and to make debugging produce the expected
3419 results. Statements are independent: if you stop the program with a
3420 breakpoint between statements, you can then assign a new value to any
3421 variable or change the program counter to any other statement in the
3422 function and get exactly the results you would expect from the source
3425 Turning on optimization flags makes the compiler attempt to improve
3426 the performance and/or code size at the expense of compilation time
3427 and possibly the ability to debug the program.
3429 Not all optimizations are controlled directly by a flag. Only
3430 optimizations that have a flag are listed.
3437 Optimize. Optimizing compilation takes somewhat more time, and a lot
3438 more memory for a large function.
3440 With @option{-O}, the compiler tries to reduce code size and execution
3441 time, without performing any optimizations that take a great deal of
3444 @option{-O} turns on the following optimization flags:
3445 @gccoptlist{-fdefer-pop
3453 -fguess-branch-probability
3456 @option{-O} also turns on @option{-fomit-frame-pointer} on machines
3457 where doing so does not interfere with debugging.
3461 Optimize even more. GCC performs nearly all supported optimizations
3462 that do not involve a space-speed tradeoff. The compiler does not
3463 perform loop unrolling or function inlining when you specify @option{-O2}.
3464 As compared to @option{-O}, this option increases both compilation time
3465 and the performance of the generated code.
3467 @option{-O2} turns on all optimization flags specified by @option{-O}. It
3468 also turns on the following optimization flags:
3469 @gccoptlist{-fforce-mem
3470 -foptimize-sibling-calls
3472 -fcse-follow-jumps -fcse-skip-blocks
3473 -frerun-cse-after-loop -frerun-loop-opt
3474 -fgcse -fgcse-lm -fgcse-sm
3475 -fdelete-null-pointer-checks
3476 -fexpensive-optimizations
3478 -fschedule-insns -fschedule-insns2
3479 -fsched-interblock -fsched-spec
3482 -freorder-blocks -freorder-functions
3484 -falign-functions -falign-jumps
3485 -falign-loops -falign-labels}
3487 Please note the warning under @option{-fgcse} about
3488 invoking @option{-O2} on programs that use computed gotos.
3492 Optimize yet more. @option{-O3} turns on all optimizations specified by
3493 @option{-O2} and also turns on the @option{-finline-functions} and
3494 @option{-frename-registers} options.
3498 Do not optimize. This is the default.
3502 Optimize for size. @option{-Os} enables all @option{-O2} optimizations that
3503 do not typically increase code size. It also performs further
3504 optimizations designed to reduce code size.
3506 @option{-Os} disables the following optimization flags:
3507 @gccoptlist{-falign-functions -falign-jumps -falign-loops
3508 -falign-labels -freorder-blocks -fprefetch-loop-arrays}
3510 If you use multiple @option{-O} options, with or without level numbers,
3511 the last such option is the one that is effective.
3514 Options of the form @option{-f@var{flag}} specify machine-independent
3515 flags. Most flags have both positive and negative forms; the negative
3516 form of @option{-ffoo} would be @option{-fno-foo}. In the table
3517 below, only one of the forms is listed---the one you typically will
3518 use. You can figure out the other form by either removing @samp{no-}
3521 The following options control specific optimizations. They are either
3522 activated by @option{-O} options or are related to ones that are. You
3523 can use the following flags in the rare cases when ``fine-tuning'' of
3524 optimizations to be performed is desired.
3527 @item -fno-default-inline
3528 @opindex fno-default-inline
3529 Do not make member functions inline by default merely because they are
3530 defined inside the class scope (C++ only). Otherwise, when you specify
3531 @w{@option{-O}}, member functions defined inside class scope are compiled
3532 inline by default; i.e., you don't need to add @samp{inline} in front of
3533 the member function name.
3535 @item -fno-defer-pop
3536 @opindex fno-defer-pop
3537 Always pop the arguments to each function call as soon as that function
3538 returns. For machines which must pop arguments after a function call,
3539 the compiler normally lets arguments accumulate on the stack for several
3540 function calls and pops them all at once.
3542 Disabled at levels @option{-O}, @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
3546 Force memory operands to be copied into registers before doing
3547 arithmetic on them. This produces better code by making all memory
3548 references potential common subexpressions. When they are not common
3549 subexpressions, instruction combination should eliminate the separate
3552 Enabled at levels @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
3555 @opindex fforce-addr
3556 Force memory address constants to be copied into registers before
3557 doing arithmetic on them. This may produce better code just as
3558 @option{-fforce-mem} may.
3560 @item -fomit-frame-pointer
3561 @opindex fomit-frame-pointer
3562 Don't keep the frame pointer in a register for functions that
3563 don't need one. This avoids the instructions to save, set up and
3564 restore frame pointers; it also makes an extra register available
3565 in many functions. @strong{It also makes debugging impossible on
3568 On some machines, such as the VAX, this flag has no effect, because
3569 the standard calling sequence automatically handles the frame pointer
3570 and nothing is saved by pretending it doesn't exist. The
3571 machine-description macro @code{FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED} controls
3572 whether a target machine supports this flag. @xref{Registers,,Register
3573 Usage, gccint, GNU Compiler Collection (GCC) Internals}.
3575 Enabled at levels @option{-O}, @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
3577 @item -foptimize-sibling-calls
3578 @opindex foptimize-sibling-calls
3579 Optimize sibling and tail recursive calls.
3581 Enabled at levels @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
3585 Don't pay attention to the @code{inline} keyword. Normally this option
3586 is used to keep the compiler from expanding any functions inline.
3587 Note that if you are not optimizing, no functions can be expanded inline.
3589 @item -finline-functions
3590 @opindex finline-functions
3591 Integrate all simple functions into their callers. The compiler
3592 heuristically decides which functions are simple enough to be worth
3593 integrating in this way.
3595 If all calls to a given function are integrated, and the function is
3596 declared @code{static}, then the function is normally not output as
3597 assembler code in its own right.
3599 Enabled at level @option{-O3}.
3601 @item -finline-limit=@var{n}
3602 @opindex finline-limit
3603 By default, gcc limits the size of functions that can be inlined. This flag
3604 allows the control of this limit for functions that are explicitly marked as
3605 inline (i.e., marked with the inline keyword or defined within the class
3606 definition in c++). @var{n} is the size of functions that can be inlined in
3607 number of pseudo instructions (not counting parameter handling). The default
3608 value of @var{n} is 600.
3609 Increasing this value can result in more inlined code at
3610 the cost of compilation time and memory consumption. Decreasing usually makes
3611 the compilation faster and less code will be inlined (which presumably
3612 means slower programs). This option is particularly useful for programs that
3613 use inlining heavily such as those based on recursive templates with C++.
3615 @emph{Note:} pseudo instruction represents, in this particular context, an
3616 abstract measurement of function's size. In no way, it represents a count
3617 of assembly instructions and as such its exact meaning might change from one
3618 release to an another.
3620 @item -fkeep-inline-functions
3621 @opindex fkeep-inline-functions
3622 Even if all calls to a given function are integrated, and the function
3623 is declared @code{static}, nevertheless output a separate run-time
3624 callable version of the function. This switch does not affect
3625 @code{extern inline} functions.
3627 @item -fkeep-static-consts
3628 @opindex fkeep-static-consts
3629 Emit variables declared @code{static const} when optimization isn't turned
3630 on, even if the variables aren't referenced.
3632 GCC enables this option by default. If you want to force the compiler to
3633 check if the variable was referenced, regardless of whether or not
3634 optimization is turned on, use the @option{-fno-keep-static-consts} option.
3636 @item -fmerge-constants
3637 Attempt to merge identical constants (string constants and floating point
3638 constants) across compilation units.
3640 This option is the default for optimized compilation if the assembler and
3641 linker support it. Use @option{-fno-merge-constants} to inhibit this
3644 Enabled at levels @option{-O}, @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
3646 @item -fmerge-all-constants
3647 Attempt to merge identical constants and identical variables.
3649 This option implies @option{-fmerge-constants}. In addition to
3650 @option{-fmerge-constants} this considers e.g. even constant initialized
3651 arrays or initialized constant variables with integral or floating point
3652 types. Languages like C or C++ require each non-automatic variable to
3653 have distinct location, so using this option will result in non-conforming
3658 Use a graph coloring register allocator. Currently this option is meant
3659 for testing, so we are interested to hear about miscompilations with
3662 @item -fno-branch-count-reg
3663 @opindex fno-branch-count-reg
3664 Do not use ``decrement and branch'' instructions on a count register,
3665 but instead generate a sequence of instructions that decrement a
3666 register, compare it against zero, then branch based upon the result.
3667 This option is only meaningful on architectures that support such
3668 instructions, which include x86, PowerPC, IA-64 and S/390.
3670 The default is @option{-fbranch-count-reg}, enabled when
3671 @option{-fstrength-reduce} is enabled.
3673 @item -fno-function-cse
3674 @opindex fno-function-cse
3675 Do not put function addresses in registers; make each instruction that
3676 calls a constant function contain the function's address explicitly.
3678 This option results in less efficient code, but some strange hacks
3679 that alter the assembler output may be confused by the optimizations
3680 performed when this option is not used.
3682 The default is @option{-ffunction-cse}
3684 @item -fno-zero-initialized-in-bss
3685 @opindex fno-zero-initialized-in-bss
3686 If the target supports a BSS section, GCC by default puts variables that
3687 are initialized to zero into BSS@. This can save space in the resulting
3690 This option turns off this behavior because some programs explicitly
3691 rely on variables going to the data section. E.g., so that the
3692 resulting executable can find the beginning of that section and/or make
3693 assumptions based on that.
3695 The default is @option{-fzero-initialized-in-bss}.
3697 @item -fstrength-reduce
3698 @opindex fstrength-reduce
3699 Perform the optimizations of loop strength reduction and
3700 elimination of iteration variables.
3702 Enabled at levels @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
3704 @item -fthread-jumps
3705 @opindex fthread-jumps
3706 Perform optimizations where we check to see if a jump branches to a
3707 location where another comparison subsumed by the first is found. If
3708 so, the first branch is redirected to either the destination of the
3709 second branch or a point immediately following it, depending on whether
3710 the condition is known to be true or false.
3712 Enabled at levels @option{-O}, @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
3714 @item -fcse-follow-jumps
3715 @opindex fcse-follow-jumps
3716 In common subexpression elimination, scan through jump instructions
3717 when the target of the jump is not reached by any other path. For
3718 example, when CSE encounters an @code{if} statement with an
3719 @code{else} clause, CSE will follow the jump when the condition
3722 Enabled at levels @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
3724 @item -fcse-skip-blocks
3725 @opindex fcse-skip-blocks
3726 This is similar to @option{-fcse-follow-jumps}, but causes CSE to
3727 follow jumps which conditionally skip over blocks. When CSE
3728 encounters a simple @code{if} statement with no else clause,
3729 @option{-fcse-skip-blocks} causes CSE to follow the jump around the
3730 body of the @code{if}.
3732 Enabled at levels @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
3734 @item -frerun-cse-after-loop
3735 @opindex frerun-cse-after-loop
3736 Re-run common subexpression elimination after loop optimizations has been
3739 Enabled at levels @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
3741 @item -frerun-loop-opt
3742 @opindex frerun-loop-opt
3743 Run the loop optimizer twice.
3745 Enabled at levels @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
3749 Perform a global common subexpression elimination pass.
3750 This pass also performs global constant and copy propagation.
3752 @emph{Note:} When compiling a program using computed gotos, a GCC
3753 extension, you may get better runtime performance if you disable
3754 the global common subexpression elimination pass by adding
3755 @option{-fno-gcse} to the command line.
3757 Enabled at levels @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
3761 When @option{-fgcse-lm} is enabled, global common subexpression elimination will
3762 attempt to move loads which are only killed by stores into themselves. This
3763 allows a loop containing a load/store sequence to be changed to a load outside
3764 the loop, and a copy/store within the loop.
3766 Enabled by default when gcse is enabled.
3770 When @option{-fgcse-sm} is enabled, A store motion pass is run after global common
3771 subexpression elimination. This pass will attempt to move stores out of loops.
3772 When used in conjunction with @option{-fgcse-lm}, loops containing a load/store sequence
3773 can be changed to a load before the loop and a store after the loop.
3775 Enabled by default when gcse is enabled.
3777 @item -floop-optimize
3778 @opindex floop-optimize
3779 Perform loop optimizations: move constant expressions out of loops, simplify
3780 exit test conditions and optionally do strength-reduction and loop unrolling as
3783 Enabled at levels @option{-O}, @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
3785 @item -fcrossjumping
3786 @opindex crossjumping
3787 Perform cross-jumping transformation. This transformation unifies equivalent code and save code size. The
3788 resulting code may or may not perform better than without cross-jumping.
3790 Enabled at levels @option{-O}, @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
3792 @item -fif-conversion
3793 @opindex if-conversion
3794 Attempt to transform conditional jumps into branch-less equivalents. This
3795 include use of conditional moves, min, max, set flags and abs instructions, and
3796 some tricks doable by standard arithmetics. The use of conditional execution
3797 on chips where it is available is controlled by @code{if-conversion2}.
3799 Enabled at levels @option{-O}, @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
3801 @item -fif-conversion2
3802 @opindex if-conversion2
3803 Use conditional execution (where available) to transform conditional jumps into
3804 branch-less equivalents.
3806 Enabled at levels @option{-O}, @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
3808 @item -fdelete-null-pointer-checks
3809 @opindex fdelete-null-pointer-checks
3810 Use global dataflow analysis to identify and eliminate useless checks
3811 for null pointers. The compiler assumes that dereferencing a null
3812 pointer would have halted the program. If a pointer is checked after
3813 it has already been dereferenced, it cannot be null.
3815 In some environments, this assumption is not true, and programs can
3816 safely dereference null pointers. Use
3817 @option{-fno-delete-null-pointer-checks} to disable this optimization
3818 for programs which depend on that behavior.
3820 Enabled at levels @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
3822 @item -fexpensive-optimizations
3823 @opindex fexpensive-optimizations
3824 Perform a number of minor optimizations that are relatively expensive.
3826 Enabled at levels @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
3828 @item -foptimize-register-move
3830 @opindex foptimize-register-move
3832 Attempt to reassign register numbers in move instructions and as
3833 operands of other simple instructions in order to maximize the amount of
3834 register tying. This is especially helpful on machines with two-operand
3837 Note @option{-fregmove} and @option{-foptimize-register-move} are the same
3840 Enabled at levels @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
3842 @item -fdelayed-branch
3843 @opindex fdelayed-branch
3844 If supported for the target machine, attempt to reorder instructions
3845 to exploit instruction slots available after delayed branch
3848 Enabled at levels @option{-O}, @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
3850 @item -fschedule-insns
3851 @opindex fschedule-insns
3852 If supported for the target machine, attempt to reorder instructions to
3853 eliminate execution stalls due to required data being unavailable. This
3854 helps machines that have slow floating point or memory load instructions
3855 by allowing other instructions to be issued until the result of the load
3856 or floating point instruction is required.
3858 Enabled at levels @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
3860 @item -fschedule-insns2
3861 @opindex fschedule-insns2
3862 Similar to @option{-fschedule-insns}, but requests an additional pass of
3863 instruction scheduling after register allocation has been done. This is
3864 especially useful on machines with a relatively small number of
3865 registers and where memory load instructions take more than one cycle.
3867 Enabled at levels @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
3869 @item -fno-sched-interblock
3870 @opindex fno-sched-interblock
3871 Don't schedule instructions across basic blocks. This is normally
3872 enabled by default when scheduling before register allocation, i.e.@:
3873 with @option{-fschedule-insns} or at @option{-O2} or higher.
3875 @item -fno-sched-spec
3876 @opindex fno-sched-spec
3877 Don't allow speculative motion of non-load instructions. This is normally
3878 enabled by default when scheduling before register allocation, i.e.@:
3879 with @option{-fschedule-insns} or at @option{-O2} or higher.
3881 @item -fsched-spec-load
3882 @opindex fsched-spec-load
3883 Allow speculative motion of some load instructions. This only makes
3884 sense when scheduling before register allocation, i.e.@: with
3885 @option{-fschedule-insns} or at @option{-O2} or higher.
3887 @item -fsched-spec-load-dangerous
3888 @opindex fsched-spec-load-dangerous
3889 Allow speculative motion of more load instructions. This only makes
3890 sense when scheduling before register allocation, i.e.@: with
3891 @option{-fschedule-insns} or at @option{-O2} or higher.
3893 @item -fcaller-saves
3894 @opindex fcaller-saves
3895 Enable values to be allocated in registers that will be clobbered by
3896 function calls, by emitting extra instructions to save and restore the
3897 registers around such calls. Such allocation is done only when it
3898 seems to result in better code than would otherwise be produced.
3900 This option is always enabled by default on certain machines, usually
3901 those which have no call-preserved registers to use instead.
3903 Enabled at levels @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
3905 @item -fmove-all-movables
3906 @opindex fmove-all-movables
3907 Forces all invariant computations in loops to be moved
3910 @item -freduce-all-givs
3911 @opindex freduce-all-givs
3912 Forces all general-induction variables in loops to be
3915 @emph{Note:} When compiling programs written in Fortran,
3916 @option{-fmove-all-movables} and @option{-freduce-all-givs} are enabled
3917 by default when you use the optimizer.
3919 These options may generate better or worse code; results are highly
3920 dependent on the structure of loops within the source code.
3922 These two options are intended to be removed someday, once
3923 they have helped determine the efficacy of various
3924 approaches to improving loop optimizations.
3926 Please let us (@w{@email{gcc@@gcc.gnu.org}} and @w{@email{fortran@@gnu.org}})
3927 know how use of these options affects
3928 the performance of your production code.
3929 We're very interested in code that runs @emph{slower}
3930 when these options are @emph{enabled}.
3933 @itemx -fno-peephole2
3934 @opindex fno-peephole
3935 @opindex fno-peephole2
3936 Disable any machine-specific peephole optimizations. The difference
3937 between @option{-fno-peephole} and @option{-fno-peephole2} is in how they
3938 are implemented in the compiler; some targets use one, some use the
3939 other, a few use both.
3941 @option{-fpeephole} is enabled by default.
3942 @option{-fpeephole2} enabled at levels @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
3944 @item -fno-guess-branch-probability
3945 @opindex fno-guess-branch-probability
3946 Do not guess branch probabilities using a randomized model.
3948 Sometimes gcc will opt to use a randomized model to guess branch
3949 probabilities, when none are available from either profiling feedback
3950 (@option{-fprofile-arcs}) or @samp{__builtin_expect}. This means that
3951 different runs of the compiler on the same program may produce different
3954 In a hard real-time system, people don't want different runs of the
3955 compiler to produce code that has different behavior; minimizing
3956 non-determinism is of paramount import. This switch allows users to
3957 reduce non-determinism, possibly at the expense of inferior
3960 The default is @option{-fguess-branch-probability} at levels
3961 @option{-O}, @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
3963 @item -freorder-blocks
3964 @opindex freorder-blocks
3965 Reorder basic blocks in the compiled function in order to reduce number of
3966 taken branches and improve code locality.
3968 Enabled at levels @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
3970 @item -freorder-functions
3971 @opindex freorder-functions
3972 Reorder basic blocks in the compiled function in order to reduce number of
3973 taken branches and improve code locality. This is implemented by using special
3974 subsections @code{text.hot} for most frequently executed functions and
3975 @code{text.unlikely} for unlikely executed functions. Reordering is done by
3976 the linker so object file format must support named sections and linker must
3977 place them in a reasonable way.
3979 Also profile feedback must be available in to make this option effective. See
3980 @option{-fprofile-arcs} for details.
3982 Enabled at levels @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
3984 @item -fstrict-aliasing
3985 @opindex fstrict-aliasing
3986 Allows the compiler to assume the strictest aliasing rules applicable to
3987 the language being compiled. For C (and C++), this activates
3988 optimizations based on the type of expressions. In particular, an
3989 object of one type is assumed never to reside at the same address as an
3990 object of a different type, unless the types are almost the same. For
3991 example, an @code{unsigned int} can alias an @code{int}, but not a
3992 @code{void*} or a @code{double}. A character type may alias any other
3995 Pay special attention to code like this:
4008 The practice of reading from a different union member than the one most
4009 recently written to (called ``type-punning'') is common. Even with
4010 @option{-fstrict-aliasing}, type-punning is allowed, provided the memory
4011 is accessed through the union type. So, the code above will work as
4012 expected. However, this code might not:
4023 Every language that wishes to perform language-specific alias analysis
4024 should define a function that computes, given an @code{tree}
4025 node, an alias set for the node. Nodes in different alias sets are not
4026 allowed to alias. For an example, see the C front-end function
4027 @code{c_get_alias_set}.
4029 Enabled at levels @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
4031 @item -falign-functions
4032 @itemx -falign-functions=@var{n}
4033 @opindex falign-functions
4034 Align the start of functions to the next power-of-two greater than
4035 @var{n}, skipping up to @var{n} bytes. For instance,
4036 @option{-falign-functions=32} aligns functions to the next 32-byte
4037 boundary, but @option{-falign-functions=24} would align to the next
4038 32-byte boundary only if this can be done by skipping 23 bytes or less.
4040 @option{-fno-align-functions} and @option{-falign-functions=1} are
4041 equivalent and mean that functions will not be aligned.
4043 Some assemblers only support this flag when @var{n} is a power of two;
4044 in that case, it is rounded up.
4046 If @var{n} is not specified, use a machine-dependent default.
4048 Enabled at levels @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}.
4050 @item -falign-labels
4051 @itemx -falign-labels=@var{n}
4052 @opindex falign-labels
4053 Align all branch targets to a power-of-two boundary, skipping up to
4054 @var{n} bytes like @option{-falign-functions}. This option can easily
4055 make code slower, because it must insert dummy operations for when the
4056 branch target is reached in the usual flow of the code.
4058 If @option{-falign-loops} or @option{-falign-jumps} are applicable and
4059 are greater than this value, then their values are used instead.
4061 If @var{n} is not specified, use a machine-dependent default which is
4062 very likely to be @samp{1}, meaning no alignment.
4064 Enabled at levels @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}.
4067 @itemx -falign-loops=@var{n}
4068 @opindex falign-loops
4069 Align loops to a power-of-two boundary, skipping up to @var{n} bytes
4070 like @option{-falign-functions}. The hope is that the loop will be
4071 executed many times, which will make up for any execution of the dummy
4074 If @var{n} is not specified, use a machine-dependent default.
4076 Enabled at levels @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}.
4079 @itemx -falign-jumps=@var{n}
4080 @opindex falign-jumps
4081 Align branch targets to a power-of-two boundary, for branch targets
4082 where the targets can only be reached by jumping, skipping up to @var{n}
4083 bytes like @option{-falign-functions}. In this case, no dummy operations
4086 If @var{n} is not specified, use a machine-dependent default.
4088 Enabled at levels @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}.
4090 @item -frename-registers
4091 @opindex frename-registers
4092 Attempt to avoid false dependencies in scheduled code by making use
4093 of registers left over after register allocation. This optimization
4094 will most benefit processors with lots of registers. It can, however,
4095 make debugging impossible, since variables will no longer stay in
4096 a ``home register''.
4098 Enabled at levels @option{-O3}.
4100 @item -fno-cprop-registers
4101 @opindex fno-cprop-registers
4102 After register allocation and post-register allocation instruction splitting,
4103 we perform a copy-propagation pass to try to reduce scheduling dependencies
4104 and occasionally eliminate the copy.
4106 Disabled at levels @option{-O}, @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
4110 The following options control compiler behavior regarding floating
4111 point arithmetic. These options trade off between speed and
4112 correctness. All must be specifically enabled.
4116 @opindex ffloat-store
4117 Do not store floating point variables in registers, and inhibit other
4118 options that might change whether a floating point value is taken from a
4121 @cindex floating point precision
4122 This option prevents undesirable excess precision on machines such as
4123 the 68000 where the floating registers (of the 68881) keep more
4124 precision than a @code{double} is supposed to have. Similarly for the
4125 x86 architecture. For most programs, the excess precision does only
4126 good, but a few programs rely on the precise definition of IEEE floating
4127 point. Use @option{-ffloat-store} for such programs, after modifying
4128 them to store all pertinent intermediate computations into variables.
4132 Sets @option{-fno-math-errno}, @option{-funsafe-math-optimizations}, @*
4133 @option{-fno-trapping-math}, @option{-ffinite-math-only} and @*
4134 @option{-fno-signaling-nans}.
4136 This option causes the preprocessor macro @code{__FAST_MATH__} to be defined.
4138 This option should never be turned on by any @option{-O} option since
4139 it can result in incorrect output for programs which depend on
4140 an exact implementation of IEEE or ISO rules/specifications for
4143 @item -fno-math-errno
4144 @opindex fno-math-errno
4145 Do not set ERRNO after calling math functions that are executed
4146 with a single instruction, e.g., sqrt. A program that relies on
4147 IEEE exceptions for math error handling may want to use this flag
4148 for speed while maintaining IEEE arithmetic compatibility.
4150 This option should never be turned on by any @option{-O} option since
4151 it can result in incorrect output for programs which depend on
4152 an exact implementation of IEEE or ISO rules/specifications for
4155 The default is @option{-fmath-errno}.
4157 @item -funsafe-math-optimizations
4158 @opindex funsafe-math-optimizations
4159 Allow optimizations for floating-point arithmetic that (a) assume
4160 that arguments and results are valid and (b) may violate IEEE or
4161 ANSI standards. When used at link-time, it may include libraries
4162 or startup files that change the default FPU control word or other
4163 similar optimizations.
4165 This option should never be turned on by any @option{-O} option since
4166 it can result in incorrect output for programs which depend on
4167 an exact implementation of IEEE or ISO rules/specifications for
4170 The default is @option{-fno-unsafe-math-optimizations}.
4172 @item -ffinite-math-only
4173 @opindex ffinite-math-only
4174 Allow optimizations for floating-point arithmetic that assume
4175 that arguments and results are not NaNs or +-Infs.
4177 This option should never be turned on by any @option{-O} option since
4178 it can result in incorrect output for programs which depend on
4179 an exact implementation of IEEE or ISO rules/specifications.
4181 The default is @option{-fno-finite-math-only}.
4183 @item -fno-trapping-math
4184 @opindex fno-trapping-math
4185 Compile code assuming that floating-point operations cannot generate
4186 user-visible traps. These traps include division by zero, overflow,
4187 underflow, inexact result and invalid operation. This option implies
4188 @option{-fno-signaling-nans}. Setting this option may allow faster
4189 code if one relies on ``non-stop'' IEEE arithmetic, for example.
4191 This option should never be turned on by any @option{-O} option since
4192 it can result in incorrect output for programs which depend on
4193 an exact implementation of IEEE or ISO rules/specifications for
4196 The default is @option{-ftrapping-math}.
4198 @item -fsignaling-nans
4199 @opindex fsignaling-nans
4200 Compile code assuming that IEEE signaling NaNs may generate user-visible
4201 traps during floating-point operations. Setting this option disables
4202 optimizations that may change the number of exceptions visible with
4203 signaling NaNs. This option implies @option{-ftrapping-math}.
4205 This option causes the preprocessor macro @code{__SUPPORT_SNAN__} to
4208 The default is @option{-fno-signaling-nans}.
4210 This option is experimental and does not currently guarantee to
4211 disable all GCC optimizations that affect signaling NaN behavior.
4213 @item -fsingle-precision-constant
4214 @opindex fsingle-precision-constant
4215 Treat floating point constant as single precision constant instead of
4216 implicitly converting it to double precision constant.
4221 The following options control optimizations that may improve
4222 performance, but are not enabled by any @option{-O} options. This
4223 section includes experimental options that may produce broken code.
4226 @item -fbranch-probabilities
4227 @opindex fbranch-probabilities
4228 After running a program compiled with @option{-fprofile-arcs}
4229 (@pxref{Debugging Options,, Options for Debugging Your Program or
4230 @command{gcc}}), you can compile it a second time using
4231 @option{-fbranch-probabilities}, to improve optimizations based on
4232 the number of times each branch was taken. When the program
4233 compiled with @option{-fprofile-arcs} exits it saves arc execution
4234 counts to a file called @file{@var{sourcename}.da} for each source
4235 file The information in this data file is very dependent on the
4236 structure of the generated code, so you must use the same source code
4237 and the same optimization options for both compilations.
4239 With @option{-fbranch-probabilities}, GCC puts a @samp{REG_EXEC_COUNT}
4240 note on the first instruction of each basic block, and a
4241 @samp{REG_BR_PROB} note on each @samp{JUMP_INSN} and @samp{CALL_INSN}.
4242 These can be used to improve optimization. Currently, they are only
4243 used in one place: in @file{reorg.c}, instead of guessing which path a
4244 branch is mostly to take, the @samp{REG_BR_PROB} values are used to
4245 exactly determine which path is taken more often.
4249 Use a graph coloring register allocator. Currently this option is meant
4250 for testing, so we are interested to hear about miscompilations with
4255 Perform tail duplication to enlarge superblock size. This transformation
4256 simplifies the control flow of the function allowing other optimizations to do
4259 @item -funroll-loops
4260 @opindex funroll-loops
4261 Unroll loops whose number of iterations can be determined at compile
4262 time or upon entry to the loop. @option{-funroll-loops} implies both
4263 @option{-fstrength-reduce} and @option{-frerun-cse-after-loop}. This
4264 option makes code larger, and may or may not make it run faster.
4266 @item -funroll-all-loops
4267 @opindex funroll-all-loops
4268 Unroll all loops, even if their number of iterations is uncertain when
4269 the loop is entered. This usually makes programs run more slowly.
4270 @option{-funroll-all-loops} implies the same options as
4271 @option{-funroll-loops},
4273 @item -fprefetch-loop-arrays
4274 @opindex fprefetch-loop-arrays
4275 If supported by the target machine, generate instructions to prefetch
4276 memory to improve the performance of loops that access large arrays.
4278 Disabled at level @option{-Os}.
4280 @item -ffunction-sections
4281 @itemx -fdata-sections
4282 @opindex ffunction-sections
4283 @opindex fdata-sections
4284 Place each function or data item into its own section in the output
4285 file if the target supports arbitrary sections. The name of the
4286 function or the name of the data item determines the section's name
4289 Use these options on systems where the linker can perform optimizations
4290 to improve locality of reference in the instruction space. HPPA
4291 processors running HP-UX and SPARC processors running Solaris 2 have
4292 linkers with such optimizations. Other systems using the ELF object format
4293 as well as AIX may have these optimizations in the future.
4295 Only use these options when there are significant benefits from doing
4296 so. When you specify these options, the assembler and linker will
4297 create larger object and executable files and will also be slower.
4298 You will not be able to use @code{gprof} on all systems if you
4299 specify this option and you may have problems with debugging if
4300 you specify both this option and @option{-g}.
4304 Perform optimizations in static single assignment form. Each function's
4305 flow graph is translated into SSA form, optimizations are performed, and
4306 the flow graph is translated back from SSA form. Users should not
4307 specify this option, since it is not yet ready for production use.
4311 Perform Sparse Conditional Constant Propagation in SSA form. Requires
4312 @option{-fssa}. Like @option{-fssa}, this is an experimental feature.
4316 Perform aggressive dead-code elimination in SSA form. Requires @option{-fssa}.
4317 Like @option{-fssa}, this is an experimental feature.
4322 @item --param @var{name}=@var{value}
4324 In some places, GCC uses various constants to control the amount of
4325 optimization that is done. For example, GCC will not inline functions
4326 that contain more that a certain number of instructions. You can
4327 control some of these constants on the command-line using the
4328 @option{--param} option.
4330 In each case, the @var{value} is an integer. The allowable choices for
4331 @var{name} are given in the following table:
4334 @item max-delay-slot-insn-search
4335 The maximum number of instructions to consider when looking for an
4336 instruction to fill a delay slot. If more than this arbitrary number of
4337 instructions is searched, the time savings from filling the delay slot
4338 will be minimal so stop searching. Increasing values mean more
4339 aggressive optimization, making the compile time increase with probably
4340 small improvement in executable run time.
4342 @item max-delay-slot-live-search
4343 When trying to fill delay slots, the maximum number of instructions to
4344 consider when searching for a block with valid live register
4345 information. Increasing this arbitrarily chosen value means more
4346 aggressive optimization, increasing the compile time. This parameter
4347 should be removed when the delay slot code is rewritten to maintain the
4350 @item max-gcse-memory
4351 The approximate maximum amount of memory that will be allocated in
4352 order to perform the global common subexpression elimination
4353 optimization. If more memory than specified is required, the
4354 optimization will not be done.
4356 @item max-gcse-passes
4357 The maximum number of passes of GCSE to run.
4359 @item max-pending-list-length
4360 The maximum number of pending dependencies scheduling will allow
4361 before flushing the current state and starting over. Large functions
4362 with few branches or calls can create excessively large lists which
4363 needlessly consume memory and resources.
4365 @item max-inline-insns
4366 If an function contains more than this many instructions, it
4367 will not be inlined. This option is precisely equivalent to
4368 @option{-finline-limit}.
4370 @item max-unrolled-insns
4371 The maximum number of instructions that a loop should have if that loop
4372 is unrolled, and if the loop is unrolled, it determines how many times
4373 the loop code is unrolled.
4375 @item hot-bb-count-fraction
4376 Select fraction of the maximal count of repetitions of basic block in program
4377 given basic block needs to have to be considered hot.
4379 @item hot-bb-frequency-fraction
4380 Select fraction of the maximal frequency of executions of basic block in
4381 function given basic block needs to have to be considered hot
4383 @item tracer-dynamic-coverage
4384 @itemx tracer-dynamic-coverage-feedback
4386 This value is used to limit superblock formation once the given percentage of
4387 executed instructions is covered. This limits unnecessary code size
4390 The @option{tracer-dynamic-coverage-feedback} is used only when profile
4391 feedback is available. The real profiles (as opposed to statically estimated
4392 ones) are much less balanced allowing the threshold to be larger value.
4394 @item tracer-max-code-growth
4395 Stop tail duplication once code growth has reached given percentage. This is
4396 rather hokey argument, as most of the duplicates will be eliminated later in
4397 cross jumping, so it may be set to much higher values than is the desired code
4400 @item tracer-min-branch-ratio
4402 Stop reverse growth when the reverse probability of best edge is less than this
4403 threshold (in percent).
4405 @item tracer-min-branch-ratio
4406 @itemx tracer-min-branch-ratio-feedback
4408 Stop forward growth if the best edge do have probability lower than this
4411 Similarly to @option{tracer-dynamic-coverage} two values are present, one for
4412 compilation for profile feedback and one for compilation without. The value
4413 for compilation with profile feedback needs to be more conservative (higher) in
4414 order to make tracer effective.
4416 @item ggc-min-expand
4418 GCC uses a garbage collector to manage its own memory allocation. This
4419 parameter specifies the minimum percentage by which the garbage
4420 collector's heap should be allowed to expand between collections.
4421 Tuning this may improve compilation speed; it has no effect on code
4424 The default is 30%. Setting this parameter and
4425 @option{ggc-min-heapsize} to zero causes a full collection to occur at
4426 every opportunity. This is extremely slow, but can be useful for
4429 @item ggc-min-heapsize
4431 Minimum size of the garbage collector's heap before it begins bothering
4432 to collect garbage. The first collection occurs after the heap expands
4433 by @option{ggc-min-expand}% beyond @option{ggc-min-heapsize}. Again,
4434 tuning this may improve compilation speed, and has no effect on code
4437 The default is 4096 (four megabytes). Setting this parameter very large
4438 effectively disables garbage collection. Setting this parameter and
4439 @option{ggc-min-expand} to zero causes a full collection to occur at
4445 @node Preprocessor Options
4446 @section Options Controlling the Preprocessor
4447 @cindex preprocessor options
4448 @cindex options, preprocessor
4450 These options control the C preprocessor, which is run on each C source
4451 file before actual compilation.
4453 If you use the @option{-E} option, nothing is done except preprocessing.
4454 Some of these options make sense only together with @option{-E} because
4455 they cause the preprocessor output to be unsuitable for actual
4460 You can use @option{-Wp,@var{option}} to bypass the compiler driver
4461 and pass @var{option} directly through to the preprocessor. If
4462 @var{option} contains commas, it is split into multiple options at the
4463 commas. However, many options are modified, translated or interpreted
4464 by the compiler driver before being passed to the preprocessor, and
4465 @option{-Wp} forcibly bypasses this phase. The preprocessor's direct
4466 interface is undocumented and subject to change, so whenever possible
4467 you should avoid using @option{-Wp} and let the driver handle the
4470 @item -Xpreprocessor @var{option}
4471 @opindex preprocessor
4472 Pass @var{option} as an option to the preprocessor. You can use this to
4473 supply system-specific preprocessor options which GCC does not know how to
4476 If you want to pass an option that takes an argument, you must use
4477 @option{-Xpreprocessor} twice, once for the option and once for the argument.
4480 @include cppopts.texi
4482 @node Assembler Options
4483 @section Passing Options to the Assembler
4485 @c prevent bad page break with this line
4486 You can pass options to the assembler.
4489 @item -Wa,@var{option}
4491 Pass @var{option} as an option to the assembler. If @var{option}
4492 contains commas, it is split into multiple options at the commas.
4494 @item -Xassembler @var{option}
4496 Pass @var{option} as an option to the assembler. You can use this to
4497 supply system-specific assembler options which GCC does not know how to
4500 If you want to pass an option that takes an argument, you must use
4501 @option{-Xassembler} twice, once for the option and once for the argument.
4506 @section Options for Linking
4507 @cindex link options
4508 @cindex options, linking
4510 These options come into play when the compiler links object files into
4511 an executable output file. They are meaningless if the compiler is
4512 not doing a link step.
4516 @item @var{object-file-name}
4517 A file name that does not end in a special recognized suffix is
4518 considered to name an object file or library. (Object files are
4519 distinguished from libraries by the linker according to the file
4520 contents.) If linking is done, these object files are used as input
4529 If any of these options is used, then the linker is not run, and
4530 object file names should not be used as arguments. @xref{Overall
4534 @item -l@var{library}
4535 @itemx -l @var{library}
4537 Search the library named @var{library} when linking. (The second
4538 alternative with the library as a separate argument is only for
4539 POSIX compliance and is not recommended.)
4541 It makes a difference where in the command you write this option; the
4542 linker searches and processes libraries and object files in the order they
4543 are specified. Thus, @samp{foo.o -lz bar.o} searches library @samp{z}
4544 after file @file{foo.o} but before @file{bar.o}. If @file{bar.o} refers
4545 to functions in @samp{z}, those functions may not be loaded.
4547 The linker searches a standard list of directories for the library,
4548 which is actually a file named @file{lib@var{library}.a}. The linker
4549 then uses this file as if it had been specified precisely by name.
4551 The directories searched include several standard system directories
4552 plus any that you specify with @option{-L}.
4554 Normally the files found this way are library files---archive files
4555 whose members are object files. The linker handles an archive file by
4556 scanning through it for members which define symbols that have so far
4557 been referenced but not defined. But if the file that is found is an
4558 ordinary object file, it is linked in the usual fashion. The only
4559 difference between using an @option{-l} option and specifying a file name
4560 is that @option{-l} surrounds @var{library} with @samp{lib} and @samp{.a}
4561 and searches several directories.
4565 You need this special case of the @option{-l} option in order to
4566 link an Objective-C program.
4569 @opindex nostartfiles
4570 Do not use the standard system startup files when linking.
4571 The standard system libraries are used normally, unless @option{-nostdlib}
4572 or @option{-nodefaultlibs} is used.
4574 @item -nodefaultlibs
4575 @opindex nodefaultlibs
4576 Do not use the standard system libraries when linking.
4577 Only the libraries you specify will be passed to the linker.
4578 The standard startup files are used normally, unless @option{-nostartfiles}
4579 is used. The compiler may generate calls to memcmp, memset, and memcpy
4580 for System V (and ISO C) environments or to bcopy and bzero for
4581 BSD environments. These entries are usually resolved by entries in
4582 libc. These entry points should be supplied through some other
4583 mechanism when this option is specified.
4587 Do not use the standard system startup files or libraries when linking.
4588 No startup files and only the libraries you specify will be passed to
4589 the linker. The compiler may generate calls to memcmp, memset, and memcpy
4590 for System V (and ISO C) environments or to bcopy and bzero for
4591 BSD environments. These entries are usually resolved by entries in
4592 libc. These entry points should be supplied through some other
4593 mechanism when this option is specified.
4595 @cindex @option{-lgcc}, use with @option{-nostdlib}
4596 @cindex @option{-nostdlib} and unresolved references
4597 @cindex unresolved references and @option{-nostdlib}
4598 @cindex @option{-lgcc}, use with @option{-nodefaultlibs}
4599 @cindex @option{-nodefaultlibs} and unresolved references
4600 @cindex unresolved references and @option{-nodefaultlibs}
4601 One of the standard libraries bypassed by @option{-nostdlib} and
4602 @option{-nodefaultlibs} is @file{libgcc.a}, a library of internal subroutines
4603 that GCC uses to overcome shortcomings of particular machines, or special
4604 needs for some languages.
4605 (@xref{Interface,,Interfacing to GCC Output,gccint,GNU Compiler
4606 Collection (GCC) Internals},
4607 for more discussion of @file{libgcc.a}.)
4608 In most cases, you need @file{libgcc.a} even when you want to avoid
4609 other standard libraries. In other words, when you specify @option{-nostdlib}
4610 or @option{-nodefaultlibs} you should usually specify @option{-lgcc} as well.
4611 This ensures that you have no unresolved references to internal GCC
4612 library subroutines. (For example, @samp{__main}, used to ensure C++
4613 constructors will be called; @pxref{Collect2,,@code{collect2}, gccint,
4614 GNU Compiler Collection (GCC) Internals}.)
4618 Remove all symbol table and relocation information from the executable.
4622 On systems that support dynamic linking, this prevents linking with the shared
4623 libraries. On other systems, this option has no effect.
4627 Produce a shared object which can then be linked with other objects to
4628 form an executable. Not all systems support this option. For predictable
4629 results, you must also specify the same set of options that were used to
4630 generate code (@option{-fpic}, @option{-fPIC}, or model suboptions)
4631 when you specify this option.@footnote{On some systems, @samp{gcc -shared}
4632 needs to build supplementary stub code for constructors to work. On
4633 multi-libbed systems, @samp{gcc -shared} must select the correct support
4634 libraries to link against. Failing to supply the correct flags may lead
4635 to subtle defects. Supplying them in cases where they are not necessary
4638 @item -shared-libgcc
4639 @itemx -static-libgcc
4640 @opindex shared-libgcc
4641 @opindex static-libgcc
4642 On systems that provide @file{libgcc} as a shared library, these options
4643 force the use of either the shared or static version respectively.
4644 If no shared version of @file{libgcc} was built when the compiler was
4645 configured, these options have no effect.
4647 There are several situations in which an application should use the
4648 shared @file{libgcc} instead of the static version. The most common
4649 of these is when the application wishes to throw and catch exceptions
4650 across different shared libraries. In that case, each of the libraries
4651 as well as the application itself should use the shared @file{libgcc}.
4653 Therefore, the G++ and GCJ drivers automatically add
4654 @option{-shared-libgcc} whenever you build a shared library or a main
4655 executable, because C++ and Java programs typically use exceptions, so
4656 this is the right thing to do.
4658 If, instead, you use the GCC driver to create shared libraries, you may
4659 find that they will not always be linked with the shared @file{libgcc}.
4660 If GCC finds, at its configuration time, that you have a GNU linker that
4661 does not support option @option{--eh-frame-hdr}, it will link the shared
4662 version of @file{libgcc} into shared libraries by default. Otherwise,
4663 it will take advantage of the linker and optimize away the linking with
4664 the shared version of @file{libgcc}, linking with the static version of
4665 libgcc by default. This allows exceptions to propagate through such
4666 shared libraries, without incurring relocation costs at library load
4669 However, if a library or main executable is supposed to throw or catch
4670 exceptions, you must link it using the G++ or GCJ driver, as appropriate
4671 for the languages used in the program, or using the option
4672 @option{-shared-libgcc}, such that it is linked with the shared
4677 Bind references to global symbols when building a shared object. Warn
4678 about any unresolved references (unless overridden by the link editor
4679 option @samp{-Xlinker -z -Xlinker defs}). Only a few systems support
4682 @item -Xlinker @var{option}
4684 Pass @var{option} as an option to the linker. You can use this to
4685 supply system-specific linker options which GCC does not know how to
4688 If you want to pass an option that takes an argument, you must use
4689 @option{-Xlinker} twice, once for the option and once for the argument.
4690 For example, to pass @option{-assert definitions}, you must write
4691 @samp{-Xlinker -assert -Xlinker definitions}. It does not work to write
4692 @option{-Xlinker "-assert definitions"}, because this passes the entire
4693 string as a single argument, which is not what the linker expects.
4695 @item -Wl,@var{option}
4697 Pass @var{option} as an option to the linker. If @var{option} contains
4698 commas, it is split into multiple options at the commas.
4700 @item -u @var{symbol}
4702 Pretend the symbol @var{symbol} is undefined, to force linking of
4703 library modules to define it. You can use @option{-u} multiple times with
4704 different symbols to force loading of additional library modules.
4707 @node Directory Options
4708 @section Options for Directory Search
4709 @cindex directory options
4710 @cindex options, directory search
4713 These options specify directories to search for header files, for
4714 libraries and for parts of the compiler:
4719 Add the directory @var{dir} to the head of the list of directories to be
4720 searched for header files. This can be used to override a system header
4721 file, substituting your own version, since these directories are
4722 searched before the system header file directories. However, you should
4723 not use this option to add directories that contain vendor-supplied
4724 system header files (use @option{-isystem} for that). If you use more than
4725 one @option{-I} option, the directories are scanned in left-to-right
4726 order; the standard system directories come after.
4728 If a standard system include directory, or a directory specified with
4729 @option{-isystem}, is also specified with @option{-I}, the @option{-I}
4730 option will be ignored. The directory will still be searched but as a
4731 system directory at its normal position in the system include chain.
4732 This is to ensure that GCC's procedure to fix buggy system headers and
4733 the ordering for the include_next directive are not inadvertently changed.
4734 If you really need to change the search order for system directories,
4735 use the @option{-nostdinc} and/or @option{-isystem} options.
4739 Any directories you specify with @option{-I} options before the @option{-I-}
4740 option are searched only for the case of @samp{#include "@var{file}"};
4741 they are not searched for @samp{#include <@var{file}>}.
4743 If additional directories are specified with @option{-I} options after
4744 the @option{-I-}, these directories are searched for all @samp{#include}
4745 directives. (Ordinarily @emph{all} @option{-I} directories are used
4748 In addition, the @option{-I-} option inhibits the use of the current
4749 directory (where the current input file came from) as the first search
4750 directory for @samp{#include "@var{file}"}. There is no way to
4751 override this effect of @option{-I-}. With @option{-I.} you can specify
4752 searching the directory which was current when the compiler was
4753 invoked. That is not exactly the same as what the preprocessor does
4754 by default, but it is often satisfactory.
4756 @option{-I-} does not inhibit the use of the standard system directories
4757 for header files. Thus, @option{-I-} and @option{-nostdinc} are
4762 Add directory @var{dir} to the list of directories to be searched
4765 @item -B@var{prefix}
4767 This option specifies where to find the executables, libraries,
4768 include files, and data files of the compiler itself.
4770 The compiler driver program runs one or more of the subprograms
4771 @file{cpp}, @file{cc1}, @file{as} and @file{ld}. It tries
4772 @var{prefix} as a prefix for each program it tries to run, both with and
4773 without @samp{@var{machine}/@var{version}/} (@pxref{Target Options}).
4775 For each subprogram to be run, the compiler driver first tries the
4776 @option{-B} prefix, if any. If that name is not found, or if @option{-B}
4777 was not specified, the driver tries two standard prefixes, which are
4778 @file{/usr/lib/gcc/} and @file{/usr/local/lib/gcc-lib/}. If neither of
4779 those results in a file name that is found, the unmodified program
4780 name is searched for using the directories specified in your
4781 @env{PATH} environment variable.
4783 The compiler will check to see if the path provided by the @option{-B}
4784 refers to a directory, and if necessary it will add a directory
4785 separator character at the end of the path.
4787 @option{-B} prefixes that effectively specify directory names also apply
4788 to libraries in the linker, because the compiler translates these
4789 options into @option{-L} options for the linker. They also apply to
4790 includes files in the preprocessor, because the compiler translates these
4791 options into @option{-isystem} options for the preprocessor. In this case,
4792 the compiler appends @samp{include} to the prefix.
4794 The run-time support file @file{libgcc.a} can also be searched for using
4795 the @option{-B} prefix, if needed. If it is not found there, the two
4796 standard prefixes above are tried, and that is all. The file is left
4797 out of the link if it is not found by those means.
4799 Another way to specify a prefix much like the @option{-B} prefix is to use
4800 the environment variable @env{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX}. @xref{Environment
4803 As a special kludge, if the path provided by @option{-B} is
4804 @file{[dir/]stage@var{N}/}, where @var{N} is a number in the range 0 to
4805 9, then it will be replaced by @file{[dir/]include}. This is to help
4806 with boot-strapping the compiler.
4808 @item -specs=@var{file}
4810 Process @var{file} after the compiler reads in the standard @file{specs}
4811 file, in order to override the defaults that the @file{gcc} driver
4812 program uses when determining what switches to pass to @file{cc1},
4813 @file{cc1plus}, @file{as}, @file{ld}, etc. More than one
4814 @option{-specs=@var{file}} can be specified on the command line, and they
4815 are processed in order, from left to right.
4821 @section Specifying subprocesses and the switches to pass to them
4823 @command{gcc} is a driver program. It performs its job by invoking a
4824 sequence of other programs to do the work of compiling, assembling and
4825 linking. GCC interprets its command-line parameters and uses these to
4826 deduce which programs it should invoke, and which command-line options
4827 it ought to place on their command lines. This behavior is controlled
4828 by @dfn{spec strings}. In most cases there is one spec string for each
4829 program that GCC can invoke, but a few programs have multiple spec
4830 strings to control their behavior. The spec strings built into GCC can
4831 be overridden by using the @option{-specs=} command-line switch to specify
4834 @dfn{Spec files} are plaintext files that are used to construct spec
4835 strings. They consist of a sequence of directives separated by blank
4836 lines. The type of directive is determined by the first non-whitespace
4837 character on the line and it can be one of the following:
4840 @item %@var{command}
4841 Issues a @var{command} to the spec file processor. The commands that can
4845 @item %include <@var{file}>
4847 Search for @var{file} and insert its text at the current point in the
4850 @item %include_noerr <@var{file}>
4851 @cindex %include_noerr
4852 Just like @samp{%include}, but do not generate an error message if the include
4853 file cannot be found.
4855 @item %rename @var{old_name} @var{new_name}
4857 Rename the spec string @var{old_name} to @var{new_name}.
4861 @item *[@var{spec_name}]:
4862 This tells the compiler to create, override or delete the named spec
4863 string. All lines after this directive up to the next directive or
4864 blank line are considered to be the text for the spec string. If this
4865 results in an empty string then the spec will be deleted. (Or, if the
4866 spec did not exist, then nothing will happened.) Otherwise, if the spec
4867 does not currently exist a new spec will be created. If the spec does
4868 exist then its contents will be overridden by the text of this
4869 directive, unless the first character of that text is the @samp{+}
4870 character, in which case the text will be appended to the spec.
4872 @item [@var{suffix}]:
4873 Creates a new @samp{[@var{suffix}] spec} pair. All lines after this directive
4874 and up to the next directive or blank line are considered to make up the
4875 spec string for the indicated suffix. When the compiler encounters an
4876 input file with the named suffix, it will processes the spec string in
4877 order to work out how to compile that file. For example:
4884 This says that any input file whose name ends in @samp{.ZZ} should be
4885 passed to the program @samp{z-compile}, which should be invoked with the
4886 command-line switch @option{-input} and with the result of performing the
4887 @samp{%i} substitution. (See below.)
4889 As an alternative to providing a spec string, the text that follows a
4890 suffix directive can be one of the following:
4893 @item @@@var{language}
4894 This says that the suffix is an alias for a known @var{language}. This is
4895 similar to using the @option{-x} command-line switch to GCC to specify a
4896 language explicitly. For example:
4903 Says that .ZZ files are, in fact, C++ source files.
4906 This causes an error messages saying:
4909 @var{name} compiler not installed on this system.
4913 GCC already has an extensive list of suffixes built into it.
4914 This directive will add an entry to the end of the list of suffixes, but
4915 since the list is searched from the end backwards, it is effectively
4916 possible to override earlier entries using this technique.
4920 GCC has the following spec strings built into it. Spec files can
4921 override these strings or create their own. Note that individual
4922 targets can also add their own spec strings to this list.
4925 asm Options to pass to the assembler
4926 asm_final Options to pass to the assembler post-processor
4927 cpp Options to pass to the C preprocessor
4928 cc1 Options to pass to the C compiler
4929 cc1plus Options to pass to the C++ compiler
4930 endfile Object files to include at the end of the link
4931 link Options to pass to the linker
4932 lib Libraries to include on the command line to the linker
4933 libgcc Decides which GCC support library to pass to the linker
4934 linker Sets the name of the linker
4935 predefines Defines to be passed to the C preprocessor
4936 signed_char Defines to pass to CPP to say whether @code{char} is signed
4938 startfile Object files to include at the start of the link
4941 Here is a small example of a spec file:
4947 --start-group -lgcc -lc -leval1 --end-group %(old_lib)
4950 This example renames the spec called @samp{lib} to @samp{old_lib} and
4951 then overrides the previous definition of @samp{lib} with a new one.
4952 The new definition adds in some extra command-line options before
4953 including the text of the old definition.
4955 @dfn{Spec strings} are a list of command-line options to be passed to their
4956 corresponding program. In addition, the spec strings can contain
4957 @samp{%}-prefixed sequences to substitute variable text or to
4958 conditionally insert text into the command line. Using these constructs
4959 it is possible to generate quite complex command lines.
4961 Here is a table of all defined @samp{%}-sequences for spec
4962 strings. Note that spaces are not generated automatically around the
4963 results of expanding these sequences. Therefore you can concatenate them
4964 together or combine them with constant text in a single argument.
4968 Substitute one @samp{%} into the program name or argument.
4971 Substitute the name of the input file being processed.
4974 Substitute the basename of the input file being processed.
4975 This is the substring up to (and not including) the last period
4976 and not including the directory.
4979 This is the same as @samp{%b}, but include the file suffix (text after
4983 Marks the argument containing or following the @samp{%d} as a
4984 temporary file name, so that that file will be deleted if GCC exits
4985 successfully. Unlike @samp{%g}, this contributes no text to the
4988 @item %g@var{suffix}
4989 Substitute a file name that has suffix @var{suffix} and is chosen
4990 once per compilation, and mark the argument in the same way as
4991 @samp{%d}. To reduce exposure to denial-of-service attacks, the file
4992 name is now chosen in a way that is hard to predict even when previously
4993 chosen file names are known. For example, @samp{%g.s @dots{} %g.o @dots{} %g.s}
4994 might turn into @samp{ccUVUUAU.s ccXYAXZ12.o ccUVUUAU.s}. @var{suffix} matches
4995 the regexp @samp{[.A-Za-z]*} or the special string @samp{%O}, which is
4996 treated exactly as if @samp{%O} had been preprocessed. Previously, @samp{%g}
4997 was simply substituted with a file name chosen once per compilation,
4998 without regard to any appended suffix (which was therefore treated
4999 just like ordinary text), making such attacks more likely to succeed.
5001 @item %u@var{suffix}
5002 Like @samp{%g}, but generates a new temporary file name even if
5003 @samp{%u@var{suffix}} was already seen.
5005 @item %U@var{suffix}
5006 Substitutes the last file name generated with @samp{%u@var{suffix}}, generating a
5007 new one if there is no such last file name. In the absence of any
5008 @samp{%u@var{suffix}}, this is just like @samp{%g@var{suffix}}, except they don't share
5009 the same suffix @emph{space}, so @samp{%g.s @dots{} %U.s @dots{} %g.s @dots{} %U.s}
5010 would involve the generation of two distinct file names, one
5011 for each @samp{%g.s} and another for each @samp{%U.s}. Previously, @samp{%U} was
5012 simply substituted with a file name chosen for the previous @samp{%u},
5013 without regard to any appended suffix.
5015 @item %j@var{suffix}
5016 Substitutes the name of the @code{HOST_BIT_BUCKET}, if any, and if it is
5017 writable, and if save-temps is off; otherwise, substitute the name
5018 of a temporary file, just like @samp{%u}. This temporary file is not
5019 meant for communication between processes, but rather as a junk
5022 @item %|@var{suffix}
5023 @itemx %m@var{suffix}
5024 Like @samp{%g}, except if @option{-pipe} is in effect. In that case
5025 @samp{%|} substitutes a single dash and @samp{%m} substitutes nothing at
5026 all. These are the two most common ways to instruct a program that it
5027 should read from standard input or write to standard output. If you
5028 need something more elaborate you can use an @samp{%@{pipe:@code{X}@}}
5029 construct: see for example @file{f/lang-specs.h}.
5031 @item %.@var{SUFFIX}
5032 Substitutes @var{.SUFFIX} for the suffixes of a matched switch's args
5033 when it is subsequently output with @samp{%*}. @var{SUFFIX} is
5034 terminated by the next space or %.
5037 Marks the argument containing or following the @samp{%w} as the
5038 designated output file of this compilation. This puts the argument
5039 into the sequence of arguments that @samp{%o} will substitute later.
5042 Substitutes the names of all the output files, with spaces
5043 automatically placed around them. You should write spaces
5044 around the @samp{%o} as well or the results are undefined.
5045 @samp{%o} is for use in the specs for running the linker.
5046 Input files whose names have no recognized suffix are not compiled
5047 at all, but they are included among the output files, so they will
5051 Substitutes the suffix for object files. Note that this is
5052 handled specially when it immediately follows @samp{%g, %u, or %U},
5053 because of the need for those to form complete file names. The
5054 handling is such that @samp{%O} is treated exactly as if it had already
5055 been substituted, except that @samp{%g, %u, and %U} do not currently
5056 support additional @var{suffix} characters following @samp{%O} as they would
5057 following, for example, @samp{.o}.
5060 Substitutes the standard macro predefinitions for the
5061 current target machine. Use this when running @code{cpp}.
5064 Like @samp{%p}, but puts @samp{__} before and after the name of each
5065 predefined macro, except for macros that start with @samp{__} or with
5066 @samp{_@var{L}}, where @var{L} is an uppercase letter. This is for ISO
5070 Substitute a @option{-iprefix} option made from @env{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX}.
5073 Current argument is the name of a library or startup file of some sort.
5074 Search for that file in a standard list of directories and substitute
5075 the full name found.
5078 Print @var{str} as an error message. @var{str} is terminated by a newline.
5079 Use this when inconsistent options are detected.
5082 Substitute the contents of spec string @var{name} at this point.
5085 Like @samp{%(@dots{})} but put @samp{__} around @option{-D} arguments.
5087 @item %x@{@var{option}@}
5088 Accumulate an option for @samp{%X}.
5091 Output the accumulated linker options specified by @option{-Wl} or a @samp{%x}
5095 Output the accumulated assembler options specified by @option{-Wa}.
5098 Output the accumulated preprocessor options specified by @option{-Wp}.
5101 Substitute the major version number of GCC@.
5102 (For version 2.9.5, this is 2.)
5105 Substitute the minor version number of GCC@.
5106 (For version 2.9.5, this is 9.)
5109 Substitute the patch level number of GCC@.
5110 (For version 2.9.5, this is 5.)
5113 Process the @code{asm} spec. This is used to compute the
5114 switches to be passed to the assembler.
5117 Process the @code{asm_final} spec. This is a spec string for
5118 passing switches to an assembler post-processor, if such a program is
5122 Process the @code{link} spec. This is the spec for computing the
5123 command line passed to the linker. Typically it will make use of the
5124 @samp{%L %G %S %D and %E} sequences.
5127 Dump out a @option{-L} option for each directory that GCC believes might
5128 contain startup files. If the target supports multilibs then the
5129 current multilib directory will be prepended to each of these paths.
5132 Output the multilib directory with directory separators replaced with
5133 @samp{_}. If multilib directories are not set, or the multilib directory is
5134 @file{.} then this option emits nothing.
5137 Process the @code{lib} spec. This is a spec string for deciding which
5138 libraries should be included on the command line to the linker.
5141 Process the @code{libgcc} spec. This is a spec string for deciding
5142 which GCC support library should be included on the command line to the linker.
5145 Process the @code{startfile} spec. This is a spec for deciding which
5146 object files should be the first ones passed to the linker. Typically
5147 this might be a file named @file{crt0.o}.
5150 Process the @code{endfile} spec. This is a spec string that specifies
5151 the last object files that will be passed to the linker.
5154 Process the @code{cpp} spec. This is used to construct the arguments
5155 to be passed to the C preprocessor.
5158 Process the @code{signed_char} spec. This is intended to be used
5159 to tell cpp whether a char is signed. It typically has the definition:
5161 %@{funsigned-char:-D__CHAR_UNSIGNED__@}
5165 Process the @code{cc1} spec. This is used to construct the options to be
5166 passed to the actual C compiler (@samp{cc1}).
5169 Process the @code{cc1plus} spec. This is used to construct the options to be
5170 passed to the actual C++ compiler (@samp{cc1plus}).
5173 Substitute the variable part of a matched option. See below.
5174 Note that each comma in the substituted string is replaced by
5178 Remove all occurrences of @code{-S} from the command line. Note---this
5179 command is position dependent. @samp{%} commands in the spec string
5180 before this one will see @code{-S}, @samp{%} commands in the spec string
5181 after this one will not.
5183 @item %:@var{function}(@var{args})
5184 Call the named function @var{function}, passing it @var{args}.
5185 @var{args} is first processed as a nested spec string, then split
5186 into an argument vector in the usual fashion. The function returns
5187 a string which is processed as if it had appeared literally as part
5188 of the current spec.
5190 The following built-in spec functions are provided:
5193 @item @code{if-exists}
5194 The @code{if-exists} spec function takes one argument, an absolute
5195 pathname to a file. If the file exists, @code{if-exists} returns the
5196 pathname. Here is a small example of its usage:
5200 crt0%O%s %:if-exists(crti%O%s) crtbegin%O%s
5203 @item @code{if-exists-else}
5204 The @code{if-exists-else} spec function is similar to the @code{if-exists}
5205 spec function, except that it takes two arguments. The first argument is
5206 an absolute pathname to a file. If the file exists, @code{if-exists-else}
5207 returns the pathname. If it does not exist, it returns the second argument.
5208 This way, @code{if-exists-else} can be used to select one file or another,
5209 based on the existence of the first. Here is a small example of its usage:
5213 crt0%O%s %:if-exists(crti%O%s) %:if-exists-else(crtbeginT%O%s crtbegin%O%s)
5218 Substitutes the @code{-S} switch, if that switch was given to GCC@.
5219 If that switch was not specified, this substitutes nothing. Note that
5220 the leading dash is omitted when specifying this option, and it is
5221 automatically inserted if the substitution is performed. Thus the spec
5222 string @samp{%@{foo@}} would match the command-line option @option{-foo}
5223 and would output the command line option @option{-foo}.
5225 @item %W@{@code{S}@}
5226 Like %@{@code{S}@} but mark last argument supplied within as a file to be
5229 @item %@{@code{S}*@}
5230 Substitutes all the switches specified to GCC whose names start
5231 with @code{-S}, but which also take an argument. This is used for
5232 switches like @option{-o}, @option{-D}, @option{-I}, etc.
5233 GCC considers @option{-o foo} as being
5234 one switch whose names starts with @samp{o}. %@{o*@} would substitute this
5235 text, including the space. Thus two arguments would be generated.
5237 @item %@{@code{S}*&@code{T}*@}
5238 Like %@{@code{S}*@}, but preserve order of @code{S} and @code{T} options
5239 (the order of @code{S} and @code{T} in the spec is not significant).
5240 There can be any number of ampersand-separated variables; for each the
5241 wild card is optional. Useful for CPP as @samp{%@{D*&U*&A*@}}.
5243 @item %@{@code{S}:@code{X}@}
5244 Substitutes @code{X}, if the @samp{-S} switch was given to GCC@.
5246 @item %@{!@code{S}:@code{X}@}
5247 Substitutes @code{X}, if the @samp{-S} switch was @emph{not} given to GCC@.
5249 @item %@{@code{S}*:@code{X}@}
5250 Substitutes @code{X} if one or more switches whose names start with
5251 @code{-S} are specified to GCC@. Normally @code{X} is substituted only
5252 once, no matter how many such switches appeared. However, if @code{%*}
5253 appears somewhere in @code{X}, then @code{X} will be substituted once
5254 for each matching switch, with the @code{%*} replaced by the part of
5255 that switch that matched the @code{*}.
5257 @item %@{.@code{S}:@code{X}@}
5258 Substitutes @code{X}, if processing a file with suffix @code{S}.
5260 @item %@{!.@code{S}:@code{X}@}
5261 Substitutes @code{X}, if @emph{not} processing a file with suffix @code{S}.
5263 @item %@{@code{S}|@code{P}:@code{X}@}
5264 Substitutes @code{X} if either @code{-S} or @code{-P} was given to GCC@.
5265 This may be combined with @samp{!}, @samp{.}, and @code{*} sequences as well,
5266 although they have a stronger binding than the @samp{|}. If @code{%*}
5267 appears in @code{X}, all of the alternatives must be starred, and only
5268 the first matching alternative is substituted.
5270 For example, a spec string like this:
5273 %@{.c:-foo@} %@{!.c:-bar@} %@{.c|d:-baz@} %@{!.c|d:-boggle@}
5276 will output the following command-line options from the following input
5277 command-line options:
5282 -d fred.c -foo -baz -boggle
5283 -d jim.d -bar -baz -boggle
5286 @item %@{S:X; T:Y; :D@}
5288 If @code{S} was given to GCC, substitues @code{X}; else if @code{T} was
5289 given to GCC, substitues @code{Y}; else substitutes @code{D}. There can
5290 be as many clauses as you need. This may be combined with @code{.},
5291 @code{!}, @code{|}, and @code{*} as needed.
5296 The conditional text @code{X} in a %@{@code{S}:@code{X}@} or similar
5297 construct may contain other nested @samp{%} constructs or spaces, or
5298 even newlines. They are processed as usual, as described above.
5299 Trailing white space in @code{X} is ignored. White space may also
5300 appear anywhere on the left side of the colon in these constructs,
5301 except between @code{.} or @code{*} and the corresponding word.
5303 The @option{-O}, @option{-f}, @option{-m}, and @option{-W} switches are
5304 handled specifically in these constructs. If another value of
5305 @option{-O} or the negated form of a @option{-f}, @option{-m}, or
5306 @option{-W} switch is found later in the command line, the earlier
5307 switch value is ignored, except with @{@code{S}*@} where @code{S} is
5308 just one letter, which passes all matching options.
5310 The character @samp{|} at the beginning of the predicate text is used to
5311 indicate that a command should be piped to the following command, but
5312 only if @option{-pipe} is specified.
5314 It is built into GCC which switches take arguments and which do not.
5315 (You might think it would be useful to generalize this to allow each
5316 compiler's spec to say which switches take arguments. But this cannot
5317 be done in a consistent fashion. GCC cannot even decide which input
5318 files have been specified without knowing which switches take arguments,
5319 and it must know which input files to compile in order to tell which
5322 GCC also knows implicitly that arguments starting in @option{-l} are to be
5323 treated as compiler output files, and passed to the linker in their
5324 proper position among the other output files.
5326 @c man begin OPTIONS
5328 @node Target Options
5329 @section Specifying Target Machine and Compiler Version
5330 @cindex target options
5331 @cindex cross compiling
5332 @cindex specifying machine version
5333 @cindex specifying compiler version and target machine
5334 @cindex compiler version, specifying
5335 @cindex target machine, specifying
5337 The usual way to run GCC is to run the executable called @file{gcc}, or
5338 @file{<machine>-gcc} when cross-compiling, or
5339 @file{<machine>-gcc-<version>} to run a version other than the one that
5340 was installed last. Sometimes this is inconvenient, so GCC provides
5341 options that will switch to another cross-compiler or version.
5344 @item -b @var{machine}
5346 The argument @var{machine} specifies the target machine for compilation.
5348 The value to use for @var{machine} is the same as was specified as the
5349 machine type when configuring GCC as a cross-compiler. For
5350 example, if a cross-compiler was configured with @samp{configure
5351 i386v}, meaning to compile for an 80386 running System V, then you
5352 would specify @option{-b i386v} to run that cross compiler.
5354 @item -V @var{version}
5356 The argument @var{version} specifies which version of GCC to run.
5357 This is useful when multiple versions are installed. For example,
5358 @var{version} might be @samp{2.0}, meaning to run GCC version 2.0.
5361 The @option{-V} and @option{-b} options work by running the
5362 @file{<machine>-gcc-<version>} executable, so there's no real reason to
5363 use them if you can just run that directly.
5365 @node Submodel Options
5366 @section Hardware Models and Configurations
5367 @cindex submodel options
5368 @cindex specifying hardware config
5369 @cindex hardware models and configurations, specifying
5370 @cindex machine dependent options
5372 Earlier we discussed the standard option @option{-b} which chooses among
5373 different installed compilers for completely different target
5374 machines, such as VAX vs.@: 68000 vs.@: 80386.
5376 In addition, each of these target machine types can have its own
5377 special options, starting with @samp{-m}, to choose among various
5378 hardware models or configurations---for example, 68010 vs 68020,
5379 floating coprocessor or none. A single installed version of the
5380 compiler can compile for any model or configuration, according to the
5383 Some configurations of the compiler also support additional special
5384 options, usually for compatibility with other compilers on the same
5387 These options are defined by the macro @code{TARGET_SWITCHES} in the
5388 machine description. The default for the options is also defined by
5389 that macro, which enables you to change the defaults.
5401 * RS/6000 and PowerPC Options::
5405 * i386 and x86-64 Options::
5407 * Intel 960 Options::
5408 * DEC Alpha Options::
5409 * DEC Alpha/VMS Options::
5412 * System V Options::
5413 * TMS320C3x/C4x Options::
5421 * S/390 and zSeries Options::
5425 * Xstormy16 Options::
5430 @node M680x0 Options
5431 @subsection M680x0 Options
5432 @cindex M680x0 options
5434 These are the @samp{-m} options defined for the 68000 series. The default
5435 values for these options depends on which style of 68000 was selected when
5436 the compiler was configured; the defaults for the most common choices are
5444 Generate output for a 68000. This is the default
5445 when the compiler is configured for 68000-based systems.
5447 Use this option for microcontrollers with a 68000 or EC000 core,
5448 including the 68008, 68302, 68306, 68307, 68322, 68328 and 68356.
5454 Generate output for a 68020. This is the default
5455 when the compiler is configured for 68020-based systems.
5459 Generate output containing 68881 instructions for floating point.
5460 This is the default for most 68020 systems unless @option{--nfp} was
5461 specified when the compiler was configured.
5465 Generate output for a 68030. This is the default when the compiler is
5466 configured for 68030-based systems.
5470 Generate output for a 68040. This is the default when the compiler is
5471 configured for 68040-based systems.
5473 This option inhibits the use of 68881/68882 instructions that have to be
5474 emulated by software on the 68040. Use this option if your 68040 does not
5475 have code to emulate those instructions.
5479 Generate output for a 68060. This is the default when the compiler is
5480 configured for 68060-based systems.
5482 This option inhibits the use of 68020 and 68881/68882 instructions that
5483 have to be emulated by software on the 68060. Use this option if your 68060
5484 does not have code to emulate those instructions.
5488 Generate output for a CPU32. This is the default
5489 when the compiler is configured for CPU32-based systems.
5491 Use this option for microcontrollers with a
5492 CPU32 or CPU32+ core, including the 68330, 68331, 68332, 68333, 68334,
5493 68336, 68340, 68341, 68349 and 68360.
5497 Generate output for a 520X ``coldfire'' family cpu. This is the default
5498 when the compiler is configured for 520X-based systems.
5500 Use this option for microcontroller with a 5200 core, including
5501 the MCF5202, MCF5203, MCF5204 and MCF5202.
5506 Generate output for a 68040, without using any of the new instructions.
5507 This results in code which can run relatively efficiently on either a
5508 68020/68881 or a 68030 or a 68040. The generated code does use the
5509 68881 instructions that are emulated on the 68040.
5513 Generate output for a 68060, without using any of the new instructions.
5514 This results in code which can run relatively efficiently on either a
5515 68020/68881 or a 68030 or a 68040. The generated code does use the
5516 68881 instructions that are emulated on the 68060.
5520 Generate output containing Sun FPA instructions for floating point.
5523 @opindex msoft-float
5524 Generate output containing library calls for floating point.
5525 @strong{Warning:} the requisite libraries are not available for all m68k
5526 targets. Normally the facilities of the machine's usual C compiler are
5527 used, but this can't be done directly in cross-compilation. You must
5528 make your own arrangements to provide suitable library functions for
5529 cross-compilation. The embedded targets @samp{m68k-*-aout} and
5530 @samp{m68k-*-coff} do provide software floating point support.
5534 Consider type @code{int} to be 16 bits wide, like @code{short int}.
5537 @opindex mnobitfield
5538 Do not use the bit-field instructions. The @option{-m68000}, @option{-mcpu32}
5539 and @option{-m5200} options imply @w{@option{-mnobitfield}}.
5543 Do use the bit-field instructions. The @option{-m68020} option implies
5544 @option{-mbitfield}. This is the default if you use a configuration
5545 designed for a 68020.
5549 Use a different function-calling convention, in which functions
5550 that take a fixed number of arguments return with the @code{rtd}
5551 instruction, which pops their arguments while returning. This
5552 saves one instruction in the caller since there is no need to pop
5553 the arguments there.
5555 This calling convention is incompatible with the one normally
5556 used on Unix, so you cannot use it if you need to call libraries
5557 compiled with the Unix compiler.
5559 Also, you must provide function prototypes for all functions that
5560 take variable numbers of arguments (including @code{printf});
5561 otherwise incorrect code will be generated for calls to those
5564 In addition, seriously incorrect code will result if you call a
5565 function with too many arguments. (Normally, extra arguments are
5566 harmlessly ignored.)
5568 The @code{rtd} instruction is supported by the 68010, 68020, 68030,
5569 68040, 68060 and CPU32 processors, but not by the 68000 or 5200.
5572 @itemx -mno-align-int
5574 @opindex mno-align-int
5575 Control whether GCC aligns @code{int}, @code{long}, @code{long long},
5576 @code{float}, @code{double}, and @code{long double} variables on a 32-bit
5577 boundary (@option{-malign-int}) or a 16-bit boundary (@option{-mno-align-int}).
5578 Aligning variables on 32-bit boundaries produces code that runs somewhat
5579 faster on processors with 32-bit busses at the expense of more memory.
5581 @strong{Warning:} if you use the @option{-malign-int} switch, GCC will
5582 align structures containing the above types differently than
5583 most published application binary interface specifications for the m68k.
5587 Use the pc-relative addressing mode of the 68000 directly, instead of
5588 using a global offset table. At present, this option implies @option{-fpic},
5589 allowing at most a 16-bit offset for pc-relative addressing. @option{-fPIC} is
5590 not presently supported with @option{-mpcrel}, though this could be supported for
5591 68020 and higher processors.
5593 @item -mno-strict-align
5594 @itemx -mstrict-align
5595 @opindex mno-strict-align
5596 @opindex mstrict-align
5597 Do not (do) assume that unaligned memory references will be handled by
5602 @node M68hc1x Options
5603 @subsection M68hc1x Options
5604 @cindex M68hc1x options
5606 These are the @samp{-m} options defined for the 68hc11 and 68hc12
5607 microcontrollers. The default values for these options depends on
5608 which style of microcontroller was selected when the compiler was configured;
5609 the defaults for the most common choices are given below.
5616 Generate output for a 68HC11. This is the default
5617 when the compiler is configured for 68HC11-based systems.
5623 Generate output for a 68HC12. This is the default
5624 when the compiler is configured for 68HC12-based systems.
5630 Generate output for a 68HCS12.
5633 @opindex mauto-incdec
5634 Enable the use of 68HC12 pre and post auto-increment and auto-decrement
5641 Enable the use of 68HC12 min and max instructions.
5644 @itemx -mno-long-calls
5645 @opindex mlong-calls
5646 @opindex mno-long-calls
5647 Treat all calls as being far away (near). If calls are assumed to be
5648 far away, the compiler will use the @code{call} instruction to
5649 call a function and the @code{rtc} instruction for returning.
5653 Consider type @code{int} to be 16 bits wide, like @code{short int}.
5655 @item -msoft-reg-count=@var{count}
5656 @opindex msoft-reg-count
5657 Specify the number of pseudo-soft registers which are used for the
5658 code generation. The maximum number is 32. Using more pseudo-soft
5659 register may or may not result in better code depending on the program.
5660 The default is 4 for 68HC11 and 2 for 68HC12.
5665 @subsection VAX Options
5668 These @samp{-m} options are defined for the VAX:
5673 Do not output certain jump instructions (@code{aobleq} and so on)
5674 that the Unix assembler for the VAX cannot handle across long
5679 Do output those jump instructions, on the assumption that you
5680 will assemble with the GNU assembler.
5684 Output code for g-format floating point numbers instead of d-format.
5688 @subsection SPARC Options
5689 @cindex SPARC options
5691 These @samp{-m} switches are supported on the SPARC:
5696 @opindex mno-app-regs
5698 Specify @option{-mapp-regs} to generate output using the global registers
5699 2 through 4, which the SPARC SVR4 ABI reserves for applications. This
5702 To be fully SVR4 ABI compliant at the cost of some performance loss,
5703 specify @option{-mno-app-regs}. You should compile libraries and system
5704 software with this option.
5709 @opindex mhard-float
5710 Generate output containing floating point instructions. This is the
5716 @opindex msoft-float
5717 Generate output containing library calls for floating point.
5718 @strong{Warning:} the requisite libraries are not available for all SPARC
5719 targets. Normally the facilities of the machine's usual C compiler are
5720 used, but this cannot be done directly in cross-compilation. You must make
5721 your own arrangements to provide suitable library functions for
5722 cross-compilation. The embedded targets @samp{sparc-*-aout} and
5723 @samp{sparclite-*-*} do provide software floating point support.
5725 @option{-msoft-float} changes the calling convention in the output file;
5726 therefore, it is only useful if you compile @emph{all} of a program with
5727 this option. In particular, you need to compile @file{libgcc.a}, the
5728 library that comes with GCC, with @option{-msoft-float} in order for
5731 @item -mhard-quad-float
5732 @opindex mhard-quad-float
5733 Generate output containing quad-word (long double) floating point
5736 @item -msoft-quad-float
5737 @opindex msoft-quad-float
5738 Generate output containing library calls for quad-word (long double)
5739 floating point instructions. The functions called are those specified
5740 in the SPARC ABI@. This is the default.
5742 As of this writing, there are no sparc implementations that have hardware
5743 support for the quad-word floating point instructions. They all invoke
5744 a trap handler for one of these instructions, and then the trap handler
5745 emulates the effect of the instruction. Because of the trap handler overhead,
5746 this is much slower than calling the ABI library routines. Thus the
5747 @option{-msoft-quad-float} option is the default.
5753 With @option{-mflat}, the compiler does not generate save/restore instructions
5754 and will use a ``flat'' or single register window calling convention.
5755 This model uses %i7 as the frame pointer and is compatible with the normal
5756 register window model. Code from either may be intermixed.
5757 The local registers and the input registers (0--5) are still treated as
5758 ``call saved'' registers and will be saved on the stack as necessary.
5760 With @option{-mno-flat} (the default), the compiler emits save/restore
5761 instructions (except for leaf functions) and is the normal mode of operation.
5763 @item -mno-unaligned-doubles
5764 @itemx -munaligned-doubles
5765 @opindex mno-unaligned-doubles
5766 @opindex munaligned-doubles
5767 Assume that doubles have 8 byte alignment. This is the default.
5769 With @option{-munaligned-doubles}, GCC assumes that doubles have 8 byte
5770 alignment only if they are contained in another type, or if they have an
5771 absolute address. Otherwise, it assumes they have 4 byte alignment.
5772 Specifying this option avoids some rare compatibility problems with code
5773 generated by other compilers. It is not the default because it results
5774 in a performance loss, especially for floating point code.
5776 @item -mno-faster-structs
5777 @itemx -mfaster-structs
5778 @opindex mno-faster-structs
5779 @opindex mfaster-structs
5780 With @option{-mfaster-structs}, the compiler assumes that structures
5781 should have 8 byte alignment. This enables the use of pairs of
5782 @code{ldd} and @code{std} instructions for copies in structure
5783 assignment, in place of twice as many @code{ld} and @code{st} pairs.
5784 However, the use of this changed alignment directly violates the SPARC
5785 ABI@. Thus, it's intended only for use on targets where the developer
5786 acknowledges that their resulting code will not be directly in line with
5787 the rules of the ABI@.
5793 These two options select variations on the SPARC architecture.
5795 By default (unless specifically configured for the Fujitsu SPARClite),
5796 GCC generates code for the v7 variant of the SPARC architecture.
5798 @option{-mv8} will give you SPARC v8 code. The only difference from v7
5799 code is that the compiler emits the integer multiply and integer
5800 divide instructions which exist in SPARC v8 but not in SPARC v7.
5802 @option{-msparclite} will give you SPARClite code. This adds the integer
5803 multiply, integer divide step and scan (@code{ffs}) instructions which
5804 exist in SPARClite but not in SPARC v7.
5806 These options are deprecated and will be deleted in a future GCC release.
5807 They have been replaced with @option{-mcpu=xxx}.
5812 @opindex msupersparc
5813 These two options select the processor for which the code is optimized.
5815 With @option{-mcypress} (the default), the compiler optimizes code for the
5816 Cypress CY7C602 chip, as used in the SPARCStation/SPARCServer 3xx series.
5817 This is also appropriate for the older SPARCStation 1, 2, IPX etc.
5819 With @option{-msupersparc} the compiler optimizes code for the SuperSPARC cpu, as
5820 used in the SPARCStation 10, 1000 and 2000 series. This flag also enables use
5821 of the full SPARC v8 instruction set.
5823 These options are deprecated and will be deleted in a future GCC release.
5824 They have been replaced with @option{-mcpu=xxx}.
5826 @item -mcpu=@var{cpu_type}
5828 Set the instruction set, register set, and instruction scheduling parameters
5829 for machine type @var{cpu_type}. Supported values for @var{cpu_type} are
5830 @samp{v7}, @samp{cypress}, @samp{v8}, @samp{supersparc}, @samp{sparclite},
5831 @samp{hypersparc}, @samp{sparclite86x}, @samp{f930}, @samp{f934},
5832 @samp{sparclet}, @samp{tsc701}, @samp{v9}, @samp{ultrasparc}, and
5835 Default instruction scheduling parameters are used for values that select
5836 an architecture and not an implementation. These are @samp{v7}, @samp{v8},
5837 @samp{sparclite}, @samp{sparclet}, @samp{v9}.
5839 Here is a list of each supported architecture and their supported
5844 v8: supersparc, hypersparc
5845 sparclite: f930, f934, sparclite86x
5847 v9: ultrasparc, ultrasparc3
5850 @item -mtune=@var{cpu_type}
5852 Set the instruction scheduling parameters for machine type
5853 @var{cpu_type}, but do not set the instruction set or register set that the
5854 option @option{-mcpu=@var{cpu_type}} would.
5856 The same values for @option{-mcpu=@var{cpu_type}} can be used for
5857 @option{-mtune=@var{cpu_type}}, but the only useful values are those
5858 that select a particular cpu implementation. Those are @samp{cypress},
5859 @samp{supersparc}, @samp{hypersparc}, @samp{f930}, @samp{f934},
5860 @samp{sparclite86x}, @samp{tsc701}, @samp{ultrasparc}, and
5865 These @samp{-m} switches are supported in addition to the above
5866 on the SPARCLET processor.
5869 @item -mlittle-endian
5870 @opindex mlittle-endian
5871 Generate code for a processor running in little-endian mode.
5875 Treat register @code{%g0} as a normal register.
5876 GCC will continue to clobber it as necessary but will not assume
5877 it always reads as 0.
5879 @item -mbroken-saverestore
5880 @opindex mbroken-saverestore
5881 Generate code that does not use non-trivial forms of the @code{save} and
5882 @code{restore} instructions. Early versions of the SPARCLET processor do
5883 not correctly handle @code{save} and @code{restore} instructions used with
5884 arguments. They correctly handle them used without arguments. A @code{save}
5885 instruction used without arguments increments the current window pointer
5886 but does not allocate a new stack frame. It is assumed that the window
5887 overflow trap handler will properly handle this case as will interrupt
5891 These @samp{-m} switches are supported in addition to the above
5892 on SPARC V9 processors in 64-bit environments.
5895 @item -mlittle-endian
5896 @opindex mlittle-endian
5897 Generate code for a processor running in little-endian mode.
5903 Generate code for a 32-bit or 64-bit environment.
5904 The 32-bit environment sets int, long and pointer to 32 bits.
5905 The 64-bit environment sets int to 32 bits and long and pointer
5908 @item -mcmodel=medlow
5909 @opindex mcmodel=medlow
5910 Generate code for the Medium/Low code model: the program must be linked
5911 in the low 32 bits of the address space. Pointers are 64 bits.
5912 Programs can be statically or dynamically linked.
5914 @item -mcmodel=medmid
5915 @opindex mcmodel=medmid
5916 Generate code for the Medium/Middle code model: the program must be linked
5917 in the low 44 bits of the address space, the text segment must be less than
5918 2G bytes, and data segment must be within 2G of the text segment.
5919 Pointers are 64 bits.
5921 @item -mcmodel=medany
5922 @opindex mcmodel=medany
5923 Generate code for the Medium/Anywhere code model: the program may be linked
5924 anywhere in the address space, the text segment must be less than
5925 2G bytes, and data segment must be within 2G of the text segment.
5926 Pointers are 64 bits.
5928 @item -mcmodel=embmedany
5929 @opindex mcmodel=embmedany
5930 Generate code for the Medium/Anywhere code model for embedded systems:
5931 assume a 32-bit text and a 32-bit data segment, both starting anywhere
5932 (determined at link time). Register %g4 points to the base of the
5933 data segment. Pointers are still 64 bits.
5934 Programs are statically linked, PIC is not supported.
5937 @itemx -mno-stack-bias
5938 @opindex mstack-bias
5939 @opindex mno-stack-bias
5940 With @option{-mstack-bias}, GCC assumes that the stack pointer, and
5941 frame pointer if present, are offset by @minus{}2047 which must be added back
5942 when making stack frame references.
5943 Otherwise, assume no such offset is present.
5947 @subsection ARM Options
5950 These @samp{-m} options are defined for Advanced RISC Machines (ARM)
5955 @opindex mapcs-frame
5956 Generate a stack frame that is compliant with the ARM Procedure Call
5957 Standard for all functions, even if this is not strictly necessary for
5958 correct execution of the code. Specifying @option{-fomit-frame-pointer}
5959 with this option will cause the stack frames not to be generated for
5960 leaf functions. The default is @option{-mno-apcs-frame}.
5964 This is a synonym for @option{-mapcs-frame}.
5968 Generate code for a processor running with a 26-bit program counter,
5969 and conforming to the function calling standards for the APCS 26-bit
5970 option. This option replaces the @option{-m2} and @option{-m3} options
5971 of previous releases of the compiler.
5975 Generate code for a processor running with a 32-bit program counter,
5976 and conforming to the function calling standards for the APCS 32-bit
5977 option. This option replaces the @option{-m6} option of previous releases
5981 @c not currently implemented
5982 @item -mapcs-stack-check
5983 @opindex mapcs-stack-check
5984 Generate code to check the amount of stack space available upon entry to
5985 every function (that actually uses some stack space). If there is
5986 insufficient space available then either the function
5987 @samp{__rt_stkovf_split_small} or @samp{__rt_stkovf_split_big} will be
5988 called, depending upon the amount of stack space required. The run time
5989 system is required to provide these functions. The default is
5990 @option{-mno-apcs-stack-check}, since this produces smaller code.
5992 @c not currently implemented
5994 @opindex mapcs-float
5995 Pass floating point arguments using the float point registers. This is
5996 one of the variants of the APCS@. This option is recommended if the
5997 target hardware has a floating point unit or if a lot of floating point
5998 arithmetic is going to be performed by the code. The default is
5999 @option{-mno-apcs-float}, since integer only code is slightly increased in
6000 size if @option{-mapcs-float} is used.
6002 @c not currently implemented
6003 @item -mapcs-reentrant
6004 @opindex mapcs-reentrant
6005 Generate reentrant, position independent code. The default is
6006 @option{-mno-apcs-reentrant}.
6009 @item -mthumb-interwork
6010 @opindex mthumb-interwork
6011 Generate code which supports calling between the ARM and Thumb
6012 instruction sets. Without this option the two instruction sets cannot
6013 be reliably used inside one program. The default is
6014 @option{-mno-thumb-interwork}, since slightly larger code is generated
6015 when @option{-mthumb-interwork} is specified.
6017 @item -mno-sched-prolog
6018 @opindex mno-sched-prolog
6019 Prevent the reordering of instructions in the function prolog, or the
6020 merging of those instruction with the instructions in the function's
6021 body. This means that all functions will start with a recognizable set
6022 of instructions (or in fact one of a choice from a small set of
6023 different function prologues), and this information can be used to
6024 locate the start if functions inside an executable piece of code. The
6025 default is @option{-msched-prolog}.
6028 @opindex mhard-float
6029 Generate output containing floating point instructions. This is the
6033 @opindex msoft-float
6034 Generate output containing library calls for floating point.
6035 @strong{Warning:} the requisite libraries are not available for all ARM
6036 targets. Normally the facilities of the machine's usual C compiler are
6037 used, but this cannot be done directly in cross-compilation. You must make
6038 your own arrangements to provide suitable library functions for
6041 @option{-msoft-float} changes the calling convention in the output file;
6042 therefore, it is only useful if you compile @emph{all} of a program with
6043 this option. In particular, you need to compile @file{libgcc.a}, the
6044 library that comes with GCC, with @option{-msoft-float} in order for
6047 @item -mlittle-endian
6048 @opindex mlittle-endian
6049 Generate code for a processor running in little-endian mode. This is
6050 the default for all standard configurations.
6053 @opindex mbig-endian
6054 Generate code for a processor running in big-endian mode; the default is
6055 to compile code for a little-endian processor.
6057 @item -mwords-little-endian
6058 @opindex mwords-little-endian
6059 This option only applies when generating code for big-endian processors.
6060 Generate code for a little-endian word order but a big-endian byte
6061 order. That is, a byte order of the form @samp{32107654}. Note: this
6062 option should only be used if you require compatibility with code for
6063 big-endian ARM processors generated by versions of the compiler prior to
6066 @item -malignment-traps
6067 @opindex malignment-traps
6068 Generate code that will not trap if the MMU has alignment traps enabled.
6069 On ARM architectures prior to ARMv4, there were no instructions to
6070 access half-word objects stored in memory. However, when reading from
6071 memory a feature of the ARM architecture allows a word load to be used,
6072 even if the address is unaligned, and the processor core will rotate the
6073 data as it is being loaded. This option tells the compiler that such
6074 misaligned accesses will cause a MMU trap and that it should instead
6075 synthesize the access as a series of byte accesses. The compiler can
6076 still use word accesses to load half-word data if it knows that the
6077 address is aligned to a word boundary.
6079 This option is ignored when compiling for ARM architecture 4 or later,
6080 since these processors have instructions to directly access half-word
6083 @item -mno-alignment-traps
6084 @opindex mno-alignment-traps
6085 Generate code that assumes that the MMU will not trap unaligned
6086 accesses. This produces better code when the target instruction set
6087 does not have half-word memory operations (i.e.@: implementations prior to
6090 Note that you cannot use this option to access unaligned word objects,
6091 since the processor will only fetch one 32-bit aligned object from
6094 The default setting for most targets is @option{-mno-alignment-traps}, since
6095 this produces better code when there are no half-word memory
6096 instructions available.
6098 @item -mshort-load-bytes
6099 @itemx -mno-short-load-words
6100 @opindex mshort-load-bytes
6101 @opindex mno-short-load-words
6102 These are deprecated aliases for @option{-malignment-traps}.
6104 @item -mno-short-load-bytes
6105 @itemx -mshort-load-words
6106 @opindex mno-short-load-bytes
6107 @opindex mshort-load-words
6108 This are deprecated aliases for @option{-mno-alignment-traps}.
6110 @item -mcpu=@var{name}
6112 This specifies the name of the target ARM processor. GCC uses this name
6113 to determine what kind of instructions it can emit when generating
6114 assembly code. Permissible names are: @samp{arm2}, @samp{arm250},
6115 @samp{arm3}, @samp{arm6}, @samp{arm60}, @samp{arm600}, @samp{arm610},
6116 @samp{arm620}, @samp{arm7}, @samp{arm7m}, @samp{arm7d}, @samp{arm7dm},
6117 @samp{arm7di}, @samp{arm7dmi}, @samp{arm70}, @samp{arm700},
6118 @samp{arm700i}, @samp{arm710}, @samp{arm710c}, @samp{arm7100},
6119 @samp{arm7500}, @samp{arm7500fe}, @samp{arm7tdmi}, @samp{arm8},
6120 @samp{strongarm}, @samp{strongarm110}, @samp{strongarm1100},
6121 @samp{arm8}, @samp{arm810}, @samp{arm9}, @samp{arm9e}, @samp{arm920},
6122 @samp{arm920t}, @samp{arm940t}, @samp{arm9tdmi}, @samp{arm10tdmi},
6123 @samp{arm1020t}, @samp{xscale}.
6125 @itemx -mtune=@var{name}
6127 This option is very similar to the @option{-mcpu=} option, except that
6128 instead of specifying the actual target processor type, and hence
6129 restricting which instructions can be used, it specifies that GCC should
6130 tune the performance of the code as if the target were of the type
6131 specified in this option, but still choosing the instructions that it
6132 will generate based on the cpu specified by a @option{-mcpu=} option.
6133 For some ARM implementations better performance can be obtained by using
6136 @item -march=@var{name}
6138 This specifies the name of the target ARM architecture. GCC uses this
6139 name to determine what kind of instructions it can emit when generating
6140 assembly code. This option can be used in conjunction with or instead
6141 of the @option{-mcpu=} option. Permissible names are: @samp{armv2},
6142 @samp{armv2a}, @samp{armv3}, @samp{armv3m}, @samp{armv4}, @samp{armv4t},
6143 @samp{armv5}, @samp{armv5t}, @samp{armv5te}.
6145 @item -mfpe=@var{number}
6146 @itemx -mfp=@var{number}
6149 This specifies the version of the floating point emulation available on
6150 the target. Permissible values are 2 and 3. @option{-mfp=} is a synonym
6151 for @option{-mfpe=}, for compatibility with older versions of GCC@.
6153 @item -mstructure-size-boundary=@var{n}
6154 @opindex mstructure-size-boundary
6155 The size of all structures and unions will be rounded up to a multiple
6156 of the number of bits set by this option. Permissible values are 8 and
6157 32. The default value varies for different toolchains. For the COFF
6158 targeted toolchain the default value is 8. Specifying the larger number
6159 can produce faster, more efficient code, but can also increase the size
6160 of the program. The two values are potentially incompatible. Code
6161 compiled with one value cannot necessarily expect to work with code or
6162 libraries compiled with the other value, if they exchange information
6163 using structures or unions.
6165 @item -mabort-on-noreturn
6166 @opindex mabort-on-noreturn
6167 Generate a call to the function @code{abort} at the end of a
6168 @code{noreturn} function. It will be executed if the function tries to
6172 @itemx -mno-long-calls
6173 @opindex mlong-calls
6174 @opindex mno-long-calls
6175 Tells the compiler to perform function calls by first loading the
6176 address of the function into a register and then performing a subroutine
6177 call on this register. This switch is needed if the target function
6178 will lie outside of the 64 megabyte addressing range of the offset based
6179 version of subroutine call instruction.
6181 Even if this switch is enabled, not all function calls will be turned
6182 into long calls. The heuristic is that static functions, functions
6183 which have the @samp{short-call} attribute, functions that are inside
6184 the scope of a @samp{#pragma no_long_calls} directive and functions whose
6185 definitions have already been compiled within the current compilation
6186 unit, will not be turned into long calls. The exception to this rule is
6187 that weak function definitions, functions with the @samp{long-call}
6188 attribute or the @samp{section} attribute, and functions that are within
6189 the scope of a @samp{#pragma long_calls} directive, will always be
6190 turned into long calls.
6192 This feature is not enabled by default. Specifying
6193 @option{-mno-long-calls} will restore the default behavior, as will
6194 placing the function calls within the scope of a @samp{#pragma
6195 long_calls_off} directive. Note these switches have no effect on how
6196 the compiler generates code to handle function calls via function
6199 @item -mnop-fun-dllimport
6200 @opindex mnop-fun-dllimport
6201 Disable support for the @code{dllimport} attribute.
6203 @item -msingle-pic-base
6204 @opindex msingle-pic-base
6205 Treat the register used for PIC addressing as read-only, rather than
6206 loading it in the prologue for each function. The run-time system is
6207 responsible for initializing this register with an appropriate value
6208 before execution begins.
6210 @item -mpic-register=@var{reg}
6211 @opindex mpic-register
6212 Specify the register to be used for PIC addressing. The default is R10
6213 unless stack-checking is enabled, when R9 is used.
6215 @item -mpoke-function-name
6216 @opindex mpoke-function-name
6217 Write the name of each function into the text section, directly
6218 preceding the function prologue. The generated code is similar to this:
6222 .ascii "arm_poke_function_name", 0
6225 .word 0xff000000 + (t1 - t0)
6226 arm_poke_function_name
6228 stmfd sp!, @{fp, ip, lr, pc@}
6232 When performing a stack backtrace, code can inspect the value of
6233 @code{pc} stored at @code{fp + 0}. If the trace function then looks at
6234 location @code{pc - 12} and the top 8 bits are set, then we know that
6235 there is a function name embedded immediately preceding this location
6236 and has length @code{((pc[-3]) & 0xff000000)}.
6240 Generate code for the 16-bit Thumb instruction set. The default is to
6241 use the 32-bit ARM instruction set.
6244 @opindex mtpcs-frame
6245 Generate a stack frame that is compliant with the Thumb Procedure Call
6246 Standard for all non-leaf functions. (A leaf function is one that does
6247 not call any other functions.) The default is @option{-mno-tpcs-frame}.
6249 @item -mtpcs-leaf-frame
6250 @opindex mtpcs-leaf-frame
6251 Generate a stack frame that is compliant with the Thumb Procedure Call
6252 Standard for all leaf functions. (A leaf function is one that does
6253 not call any other functions.) The default is @option{-mno-apcs-leaf-frame}.
6255 @item -mcallee-super-interworking
6256 @opindex mcallee-super-interworking
6257 Gives all externally visible functions in the file being compiled an ARM
6258 instruction set header which switches to Thumb mode before executing the
6259 rest of the function. This allows these functions to be called from
6260 non-interworking code.
6262 @item -mcaller-super-interworking
6263 @opindex mcaller-super-interworking
6264 Allows calls via function pointers (including virtual functions) to
6265 execute correctly regardless of whether the target code has been
6266 compiled for interworking or not. There is a small overhead in the cost
6267 of executing a function pointer if this option is enabled.
6271 @node MN10200 Options
6272 @subsection MN10200 Options
6273 @cindex MN10200 options
6274 These @option{-m} options are defined for Matsushita MN10200 architectures:
6279 Indicate to the linker that it should perform a relaxation optimization pass
6280 to shorten branches, calls and absolute memory addresses. This option only
6281 has an effect when used on the command line for the final link step.
6283 This option makes symbolic debugging impossible.
6286 @node MN10300 Options
6287 @subsection MN10300 Options
6288 @cindex MN10300 options
6289 These @option{-m} options are defined for Matsushita MN10300 architectures:
6294 Generate code to avoid bugs in the multiply instructions for the MN10300
6295 processors. This is the default.
6298 @opindex mno-mult-bug
6299 Do not generate code to avoid bugs in the multiply instructions for the
6304 Generate code which uses features specific to the AM33 processor.
6308 Do not generate code which uses features specific to the AM33 processor. This
6313 Do not link in the C run-time initialization object file.
6317 Indicate to the linker that it should perform a relaxation optimization pass
6318 to shorten branches, calls and absolute memory addresses. This option only
6319 has an effect when used on the command line for the final link step.
6321 This option makes symbolic debugging impossible.
6325 @node M32R/D Options
6326 @subsection M32R/D Options
6327 @cindex M32R/D options
6329 These @option{-m} options are defined for Mitsubishi M32R/D architectures:
6334 Generate code for the M32R/X@.
6338 Generate code for the M32R@. This is the default.
6340 @item -mcode-model=small
6341 @opindex mcode-model=small
6342 Assume all objects live in the lower 16MB of memory (so that their addresses
6343 can be loaded with the @code{ld24} instruction), and assume all subroutines
6344 are reachable with the @code{bl} instruction.
6345 This is the default.
6347 The addressability of a particular object can be set with the
6348 @code{model} attribute.
6350 @item -mcode-model=medium
6351 @opindex mcode-model=medium
6352 Assume objects may be anywhere in the 32-bit address space (the compiler
6353 will generate @code{seth/add3} instructions to load their addresses), and
6354 assume all subroutines are reachable with the @code{bl} instruction.
6356 @item -mcode-model=large
6357 @opindex mcode-model=large
6358 Assume objects may be anywhere in the 32-bit address space (the compiler
6359 will generate @code{seth/add3} instructions to load their addresses), and
6360 assume subroutines may not be reachable with the @code{bl} instruction
6361 (the compiler will generate the much slower @code{seth/add3/jl}
6362 instruction sequence).
6365 @opindex msdata=none
6366 Disable use of the small data area. Variables will be put into
6367 one of @samp{.data}, @samp{bss}, or @samp{.rodata} (unless the
6368 @code{section} attribute has been specified).
6369 This is the default.
6371 The small data area consists of sections @samp{.sdata} and @samp{.sbss}.
6372 Objects may be explicitly put in the small data area with the
6373 @code{section} attribute using one of these sections.
6376 @opindex msdata=sdata
6377 Put small global and static data in the small data area, but do not
6378 generate special code to reference them.
6382 Put small global and static data in the small data area, and generate
6383 special instructions to reference them.
6387 @cindex smaller data references
6388 Put global and static objects less than or equal to @var{num} bytes
6389 into the small data or bss sections instead of the normal data or bss
6390 sections. The default value of @var{num} is 8.
6391 The @option{-msdata} option must be set to one of @samp{sdata} or @samp{use}
6392 for this option to have any effect.
6394 All modules should be compiled with the same @option{-G @var{num}} value.
6395 Compiling with different values of @var{num} may or may not work; if it
6396 doesn't the linker will give an error message---incorrect code will not be
6402 @subsection M88K Options
6403 @cindex M88k options
6405 These @samp{-m} options are defined for Motorola 88k architectures:
6410 Generate code that works well on both the m88100 and the
6415 Generate code that works best for the m88100, but that also
6420 Generate code that works best for the m88110, and may not run
6425 Obsolete option to be removed from the next revision.
6428 @item -midentify-revision
6429 @opindex midentify-revision
6430 @cindex identifying source, compiler (88k)
6431 Include an @code{ident} directive in the assembler output recording the
6432 source file name, compiler name and version, timestamp, and compilation
6435 @item -mno-underscores
6436 @opindex mno-underscores
6437 @cindex underscores, avoiding (88k)
6438 In assembler output, emit symbol names without adding an underscore
6439 character at the beginning of each name. The default is to use an
6440 underscore as prefix on each name.
6442 @item -mocs-debug-info
6443 @itemx -mno-ocs-debug-info
6444 @opindex mocs-debug-info
6445 @opindex mno-ocs-debug-info
6447 @cindex debugging, 88k OCS
6448 Include (or omit) additional debugging information (about registers used
6449 in each stack frame) as specified in the 88open Object Compatibility
6450 Standard, ``OCS''@. This extra information allows debugging of code that
6451 has had the frame pointer eliminated. The default for SVr4 and Delta 88
6452 SVr3.2 is to include this information; other 88k configurations omit this
6453 information by default.
6455 @item -mocs-frame-position
6456 @opindex mocs-frame-position
6457 @cindex register positions in frame (88k)
6458 When emitting COFF debugging information for automatic variables and
6459 parameters stored on the stack, use the offset from the canonical frame
6460 address, which is the stack pointer (register 31) on entry to the
6461 function. The SVr4 and Delta88 SVr3.2, and BCS configurations use
6462 @option{-mocs-frame-position}; other 88k configurations have the default
6463 @option{-mno-ocs-frame-position}.
6465 @item -mno-ocs-frame-position
6466 @opindex mno-ocs-frame-position
6467 @cindex register positions in frame (88k)
6468 When emitting COFF debugging information for automatic variables and
6469 parameters stored on the stack, use the offset from the frame pointer
6470 register (register 30). When this option is in effect, the frame
6471 pointer is not eliminated when debugging information is selected by the
6474 @item -moptimize-arg-area
6475 @opindex moptimize-arg-area
6476 @cindex arguments in frame (88k)
6477 Save space by reorganizing the stack frame. This option generates code
6478 that does not agree with the 88open specifications, but uses less
6481 @itemx -mno-optimize-arg-area
6482 @opindex mno-optimize-arg-area
6483 Do not reorganize the stack frame to save space. This is the default.
6484 The generated conforms to the specification, but uses more memory.
6486 @item -mshort-data-@var{num}
6487 @opindex mshort-data
6488 @cindex smaller data references (88k)
6489 @cindex r0-relative references (88k)
6490 Generate smaller data references by making them relative to @code{r0},
6491 which allows loading a value using a single instruction (rather than the
6492 usual two). You control which data references are affected by
6493 specifying @var{num} with this option. For example, if you specify
6494 @option{-mshort-data-512}, then the data references affected are those
6495 involving displacements of less than 512 bytes.
6496 @option{-mshort-data-@var{num}} is not effective for @var{num} greater
6499 @item -mserialize-volatile
6500 @opindex mserialize-volatile
6501 @itemx -mno-serialize-volatile
6502 @opindex mno-serialize-volatile
6503 @cindex sequential consistency on 88k
6504 Do, or don't, generate code to guarantee sequential consistency
6505 of volatile memory references. By default, consistency is
6508 The order of memory references made by the MC88110 processor does
6509 not always match the order of the instructions requesting those
6510 references. In particular, a load instruction may execute before
6511 a preceding store instruction. Such reordering violates
6512 sequential consistency of volatile memory references, when there
6513 are multiple processors. When consistency must be guaranteed,
6514 GCC generates special instructions, as needed, to force
6515 execution in the proper order.
6517 The MC88100 processor does not reorder memory references and so
6518 always provides sequential consistency. However, by default, GCC
6519 generates the special instructions to guarantee consistency
6520 even when you use @option{-m88100}, so that the code may be run on an
6521 MC88110 processor. If you intend to run your code only on the
6522 MC88100 processor, you may use @option{-mno-serialize-volatile}.
6524 The extra code generated to guarantee consistency may affect the
6525 performance of your application. If you know that you can safely
6526 forgo this guarantee, you may use @option{-mno-serialize-volatile}.
6532 @cindex assembler syntax, 88k
6534 Turn on (@option{-msvr4}) or off (@option{-msvr3}) compiler extensions
6535 related to System V release 4 (SVr4). This controls the following:
6539 Which variant of the assembler syntax to emit.
6541 @option{-msvr4} makes the C preprocessor recognize @samp{#pragma weak}
6542 that is used on System V release 4.
6544 @option{-msvr4} makes GCC issue additional declaration directives used in
6548 @option{-msvr4} is the default for the m88k-motorola-sysv4 configuration.
6549 @option{-msvr3} is the default for all other m88k configurations.
6551 @item -mversion-03.00
6552 @opindex mversion-03.00
6553 This option is obsolete, and is ignored.
6554 @c ??? which asm syntax better for GAS? option there too?
6556 @item -mno-check-zero-division
6557 @itemx -mcheck-zero-division
6558 @opindex mno-check-zero-division
6559 @opindex mcheck-zero-division
6560 @cindex zero division on 88k
6561 Do, or don't, generate code to guarantee that integer division by
6562 zero will be detected. By default, detection is guaranteed.
6564 Some models of the MC88100 processor fail to trap upon integer
6565 division by zero under certain conditions. By default, when
6566 compiling code that might be run on such a processor, GCC
6567 generates code that explicitly checks for zero-valued divisors
6568 and traps with exception number 503 when one is detected. Use of
6569 @option{-mno-check-zero-division} suppresses such checking for code
6570 generated to run on an MC88100 processor.
6572 GCC assumes that the MC88110 processor correctly detects all instances
6573 of integer division by zero. When @option{-m88110} is specified, no
6574 explicit checks for zero-valued divisors are generated, and both
6575 @option{-mcheck-zero-division} and @option{-mno-check-zero-division} are
6578 @item -muse-div-instruction
6579 @opindex muse-div-instruction
6580 @cindex divide instruction, 88k
6581 Use the div instruction for signed integer division on the
6582 MC88100 processor. By default, the div instruction is not used.
6584 On the MC88100 processor the signed integer division instruction
6585 div) traps to the operating system on a negative operand. The
6586 operating system transparently completes the operation, but at a
6587 large cost in execution time. By default, when compiling code
6588 that might be run on an MC88100 processor, GCC emulates signed
6589 integer division using the unsigned integer division instruction
6590 divu), thereby avoiding the large penalty of a trap to the
6591 operating system. Such emulation has its own, smaller, execution
6592 cost in both time and space. To the extent that your code's
6593 important signed integer division operations are performed on two
6594 nonnegative operands, it may be desirable to use the div
6595 instruction directly.
6597 On the MC88110 processor the div instruction (also known as the
6598 divs instruction) processes negative operands without trapping to
6599 the operating system. When @option{-m88110} is specified,
6600 @option{-muse-div-instruction} is ignored, and the div instruction is used
6601 for signed integer division.
6603 Note that the result of dividing @code{INT_MIN} by @minus{}1 is undefined. In
6604 particular, the behavior of such a division with and without
6605 @option{-muse-div-instruction} may differ.
6607 @item -mtrap-large-shift
6608 @itemx -mhandle-large-shift
6609 @opindex mtrap-large-shift
6610 @opindex mhandle-large-shift
6611 @cindex bit shift overflow (88k)
6612 @cindex large bit shifts (88k)
6613 Include code to detect bit-shifts of more than 31 bits; respectively,
6614 trap such shifts or emit code to handle them properly. By default GCC
6615 makes no special provision for large bit shifts.
6617 @item -mwarn-passed-structs
6618 @opindex mwarn-passed-structs
6619 @cindex structure passing (88k)
6620 Warn when a function passes a struct as an argument or result.
6621 Structure-passing conventions have changed during the evolution of the C
6622 language, and are often the source of portability problems. By default,
6623 GCC issues no such warning.
6626 @c break page here to avoid unsightly interparagraph stretch.
6630 @node RS/6000 and PowerPC Options
6631 @subsection IBM RS/6000 and PowerPC Options
6632 @cindex RS/6000 and PowerPC Options
6633 @cindex IBM RS/6000 and PowerPC Options
6635 These @samp{-m} options are defined for the IBM RS/6000 and PowerPC:
6643 @itemx -mpowerpc-gpopt
6644 @itemx -mno-powerpc-gpopt
6645 @itemx -mpowerpc-gfxopt
6646 @itemx -mno-powerpc-gfxopt
6648 @itemx -mno-powerpc64
6654 @opindex mno-powerpc
6655 @opindex mpowerpc-gpopt
6656 @opindex mno-powerpc-gpopt
6657 @opindex mpowerpc-gfxopt
6658 @opindex mno-powerpc-gfxopt
6660 @opindex mno-powerpc64
6661 GCC supports two related instruction set architectures for the
6662 RS/6000 and PowerPC@. The @dfn{POWER} instruction set are those
6663 instructions supported by the @samp{rios} chip set used in the original
6664 RS/6000 systems and the @dfn{PowerPC} instruction set is the
6665 architecture of the Motorola MPC5xx, MPC6xx, MPC8xx microprocessors, and
6666 the IBM 4xx microprocessors.
6668 Neither architecture is a subset of the other. However there is a
6669 large common subset of instructions supported by both. An MQ
6670 register is included in processors supporting the POWER architecture.
6672 You use these options to specify which instructions are available on the
6673 processor you are using. The default value of these options is
6674 determined when configuring GCC@. Specifying the
6675 @option{-mcpu=@var{cpu_type}} overrides the specification of these
6676 options. We recommend you use the @option{-mcpu=@var{cpu_type}} option
6677 rather than the options listed above.
6679 The @option{-mpower} option allows GCC to generate instructions that
6680 are found only in the POWER architecture and to use the MQ register.
6681 Specifying @option{-mpower2} implies @option{-power} and also allows GCC
6682 to generate instructions that are present in the POWER2 architecture but
6683 not the original POWER architecture.
6685 The @option{-mpowerpc} option allows GCC to generate instructions that
6686 are found only in the 32-bit subset of the PowerPC architecture.
6687 Specifying @option{-mpowerpc-gpopt} implies @option{-mpowerpc} and also allows
6688 GCC to use the optional PowerPC architecture instructions in the
6689 General Purpose group, including floating-point square root. Specifying
6690 @option{-mpowerpc-gfxopt} implies @option{-mpowerpc} and also allows GCC to
6691 use the optional PowerPC architecture instructions in the Graphics
6692 group, including floating-point select.
6694 The @option{-mpowerpc64} option allows GCC to generate the additional
6695 64-bit instructions that are found in the full PowerPC64 architecture
6696 and to treat GPRs as 64-bit, doubleword quantities. GCC defaults to
6697 @option{-mno-powerpc64}.
6699 If you specify both @option{-mno-power} and @option{-mno-powerpc}, GCC
6700 will use only the instructions in the common subset of both
6701 architectures plus some special AIX common-mode calls, and will not use
6702 the MQ register. Specifying both @option{-mpower} and @option{-mpowerpc}
6703 permits GCC to use any instruction from either architecture and to
6704 allow use of the MQ register; specify this for the Motorola MPC601.
6706 @item -mnew-mnemonics
6707 @itemx -mold-mnemonics
6708 @opindex mnew-mnemonics
6709 @opindex mold-mnemonics
6710 Select which mnemonics to use in the generated assembler code. With
6711 @option{-mnew-mnemonics}, GCC uses the assembler mnemonics defined for
6712 the PowerPC architecture. With @option{-mold-mnemonics} it uses the
6713 assembler mnemonics defined for the POWER architecture. Instructions
6714 defined in only one architecture have only one mnemonic; GCC uses that
6715 mnemonic irrespective of which of these options is specified.
6717 GCC defaults to the mnemonics appropriate for the architecture in
6718 use. Specifying @option{-mcpu=@var{cpu_type}} sometimes overrides the
6719 value of these option. Unless you are building a cross-compiler, you
6720 should normally not specify either @option{-mnew-mnemonics} or
6721 @option{-mold-mnemonics}, but should instead accept the default.
6723 @item -mcpu=@var{cpu_type}
6725 Set architecture type, register usage, choice of mnemonics, and
6726 instruction scheduling parameters for machine type @var{cpu_type}.
6727 Supported values for @var{cpu_type} are @samp{rios}, @samp{rios1},
6728 @samp{rsc}, @samp{rios2}, @samp{rs64a}, @samp{601}, @samp{602},
6729 @samp{603}, @samp{603e}, @samp{604}, @samp{604e}, @samp{620},
6730 @samp{630}, @samp{740}, @samp{7400}, @samp{7450}, @samp{750},
6731 @samp{power}, @samp{power2}, @samp{powerpc}, @samp{403}, @samp{505},
6732 @samp{801}, @samp{821}, @samp{823}, and @samp{860} and @samp{common}.
6734 @option{-mcpu=common} selects a completely generic processor. Code
6735 generated under this option will run on any POWER or PowerPC processor.
6736 GCC will use only the instructions in the common subset of both
6737 architectures, and will not use the MQ register. GCC assumes a generic
6738 processor model for scheduling purposes.
6740 @option{-mcpu=power}, @option{-mcpu=power2}, @option{-mcpu=powerpc}, and
6741 @option{-mcpu=powerpc64} specify generic POWER, POWER2, pure 32-bit
6742 PowerPC (i.e., not MPC601), and 64-bit PowerPC architecture machine
6743 types, with an appropriate, generic processor model assumed for
6744 scheduling purposes.
6746 The other options specify a specific processor. Code generated under
6747 those options will run best on that processor, and may not run at all on
6750 The @option{-mcpu} options automatically enable or disable other
6751 @option{-m} options as follows:
6755 @option{-mno-power}, @option{-mno-powerpc}
6762 @option{-mpower}, @option{-mno-powerpc}, @option{-mno-new-mnemonics}
6777 @option{-mno-power}, @option{-mpowerpc}, @option{-mnew-mnemonics}
6780 @option{-mpower}, @option{-mpowerpc}, @option{-mnew-mnemonics}
6785 @option{-mno-power}, @option{-mpowerpc}, @option{-mnew-mnemonics}, @option{-msoft-float}
6788 @item -mtune=@var{cpu_type}
6790 Set the instruction scheduling parameters for machine type
6791 @var{cpu_type}, but do not set the architecture type, register usage, or
6792 choice of mnemonics, as @option{-mcpu=@var{cpu_type}} would. The same
6793 values for @var{cpu_type} are used for @option{-mtune} as for
6794 @option{-mcpu}. If both are specified, the code generated will use the
6795 architecture, registers, and mnemonics set by @option{-mcpu}, but the
6796 scheduling parameters set by @option{-mtune}.
6801 @opindex mno-altivec
6802 These switches enable or disable the use of built-in functions that
6803 allow access to the AltiVec instruction set. You may also need to set
6804 @option{-mabi=altivec} to adjust the current ABI with AltiVec ABI
6809 Extend the current ABI with SPE ABI extensions. This does not change
6810 the default ABI, instead it adds the SPE ABI extensions to the current
6814 @opindex mabi=no-spe
6815 Disable Booke SPE ABI extensions for the current ABI.
6817 @item -misel=@var{yes/no}
6820 This switch enables or disables the generation of ISEL instructions.
6823 @itemx -mno-fp-in-toc
6824 @itemx -mno-sum-in-toc
6825 @itemx -mminimal-toc
6827 @opindex mno-fp-in-toc
6828 @opindex mno-sum-in-toc
6829 @opindex mminimal-toc
6830 Modify generation of the TOC (Table Of Contents), which is created for
6831 every executable file. The @option{-mfull-toc} option is selected by
6832 default. In that case, GCC will allocate at least one TOC entry for
6833 each unique non-automatic variable reference in your program. GCC
6834 will also place floating-point constants in the TOC@. However, only
6835 16,384 entries are available in the TOC@.
6837 If you receive a linker error message that saying you have overflowed
6838 the available TOC space, you can reduce the amount of TOC space used
6839 with the @option{-mno-fp-in-toc} and @option{-mno-sum-in-toc} options.
6840 @option{-mno-fp-in-toc} prevents GCC from putting floating-point
6841 constants in the TOC and @option{-mno-sum-in-toc} forces GCC to
6842 generate code to calculate the sum of an address and a constant at
6843 run-time instead of putting that sum into the TOC@. You may specify one
6844 or both of these options. Each causes GCC to produce very slightly
6845 slower and larger code at the expense of conserving TOC space.
6847 If you still run out of space in the TOC even when you specify both of
6848 these options, specify @option{-mminimal-toc} instead. This option causes
6849 GCC to make only one TOC entry for every file. When you specify this
6850 option, GCC will produce code that is slower and larger but which
6851 uses extremely little TOC space. You may wish to use this option
6852 only on files that contain less frequently executed code.
6858 Enable 64-bit AIX ABI and calling convention: 64-bit pointers, 64-bit
6859 @code{long} type, and the infrastructure needed to support them.
6860 Specifying @option{-maix64} implies @option{-mpowerpc64} and
6861 @option{-mpowerpc}, while @option{-maix32} disables the 64-bit ABI and
6862 implies @option{-mno-powerpc64}. GCC defaults to @option{-maix32}.
6867 @opindex mno-xl-call
6868 On AIX, pass floating-point arguments to prototyped functions beyond the
6869 register save area (RSA) on the stack in addition to argument FPRs. The
6870 AIX calling convention was extended but not initially documented to
6871 handle an obscure K&R C case of calling a function that takes the
6872 address of its arguments with fewer arguments than declared. AIX XL
6873 compilers access floating point arguments which do not fit in the
6874 RSA from the stack when a subroutine is compiled without
6875 optimization. Because always storing floating-point arguments on the
6876 stack is inefficient and rarely needed, this option is not enabled by
6877 default and only is necessary when calling subroutines compiled by AIX
6878 XL compilers without optimization.
6882 Support @dfn{IBM RS/6000 SP} @dfn{Parallel Environment} (PE)@. Link an
6883 application written to use message passing with special startup code to
6884 enable the application to run. The system must have PE installed in the
6885 standard location (@file{/usr/lpp/ppe.poe/}), or the @file{specs} file
6886 must be overridden with the @option{-specs=} option to specify the
6887 appropriate directory location. The Parallel Environment does not
6888 support threads, so the @option{-mpe} option and the @option{-pthread}
6889 option are incompatible.
6893 @opindex msoft-float
6894 @opindex mhard-float
6895 Generate code that does not use (uses) the floating-point register set.
6896 Software floating point emulation is provided if you use the
6897 @option{-msoft-float} option, and pass the option to GCC when linking.
6900 @itemx -mno-multiple
6902 @opindex mno-multiple
6903 Generate code that uses (does not use) the load multiple word
6904 instructions and the store multiple word instructions. These
6905 instructions are generated by default on POWER systems, and not
6906 generated on PowerPC systems. Do not use @option{-mmultiple} on little
6907 endian PowerPC systems, since those instructions do not work when the
6908 processor is in little endian mode. The exceptions are PPC740 and
6909 PPC750 which permit the instructions usage in little endian mode.
6915 Generate code that uses (does not use) the load string instructions
6916 and the store string word instructions to save multiple registers and
6917 do small block moves. These instructions are generated by default on
6918 POWER systems, and not generated on PowerPC systems. Do not use
6919 @option{-mstring} on little endian PowerPC systems, since those
6920 instructions do not work when the processor is in little endian mode.
6921 The exceptions are PPC740 and PPC750 which permit the instructions
6922 usage in little endian mode.
6928 Generate code that uses (does not use) the load or store instructions
6929 that update the base register to the address of the calculated memory
6930 location. These instructions are generated by default. If you use
6931 @option{-mno-update}, there is a small window between the time that the
6932 stack pointer is updated and the address of the previous frame is
6933 stored, which means code that walks the stack frame across interrupts or
6934 signals may get corrupted data.
6937 @itemx -mno-fused-madd
6938 @opindex mfused-madd
6939 @opindex mno-fused-madd
6940 Generate code that uses (does not use) the floating point multiply and
6941 accumulate instructions. These instructions are generated by default if
6942 hardware floating is used.
6944 @item -mno-bit-align
6946 @opindex mno-bit-align
6948 On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems do not (do) force structures
6949 and unions that contain bit-fields to be aligned to the base type of the
6952 For example, by default a structure containing nothing but 8
6953 @code{unsigned} bit-fields of length 1 would be aligned to a 4 byte
6954 boundary and have a size of 4 bytes. By using @option{-mno-bit-align},
6955 the structure would be aligned to a 1 byte boundary and be one byte in
6958 @item -mno-strict-align
6959 @itemx -mstrict-align
6960 @opindex mno-strict-align
6961 @opindex mstrict-align
6962 On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems do not (do) assume that
6963 unaligned memory references will be handled by the system.
6966 @itemx -mno-relocatable
6967 @opindex mrelocatable
6968 @opindex mno-relocatable
6969 On embedded PowerPC systems generate code that allows (does not allow)
6970 the program to be relocated to a different address at runtime. If you
6971 use @option{-mrelocatable} on any module, all objects linked together must
6972 be compiled with @option{-mrelocatable} or @option{-mrelocatable-lib}.
6974 @item -mrelocatable-lib
6975 @itemx -mno-relocatable-lib
6976 @opindex mrelocatable-lib
6977 @opindex mno-relocatable-lib
6978 On embedded PowerPC systems generate code that allows (does not allow)
6979 the program to be relocated to a different address at runtime. Modules
6980 compiled with @option{-mrelocatable-lib} can be linked with either modules
6981 compiled without @option{-mrelocatable} and @option{-mrelocatable-lib} or
6982 with modules compiled with the @option{-mrelocatable} options.
6988 On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems do not (do) assume that
6989 register 2 contains a pointer to a global area pointing to the addresses
6990 used in the program.
6993 @itemx -mlittle-endian
6995 @opindex mlittle-endian
6996 On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems compile code for the
6997 processor in little endian mode. The @option{-mlittle-endian} option is
6998 the same as @option{-mlittle}.
7003 @opindex mbig-endian
7004 On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems compile code for the
7005 processor in big endian mode. The @option{-mbig-endian} option is
7006 the same as @option{-mbig}.
7010 On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems compile code using calling
7011 conventions that adheres to the March 1995 draft of the System V
7012 Application Binary Interface, PowerPC processor supplement. This is the
7013 default unless you configured GCC using @samp{powerpc-*-eabiaix}.
7015 @item -mcall-sysv-eabi
7016 @opindex mcall-sysv-eabi
7017 Specify both @option{-mcall-sysv} and @option{-meabi} options.
7019 @item -mcall-sysv-noeabi
7020 @opindex mcall-sysv-noeabi
7021 Specify both @option{-mcall-sysv} and @option{-mno-eabi} options.
7025 On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems compile code using calling
7026 conventions that are similar to those used on AIX@. This is the
7027 default if you configured GCC using @samp{powerpc-*-eabiaix}.
7029 @item -mcall-solaris
7030 @opindex mcall-solaris
7031 On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems compile code for the Solaris
7035 @opindex mcall-linux
7036 On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems compile code for the
7037 Linux-based GNU system.
7041 On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems compile code for the
7042 Hurd-based GNU system.
7045 @opindex mcall-netbsd
7046 On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems compile code for the
7047 NetBSD operating system.
7049 @item -maix-struct-return
7050 @opindex maix-struct-return
7051 Return all structures in memory (as specified by the AIX ABI)@.
7053 @item -msvr4-struct-return
7054 @opindex msvr4-struct-return
7055 Return structures smaller than 8 bytes in registers (as specified by the
7059 @opindex mabi=altivec
7060 Extend the current ABI with AltiVec ABI extensions. This does not
7061 change the default ABI, instead it adds the AltiVec ABI extensions to
7064 @item -mabi=no-altivec
7065 @opindex mabi=no-altivec
7066 Disable AltiVec ABI extensions for the current ABI.
7069 @itemx -mno-prototype
7071 @opindex mno-prototype
7072 On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems assume that all calls to
7073 variable argument functions are properly prototyped. Otherwise, the
7074 compiler must insert an instruction before every non prototyped call to
7075 set or clear bit 6 of the condition code register (@var{CR}) to
7076 indicate whether floating point values were passed in the floating point
7077 registers in case the function takes a variable arguments. With
7078 @option{-mprototype}, only calls to prototyped variable argument functions
7079 will set or clear the bit.
7083 On embedded PowerPC systems, assume that the startup module is called
7084 @file{sim-crt0.o} and that the standard C libraries are @file{libsim.a} and
7085 @file{libc.a}. This is the default for @samp{powerpc-*-eabisim}.
7090 On embedded PowerPC systems, assume that the startup module is called
7091 @file{crt0.o} and the standard C libraries are @file{libmvme.a} and
7096 On embedded PowerPC systems, assume that the startup module is called
7097 @file{crt0.o} and the standard C libraries are @file{libads.a} and
7101 @opindex myellowknife
7102 On embedded PowerPC systems, assume that the startup module is called
7103 @file{crt0.o} and the standard C libraries are @file{libyk.a} and
7108 On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems, specify that you are
7109 compiling for a VxWorks system.
7113 Specify that you are compiling for the WindISS simulation environment.
7117 On embedded PowerPC systems, set the @var{PPC_EMB} bit in the ELF flags
7118 header to indicate that @samp{eabi} extended relocations are used.
7124 On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems do (do not) adhere to the
7125 Embedded Applications Binary Interface (eabi) which is a set of
7126 modifications to the System V.4 specifications. Selecting @option{-meabi}
7127 means that the stack is aligned to an 8 byte boundary, a function
7128 @code{__eabi} is called to from @code{main} to set up the eabi
7129 environment, and the @option{-msdata} option can use both @code{r2} and
7130 @code{r13} to point to two separate small data areas. Selecting
7131 @option{-mno-eabi} means that the stack is aligned to a 16 byte boundary,
7132 do not call an initialization function from @code{main}, and the
7133 @option{-msdata} option will only use @code{r13} to point to a single
7134 small data area. The @option{-meabi} option is on by default if you
7135 configured GCC using one of the @samp{powerpc*-*-eabi*} options.
7138 @opindex msdata=eabi
7139 On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems, put small initialized
7140 @code{const} global and static data in the @samp{.sdata2} section, which
7141 is pointed to by register @code{r2}. Put small initialized
7142 non-@code{const} global and static data in the @samp{.sdata} section,
7143 which is pointed to by register @code{r13}. Put small uninitialized
7144 global and static data in the @samp{.sbss} section, which is adjacent to
7145 the @samp{.sdata} section. The @option{-msdata=eabi} option is
7146 incompatible with the @option{-mrelocatable} option. The
7147 @option{-msdata=eabi} option also sets the @option{-memb} option.
7150 @opindex msdata=sysv
7151 On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems, put small global and static
7152 data in the @samp{.sdata} section, which is pointed to by register
7153 @code{r13}. Put small uninitialized global and static data in the
7154 @samp{.sbss} section, which is adjacent to the @samp{.sdata} section.
7155 The @option{-msdata=sysv} option is incompatible with the
7156 @option{-mrelocatable} option.
7158 @item -msdata=default
7160 @opindex msdata=default
7162 On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems, if @option{-meabi} is used,
7163 compile code the same as @option{-msdata=eabi}, otherwise compile code the
7164 same as @option{-msdata=sysv}.
7167 @opindex msdata-data
7168 On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems, put small global and static
7169 data in the @samp{.sdata} section. Put small uninitialized global and
7170 static data in the @samp{.sbss} section. Do not use register @code{r13}
7171 to address small data however. This is the default behavior unless
7172 other @option{-msdata} options are used.
7176 @opindex msdata=none
7178 On embedded PowerPC systems, put all initialized global and static data
7179 in the @samp{.data} section, and all uninitialized data in the
7180 @samp{.bss} section.
7184 @cindex smaller data references (PowerPC)
7185 @cindex .sdata/.sdata2 references (PowerPC)
7186 On embedded PowerPC systems, put global and static items less than or
7187 equal to @var{num} bytes into the small data or bss sections instead of
7188 the normal data or bss section. By default, @var{num} is 8. The
7189 @option{-G @var{num}} switch is also passed to the linker.
7190 All modules should be compiled with the same @option{-G @var{num}} value.
7193 @itemx -mno-regnames
7195 @opindex mno-regnames
7196 On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems do (do not) emit register
7197 names in the assembly language output using symbolic forms.
7200 @itemx -mno-longcall
7202 @opindex mno-longcall
7203 Default to making all function calls via pointers, so that functions
7204 which reside further than 64 megabytes (67,108,864 bytes) from the
7205 current location can be called. This setting can be overridden by the
7206 @code{shortcall} function attribute, or by @code{#pragma longcall(0)}.
7208 Some linkers are capable of detecting out-of-range calls and generating
7209 glue code on the fly. On these systems, long calls are unnecessary and
7210 generate slower code. As of this writing, the AIX linker can do this,
7211 as can the GNU linker for PowerPC/64. It is planned to add this feature
7212 to the GNU linker for 32-bit PowerPC systems as well.
7214 In the future, we may cause GCC to ignore all longcall specifications
7215 when the linker is known to generate glue.
7219 Adds support for multithreading with the @dfn{pthreads} library.
7220 This option sets flags for both the preprocessor and linker.
7224 @node Darwin Options
7225 @subsection Darwin Options
7226 @cindex Darwin options
7230 Loads all members of static archive libraries.
7231 See man ld(1) for more information.
7233 @item -arch_errors_fatal
7234 @opindex arch_errors_fatal
7235 Cause the errors having to do with files that have the wrong architecture
7239 @opindex bind_at_load
7240 Causes the output file to be marked such that the dynamic linker will
7241 bind all undefined references when the file is loaded or launched.
7245 Produce a Mach-o bundle format file.
7246 See man ld(1) for more information.
7248 @item -bundle_loader @var{executable}
7249 @opindex bundle_loader
7250 This specifies the @var{executable} that will be loading the build
7251 output file being linked. See man ld(1) for more information.
7253 @item -allowable_client @var{client_name}
7257 @item -compatibility_version
7258 @item -current_version
7259 @item -dependency-file
7261 @item -dylinker_install_name
7264 @item -exported_symbols_list
7266 @item -flat_namespace
7267 @item -force_cpusubtype_ALL
7268 @item -force_flat_namespace
7269 @item -headerpad_max_install_names
7273 @item -keep_private_externs
7275 @item -multiply_defined
7276 @item -multiply_defined_unused
7280 @item -noseglinkedit
7281 @item -pagezero_size
7283 @item -prebind_all_twolevel_modules
7284 @item -private_bundle
7285 @item -read_only_relocs
7287 @item -sectobjectsymbols
7291 @item -sectobjectsymbols
7293 @item -seg_addr_table
7294 @item -seg_addr_table_filename
7297 @item -segs_read_only_addr
7298 @item -segs_read_write_addr
7299 @item -single_module
7303 @item -twolevel_namespace
7306 @item -unexported_symbols_list
7307 @item -weak_reference_mismatches
7310 @opindex allowable_client
7312 @opindex client_name
7313 @opindex compatibility_version
7314 @opindex current_version
7315 @opindex dependency-file
7317 @opindex dylinker_install_name
7320 @opindex exported_symbols_list
7322 @opindex flat_namespace
7323 @opindex force_cpusubtype_ALL
7324 @opindex force_flat_namespace
7325 @opindex headerpad_max_install_names
7328 @opindex install_name
7329 @opindex keep_private_externs
7330 @opindex multi_module
7331 @opindex multiply_defined
7332 @opindex multiply_defined_unused
7334 @opindex nomultidefs
7336 @opindex noseglinkedit
7337 @opindex pagezero_size
7339 @opindex prebind_all_twolevel_modules
7340 @opindex private_bundle
7341 @opindex read_only_relocs
7343 @opindex sectobjectsymbols
7347 @opindex sectobjectsymbols
7349 @opindex seg_addr_table
7350 @opindex seg_addr_table_filename
7351 @opindex seglinkedit
7353 @opindex segs_read_only_addr
7354 @opindex segs_read_write_addr
7355 @opindex single_module
7357 @opindex sub_library
7358 @opindex sub_umbrella
7359 @opindex twolevel_namespace
7362 @opindex unexported_symbols_list
7363 @opindex weak_reference_mismatches
7364 @opindex whatsloaded
7366 This options are available for Darwin linker. Darwin linker man page
7367 describes them in detail.
7372 @subsection IBM RT Options
7374 @cindex IBM RT options
7376 These @samp{-m} options are defined for the IBM RT PC:
7380 @opindex min-line-mul
7381 Use an in-line code sequence for integer multiplies. This is the
7384 @item -mcall-lib-mul
7385 @opindex mcall-lib-mul
7386 Call @code{lmul$$} for integer multiples.
7388 @item -mfull-fp-blocks
7389 @opindex mfull-fp-blocks
7390 Generate full-size floating point data blocks, including the minimum
7391 amount of scratch space recommended by IBM@. This is the default.
7393 @item -mminimum-fp-blocks
7394 @opindex mminimum-fp-blocks
7395 Do not include extra scratch space in floating point data blocks. This
7396 results in smaller code, but slower execution, since scratch space must
7397 be allocated dynamically.
7399 @cindex @file{stdarg.h} and RT PC
7400 @item -mfp-arg-in-fpregs
7401 @opindex mfp-arg-in-fpregs
7402 Use a calling sequence incompatible with the IBM calling convention in
7403 which floating point arguments are passed in floating point registers.
7404 Note that @code{stdarg.h} will not work with floating point operands
7405 if this option is specified.
7407 @item -mfp-arg-in-gregs
7408 @opindex mfp-arg-in-gregs
7409 Use the normal calling convention for floating point arguments. This is
7412 @item -mhc-struct-return
7413 @opindex mhc-struct-return
7414 Return structures of more than one word in memory, rather than in a
7415 register. This provides compatibility with the MetaWare HighC (hc)
7416 compiler. Use the option @option{-fpcc-struct-return} for compatibility
7417 with the Portable C Compiler (pcc).
7419 @item -mnohc-struct-return
7420 @opindex mnohc-struct-return
7421 Return some structures of more than one word in registers, when
7422 convenient. This is the default. For compatibility with the
7423 IBM-supplied compilers, use the option @option{-fpcc-struct-return} or the
7424 option @option{-mhc-struct-return}.
7428 @subsection MIPS Options
7429 @cindex MIPS options
7431 These @samp{-m} options are defined for the MIPS family of computers:
7435 @item -march=@var{arch}
7437 Generate code that will run on @var{arch}, which can be the name of a
7438 generic MIPS ISA, or the name of a particular processor.
7440 @samp{mips1}, @samp{mips2}, @samp{mips3}, @samp{mips4},
7441 @samp{mips32}, @samp{mips32r2}, and @samp{mips64}.
7442 The processor names are:
7443 @samp{4kc}, @samp{4kp}, @samp{5kc}, @samp{20kc},
7445 @samp{r2000}, @samp{r3000}, @samp{r3900}, @samp{r4000}, @samp{r4400},
7446 @samp{r4600}, @samp{r4650}, @samp{r6000}, @samp{r8000},
7449 @samp{vr4100}, @samp{vr4300}, and @samp{vr5000}.
7450 The special value @samp{from-abi} selects the
7451 most compatible architecture for the selected ABI (that is,
7452 @samp{mips1} for 32-bit ABIs and @samp{mips3} for 64-bit ABIs)@.
7454 In processor names, a final @samp{000} can be abbreviated as @samp{k}
7455 (for example, @samp{-march=r2k}). Prefixes are optional, and
7456 @samp{vr} may be written @samp{r}.
7458 GCC defines two macros based on the value of this option. The first
7459 is @samp{_MIPS_ARCH}, which gives the name of target architecture, as
7460 a string. The second has the form @samp{_MIPS_ARCH_@var{foo}},
7461 where @var{foo} is the capitalized value of @samp{_MIPS_ARCH}@.
7462 For example, @samp{-march=r2000} will set @samp{_MIPS_ARCH}
7463 to @samp{"r2000"} and define the macro @samp{_MIPS_ARCH_R2000}.
7465 Note that the @samp{_MIPS_ARCH} macro uses the processor names given
7466 above. In other words, it will have the full prefix and will not
7467 abbreviate @samp{000} as @samp{k}. In the case of @samp{from-abi},
7468 the macro names the resolved architecture (either @samp{"mips1"} or
7469 @samp{"mips3"}). It names the default architecture when no
7470 @option{-march} option is given.
7472 @item -mtune=@var{arch}
7474 Optimize for @var{arch}. Among other things, this option controls
7475 the way instructions are scheduled, and the perceived cost of arithmetic
7476 operations. The list of @var{arch} values is the same as for
7479 When this option is not used, GCC will optimize for the processor
7480 specified by @option{-march}. By using @option{-march} and
7481 @option{-mtune} together, it is possible to generate code that will
7482 run on a family of processors, but optimize the code for one
7483 particular member of that family.
7485 @samp{-mtune} defines the macros @samp{_MIPS_TUNE} and
7486 @samp{_MIPS_TUNE_@var{foo}}, which work in the same way as the
7487 @samp{-march} ones described above.
7491 Equivalent to @samp{-march=mips1}.
7495 Equivalent to @samp{-march=mips2}.
7499 Equivalent to @samp{-march=mips3}.
7503 Equivalent to @samp{-march=mips4}.
7507 Equivalent to @samp{-march=mips32}.
7511 Equivalent to @samp{-march=mips32r2}.
7515 Equivalent to @samp{-march=mips64}.
7518 @itemx -mno-fused-madd
7519 @opindex mfused-madd
7520 @opindex mno-fused-madd
7521 Generate code that uses (does not use) the floating point multiply and
7522 accumulate instructions, when they are available. These instructions
7523 are generated by default if they are available, but this may be
7524 undesirable if the extra precision causes problems or on certain chips
7525 in the mode where denormals are rounded to zero where denormals
7526 generated by multiply and accumulate instructions cause exceptions
7531 Assume that floating point registers are 32 bits wide.
7535 Assume that floating point registers are 64 bits wide.
7539 Assume that general purpose registers are 32 bits wide.
7543 Assume that general purpose registers are 64 bits wide.
7547 Force int and long types to be 64 bits wide. See @option{-mlong32} for an
7548 explanation of the default, and the width of pointers.
7552 Force long types to be 64 bits wide. See @option{-mlong32} for an
7553 explanation of the default, and the width of pointers.
7557 Force long, int, and pointer types to be 32 bits wide.
7559 The default size of ints, longs and pointers depends on the ABI@. All
7560 the supported ABIs use 32-bit ints. The n64 ABI uses 64-bit longs, as
7561 does the 64-bit Cygnus EABI; the others use 32-bit longs. Pointers
7562 are the same size as longs, or the same size as integer registers,
7563 whichever is smaller.
7577 Generate code for the given ABI@.
7579 Note that there are two embedded ABIs: @option{-mabi=eabi}
7580 selects the one defined by Cygnus while @option{-meabi=meabi}
7581 selects the one defined by MIPS@. Both these ABIs have
7582 32-bit and 64-bit variants. Normally, GCC will generate
7583 64-bit code when you select a 64-bit architecture, but you
7584 can use @option{-mgp32} to get 32-bit code instead.
7586 @item -mabi-fake-default
7587 @opindex mabi-fake-default
7588 You don't want to know what this option does. No, really. I mean
7589 it. Move on to the next option.
7591 What? You're still here? Oh, well@enddots{} Ok, here's the deal. GCC
7592 wants the default set of options to get the root of the multilib tree,
7593 and the shared library SONAMEs without any multilib-indicating
7594 suffixes. This is not convenience for @samp{mips64-linux-gnu}, since
7595 we want to default to the N32 ABI, while still being binary-compatible
7596 with @samp{mips-linux-gnu} if you stick to the O32 ABI@. Being
7597 binary-compatible means shared libraries should have the same SONAMEs,
7598 and libraries should live in the same location. Having O32 libraries
7599 in a sub-directory named say @file{o32} is not acceptable.
7601 So we trick GCC into believing that O32 is the default ABI, except
7602 that we override the default with some internal command-line
7603 processing magic. Problem is, if we stopped at that, and you then
7604 created a multilib-aware package that used the output of @command{gcc
7605 -print-multi-lib} to decide which multilibs to build, and how, and
7606 you'd find yourself in an awkward situation when you found out that
7607 some of the options listed ended up mapping to the same multilib, and
7608 none of your libraries was actually built for the multilib that
7609 @option{-print-multi-lib} claims to be the default. So we added this
7610 option that disables the default switcher, falling back to GCC's
7611 original notion of the default library. Confused yet?
7613 For short: don't ever use this option, unless you find it in the list
7614 of additional options to be used when building for multilibs, in the
7615 output of @option{gcc -print-multi-lib}.
7619 Generate code for the MIPS assembler, and invoke @file{mips-tfile} to
7620 add normal debug information. This is the default for all
7621 platforms except for the OSF/1 reference platform, using the OSF/rose
7622 object format. If the either of the @option{-gstabs} or @option{-gstabs+}
7623 switches are used, the @file{mips-tfile} program will encapsulate the
7624 stabs within MIPS ECOFF@.
7628 Generate code for the GNU assembler. This is the default on the OSF/1
7629 reference platform, using the OSF/rose object format. Also, this is
7630 the default if the configure option @option{--with-gnu-as} is used.
7632 @item -msplit-addresses
7633 @itemx -mno-split-addresses
7634 @opindex msplit-addresses
7635 @opindex mno-split-addresses
7636 Generate code to load the high and low parts of address constants separately.
7637 This allows GCC to optimize away redundant loads of the high order
7638 bits of addresses. This optimization requires GNU as and GNU ld.
7639 This optimization is enabled by default for some embedded targets where
7640 GNU as and GNU ld are standard.
7646 The @option{-mrnames} switch says to output code using the MIPS software
7647 names for the registers, instead of the hardware names (ie, @var{a0}
7648 instead of @var{$4}). The only known assembler that supports this option
7649 is the Algorithmics assembler.
7655 The @option{-mgpopt} switch says to write all of the data declarations
7656 before the instructions in the text section, this allows the MIPS
7657 assembler to generate one word memory references instead of using two
7658 words for short global or static data items. This is on by default if
7659 optimization is selected.
7665 For each non-inline function processed, the @option{-mstats} switch
7666 causes the compiler to emit one line to the standard error file to
7667 print statistics about the program (number of registers saved, stack
7674 The @option{-mmemcpy} switch makes all block moves call the appropriate
7675 string function (@samp{memcpy} or @samp{bcopy}) instead of possibly
7676 generating inline code.
7679 @itemx -mno-mips-tfile
7680 @opindex mmips-tfile
7681 @opindex mno-mips-tfile
7682 The @option{-mno-mips-tfile} switch causes the compiler not
7683 postprocess the object file with the @file{mips-tfile} program,
7684 after the MIPS assembler has generated it to add debug support. If
7685 @file{mips-tfile} is not run, then no local variables will be
7686 available to the debugger. In addition, @file{stage2} and
7687 @file{stage3} objects will have the temporary file names passed to the
7688 assembler embedded in the object file, which means the objects will
7689 not compare the same. The @option{-mno-mips-tfile} switch should only
7690 be used when there are bugs in the @file{mips-tfile} program that
7691 prevents compilation.
7694 @opindex msoft-float
7695 Generate output containing library calls for floating point.
7696 @strong{Warning:} the requisite libraries are not part of GCC@.
7697 Normally the facilities of the machine's usual C compiler are used, but
7698 this can't be done directly in cross-compilation. You must make your
7699 own arrangements to provide suitable library functions for
7703 @opindex mhard-float
7704 Generate output containing floating point instructions. This is the
7705 default if you use the unmodified sources.
7708 @itemx -mno-abicalls
7710 @opindex mno-abicalls
7711 Emit (or do not emit) the pseudo operations @samp{.abicalls},
7712 @samp{.cpload}, and @samp{.cprestore} that some System V.4 ports use for
7713 position independent code.
7716 @itemx -mno-long-calls
7717 @opindex mlong-calls
7718 @opindex mno-long-calls
7719 Do all calls with the @samp{JALR} instruction, which requires
7720 loading up a function's address into a register before the call.
7721 You need to use this switch, if you call outside of the current
7722 512 megabyte segment to functions that are not through pointers.
7725 @itemx -mno-half-pic
7727 @opindex mno-half-pic
7728 Put pointers to extern references into the data section and load them
7729 up, rather than put the references in the text section.
7731 @item -membedded-pic
7732 @itemx -mno-embedded-pic
7733 @opindex membedded-pic
7734 @opindex mno-embedded-pic
7735 Generate PIC code suitable for some embedded systems. All calls are
7736 made using PC relative address, and all data is addressed using the $gp
7737 register. No more than 65536 bytes of global data may be used. This
7738 requires GNU as and GNU ld which do most of the work. This currently
7739 only works on targets which use ECOFF; it does not work with ELF@.
7741 @item -membedded-data
7742 @itemx -mno-embedded-data
7743 @opindex membedded-data
7744 @opindex mno-embedded-data
7745 Allocate variables to the read-only data section first if possible, then
7746 next in the small data section if possible, otherwise in data. This gives
7747 slightly slower code than the default, but reduces the amount of RAM required
7748 when executing, and thus may be preferred for some embedded systems.
7750 @item -muninit-const-in-rodata
7751 @itemx -mno-uninit-const-in-rodata
7752 @opindex muninit-const-in-rodata
7753 @opindex mno-uninit-const-in-rodata
7754 When used together with @option{-membedded-data}, it will always store uninitialized
7755 const variables in the read-only data section.
7757 @item -msingle-float
7758 @itemx -mdouble-float
7759 @opindex msingle-float
7760 @opindex mdouble-float
7761 The @option{-msingle-float} switch tells gcc to assume that the floating
7762 point coprocessor only supports single precision operations, as on the
7763 @samp{r4650} chip. The @option{-mdouble-float} switch permits gcc to use
7764 double precision operations. This is the default.
7770 Permit use of the @samp{mad}, @samp{madu} and @samp{mul} instructions,
7771 as on the @samp{r4650} chip.
7775 Turns on @option{-msingle-float}, @option{-mmad}, and, at least for now,
7776 @option{-mcpu=r4650}.
7782 Enable 16-bit instructions.
7786 Use the entry and exit pseudo ops. This option can only be used with
7791 Compile code for the processor in little endian mode.
7792 The requisite libraries are assumed to exist.
7796 Compile code for the processor in big endian mode.
7797 The requisite libraries are assumed to exist.
7801 @cindex smaller data references (MIPS)
7802 @cindex gp-relative references (MIPS)
7803 Put global and static items less than or equal to @var{num} bytes into
7804 the small data or bss sections instead of the normal data or bss
7805 section. This allows the assembler to emit one word memory reference
7806 instructions based on the global pointer (@var{gp} or @var{$28}),
7807 instead of the normal two words used. By default, @var{num} is 8 when
7808 the MIPS assembler is used, and 0 when the GNU assembler is used. The
7809 @option{-G @var{num}} switch is also passed to the assembler and linker.
7810 All modules should be compiled with the same @option{-G @var{num}}
7815 Tell the MIPS assembler to not run its preprocessor over user
7816 assembler files (with a @samp{.s} suffix) when assembling them.
7820 Pass an option to gas which will cause nops to be inserted if
7821 the read of the destination register of an mfhi or mflo instruction
7822 occurs in the following two instructions.
7826 Do not include the default crt0.
7828 @item -mflush-func=@var{func}
7829 @itemx -mno-flush-func
7830 @opindex mflush-func
7831 Specifies the function to call to flush the I and D caches, or to not
7832 call any such function. If called, the function must take the same
7833 arguments as the common @code{_flush_func()}, that is, the address of the
7834 memory range for which the cache is being flushed, the size of the
7835 memory range, and the number 3 (to flush both caches). The default
7836 depends on the target gcc was configured for, but commonly is either
7837 @samp{_flush_func} or @samp{__cpu_flush}.
7839 @item -mbranch-likely
7840 @itemx -mno-branch-likely
7841 @opindex mbranch-likely
7842 @opindex mno-branch-likely
7843 Enable or disable use of Branch Likely instructions, regardless of the
7844 default for the selected architecture. By default, Branch Likely
7845 instructions may be generated if they are supported by the selected
7846 architecture. An exception is for the MIPS32 and MIPS64 architectures
7847 and processors which implement those architectures; for those, Branch
7848 Likely instructions will not be generated by default because the MIPS32
7849 and MIPS64 architectures specifically deprecate their use.
7852 @node i386 and x86-64 Options
7853 @subsection Intel 386 and AMD x86-64 Options
7854 @cindex i386 Options
7855 @cindex x86-64 Options
7856 @cindex Intel 386 Options
7857 @cindex AMD x86-64 Options
7859 These @samp{-m} options are defined for the i386 and x86-64 family of
7863 @item -mcpu=@var{cpu-type}
7865 Tune to @var{cpu-type} everything applicable about the generated code, except
7866 for the ABI and the set of available instructions. The choices for
7867 @var{cpu-type} are @samp{i386}, @samp{i486}, @samp{i586}, @samp{i686},
7868 @samp{pentium}, @samp{pentium-mmx}, @samp{pentiumpro}, @samp{pentium2},
7869 @samp{pentium3}, @samp{pentium4}, @samp{k6}, @samp{k6-2}, @samp{k6-3},
7870 @samp{athlon}, @samp{athlon-tbird}, @samp{athlon-4}, @samp{athlon-xp},
7871 @samp{athlon-mp}, @samp{winchip-c6}, @samp{winchip2}, @samp{k8} and @samp{c3}.
7873 While picking a specific @var{cpu-type} will schedule things appropriately
7874 for that particular chip, the compiler will not generate any code that
7875 does not run on the i386 without the @option{-march=@var{cpu-type}} option
7876 being used. @samp{i586} is equivalent to @samp{pentium} and @samp{i686}
7877 is equivalent to @samp{pentiumpro}. @samp{k6} and @samp{athlon} are the
7878 AMD chips as opposed to the Intel ones.
7880 @item -march=@var{cpu-type}
7882 Generate instructions for the machine type @var{cpu-type}. The choices
7883 for @var{cpu-type} are the same as for @option{-mcpu}. Moreover,
7884 specifying @option{-march=@var{cpu-type}} implies @option{-mcpu=@var{cpu-type}}.
7893 @opindex mpentiumpro
7894 These options are synonyms for @option{-mcpu=i386}, @option{-mcpu=i486},
7895 @option{-mcpu=pentium}, and @option{-mcpu=pentiumpro} respectively.
7896 These synonyms are deprecated.
7898 @item -mfpmath=@var{unit}
7900 generate floating point arithmetics for selected unit @var{unit}. the choices
7905 Use the standard 387 floating point coprocessor present majority of chips and
7906 emulated otherwise. Code compiled with this option will run almost everywhere.
7907 The temporary results are computed in 80bit precision instead of precision
7908 specified by the type resulting in slightly different results compared to most
7909 of other chips. See @option{-ffloat-store} for more detailed description.
7911 This is the default choice for i386 compiler.
7914 Use scalar floating point instructions present in the SSE instruction set.
7915 This instruction set is supported by Pentium3 and newer chips, in the AMD line
7916 by Athlon-4, Athlon-xp and Athlon-mp chips. The earlier version of SSE
7917 instruction set supports only single precision arithmetics, thus the double and
7918 extended precision arithmetics is still done using 387. Later version, present
7919 only in Pentium4 and the future AMD x86-64 chips supports double precision
7922 For i387 you need to use @option{-march=@var{cpu-type}}, @option{-msse} or
7923 @option{-msse2} switches to enable SSE extensions and make this option
7924 effective. For x86-64 compiler, these extensions are enabled by default.
7926 The resulting code should be considerably faster in majority of cases and avoid
7927 the numerical instability problems of 387 code, but may break some existing
7928 code that expects temporaries to be 80bit.
7930 This is the default choice for x86-64 compiler.
7933 Attempt to utilize both instruction sets at once. This effectively double the
7934 amount of available registers and on chips with separate execution units for
7935 387 and SSE the execution resources too. Use this option with care, as it is
7936 still experimental, because gcc register allocator does not model separate
7937 functional units well resulting in instable performance.
7940 @item -masm=@var{dialect}
7941 @opindex masm=@var{dialect}
7942 Output asm instructions using selected @var{dialect}. Supported choices are
7943 @samp{intel} or @samp{att} (the default one).
7948 @opindex mno-ieee-fp
7949 Control whether or not the compiler uses IEEE floating point
7950 comparisons. These handle correctly the case where the result of a
7951 comparison is unordered.
7954 @opindex msoft-float
7955 Generate output containing library calls for floating point.
7956 @strong{Warning:} the requisite libraries are not part of GCC@.
7957 Normally the facilities of the machine's usual C compiler are used, but
7958 this can't be done directly in cross-compilation. You must make your
7959 own arrangements to provide suitable library functions for
7962 On machines where a function returns floating point results in the 80387
7963 register stack, some floating point opcodes may be emitted even if
7964 @option{-msoft-float} is used.
7966 @item -mno-fp-ret-in-387
7967 @opindex mno-fp-ret-in-387
7968 Do not use the FPU registers for return values of functions.
7970 The usual calling convention has functions return values of types
7971 @code{float} and @code{double} in an FPU register, even if there
7972 is no FPU@. The idea is that the operating system should emulate
7975 The option @option{-mno-fp-ret-in-387} causes such values to be returned
7976 in ordinary CPU registers instead.
7978 @item -mno-fancy-math-387
7979 @opindex mno-fancy-math-387
7980 Some 387 emulators do not support the @code{sin}, @code{cos} and
7981 @code{sqrt} instructions for the 387. Specify this option to avoid
7982 generating those instructions. This option is the default on FreeBSD,
7983 OpenBSD and NetBSD@. This option is overridden when @option{-march}
7984 indicates that the target cpu will always have an FPU and so the
7985 instruction will not need emulation. As of revision 2.6.1, these
7986 instructions are not generated unless you also use the
7987 @option{-funsafe-math-optimizations} switch.
7989 @item -malign-double
7990 @itemx -mno-align-double
7991 @opindex malign-double
7992 @opindex mno-align-double
7993 Control whether GCC aligns @code{double}, @code{long double}, and
7994 @code{long long} variables on a two word boundary or a one word
7995 boundary. Aligning @code{double} variables on a two word boundary will
7996 produce code that runs somewhat faster on a @samp{Pentium} at the
7997 expense of more memory.
7999 @strong{Warning:} if you use the @option{-malign-double} switch,
8000 structures containing the above types will be aligned differently than
8001 the published application binary interface specifications for the 386
8002 and will not be binary compatible with structures in code compiled
8003 without that switch.
8005 @item -m128bit-long-double
8006 @opindex m128bit-long-double
8007 Control the size of @code{long double} type. i386 application binary interface
8008 specify the size to be 12 bytes, while modern architectures (Pentium and newer)
8009 prefer @code{long double} aligned to 8 or 16 byte boundary. This is
8010 impossible to reach with 12 byte long doubles in the array accesses.
8012 @strong{Warning:} if you use the @option{-m128bit-long-double} switch, the
8013 structures and arrays containing @code{long double} will change their size as
8014 well as function calling convention for function taking @code{long double}
8017 @item -m96bit-long-double
8018 @opindex m96bit-long-double
8019 Set the size of @code{long double} to 96 bits as required by the i386
8020 application binary interface. This is the default.
8023 @itemx -mno-svr3-shlib
8024 @opindex msvr3-shlib
8025 @opindex mno-svr3-shlib
8026 Control whether GCC places uninitialized local variables into the
8027 @code{bss} or @code{data} segments. @option{-msvr3-shlib} places them
8028 into @code{bss}. These options are meaningful only on System V Release 3.
8032 Use a different function-calling convention, in which functions that
8033 take a fixed number of arguments return with the @code{ret} @var{num}
8034 instruction, which pops their arguments while returning. This saves one
8035 instruction in the caller since there is no need to pop the arguments
8038 You can specify that an individual function is called with this calling
8039 sequence with the function attribute @samp{stdcall}. You can also
8040 override the @option{-mrtd} option by using the function attribute
8041 @samp{cdecl}. @xref{Function Attributes}.
8043 @strong{Warning:} this calling convention is incompatible with the one
8044 normally used on Unix, so you cannot use it if you need to call
8045 libraries compiled with the Unix compiler.
8047 Also, you must provide function prototypes for all functions that
8048 take variable numbers of arguments (including @code{printf});
8049 otherwise incorrect code will be generated for calls to those
8052 In addition, seriously incorrect code will result if you call a
8053 function with too many arguments. (Normally, extra arguments are
8054 harmlessly ignored.)
8056 @item -mregparm=@var{num}
8058 Control how many registers are used to pass integer arguments. By
8059 default, no registers are used to pass arguments, and at most 3
8060 registers can be used. You can control this behavior for a specific
8061 function by using the function attribute @samp{regparm}.
8062 @xref{Function Attributes}.
8064 @strong{Warning:} if you use this switch, and
8065 @var{num} is nonzero, then you must build all modules with the same
8066 value, including any libraries. This includes the system libraries and
8069 @item -mpreferred-stack-boundary=@var{num}
8070 @opindex mpreferred-stack-boundary
8071 Attempt to keep the stack boundary aligned to a 2 raised to @var{num}
8072 byte boundary. If @option{-mpreferred-stack-boundary} is not specified,
8073 the default is 4 (16 bytes or 128 bits), except when optimizing for code
8074 size (@option{-Os}), in which case the default is the minimum correct
8075 alignment (4 bytes for x86, and 8 bytes for x86-64).
8077 On Pentium and PentiumPro, @code{double} and @code{long double} values
8078 should be aligned to an 8 byte boundary (see @option{-malign-double}) or
8079 suffer significant run time performance penalties. On Pentium III, the
8080 Streaming SIMD Extension (SSE) data type @code{__m128} suffers similar
8081 penalties if it is not 16 byte aligned.
8083 To ensure proper alignment of this values on the stack, the stack boundary
8084 must be as aligned as that required by any value stored on the stack.
8085 Further, every function must be generated such that it keeps the stack
8086 aligned. Thus calling a function compiled with a higher preferred
8087 stack boundary from a function compiled with a lower preferred stack
8088 boundary will most likely misalign the stack. It is recommended that
8089 libraries that use callbacks always use the default setting.
8091 This extra alignment does consume extra stack space, and generally
8092 increases code size. Code that is sensitive to stack space usage, such
8093 as embedded systems and operating system kernels, may want to reduce the
8094 preferred alignment to @option{-mpreferred-stack-boundary=2}.
8110 These switches enable or disable the use of built-in functions that allow
8111 direct access to the MMX, SSE and 3Dnow extensions of the instruction set.
8113 @xref{X86 Built-in Functions}, for details of the functions enabled
8114 and disabled by these switches.
8116 To have SSE/SSE2 instructions generated automatically from floating-point
8117 code, see @option{-mfpmath=sse}.
8120 @itemx -mno-push-args
8122 @opindex mno-push-args
8123 Use PUSH operations to store outgoing parameters. This method is shorter
8124 and usually equally fast as method using SUB/MOV operations and is enabled
8125 by default. In some cases disabling it may improve performance because of
8126 improved scheduling and reduced dependencies.
8128 @item -maccumulate-outgoing-args
8129 @opindex maccumulate-outgoing-args
8130 If enabled, the maximum amount of space required for outgoing arguments will be
8131 computed in the function prologue. This is faster on most modern CPUs
8132 because of reduced dependencies, improved scheduling and reduced stack usage
8133 when preferred stack boundary is not equal to 2. The drawback is a notable
8134 increase in code size. This switch implies @option{-mno-push-args}.
8138 Support thread-safe exception handling on @samp{Mingw32}. Code that relies
8139 on thread-safe exception handling must compile and link all code with the
8140 @option{-mthreads} option. When compiling, @option{-mthreads} defines
8141 @option{-D_MT}; when linking, it links in a special thread helper library
8142 @option{-lmingwthrd} which cleans up per thread exception handling data.
8144 @item -mno-align-stringops
8145 @opindex mno-align-stringops
8146 Do not align destination of inlined string operations. This switch reduces
8147 code size and improves performance in case the destination is already aligned,
8148 but gcc don't know about it.
8150 @item -minline-all-stringops
8151 @opindex minline-all-stringops
8152 By default GCC inlines string operations only when destination is known to be
8153 aligned at least to 4 byte boundary. This enables more inlining, increase code
8154 size, but may improve performance of code that depends on fast memcpy, strlen
8155 and memset for short lengths.
8157 @item -momit-leaf-frame-pointer
8158 @opindex momit-leaf-frame-pointer
8159 Don't keep the frame pointer in a register for leaf functions. This
8160 avoids the instructions to save, set up and restore frame pointers and
8161 makes an extra register available in leaf functions. The option
8162 @option{-fomit-frame-pointer} removes the frame pointer for all functions
8163 which might make debugging harder.
8166 These @samp{-m} switches are supported in addition to the above
8167 on AMD x86-64 processors in 64-bit environments.
8174 Generate code for a 32-bit or 64-bit environment.
8175 The 32-bit environment sets int, long and pointer to 32 bits and
8176 generates code that runs on any i386 system.
8177 The 64-bit environment sets int to 32 bits and long and pointer
8178 to 64 bits and generates code for AMD's x86-64 architecture.
8181 @opindex no-red-zone
8182 Do not use a so called red zone for x86-64 code. The red zone is mandated
8183 by the x86-64 ABI, it is a 128-byte area beyond the location of the
8184 stack pointer that will not be modified by signal or interrupt handlers
8185 and therefore can be used for temporary data without adjusting the stack
8186 pointer. The flag @option{-mno-red-zone} disables this red zone.
8188 @item -mcmodel=small
8189 @opindex mcmodel=small
8190 Generate code for the small code model: the program and its symbols must
8191 be linked in the lower 2 GB of the address space. Pointers are 64 bits.
8192 Programs can be statically or dynamically linked. This is the default
8195 @item -mcmodel=kernel
8196 @opindex mcmodel=kernel
8197 Generate code for the kernel code model. The kernel runs in the
8198 negative 2 GB of the address space.
8199 This model has to be used for Linux kernel code.
8201 @item -mcmodel=medium
8202 @opindex mcmodel=medium
8203 Generate code for the medium model: The program is linked in the lower 2
8204 GB of the address space but symbols can be located anywhere in the
8205 address space. Programs can be statically or dynamically linked, but
8206 building of shared libraries are not supported with the medium model.
8208 @item -mcmodel=large
8209 @opindex mcmodel=large
8210 Generate code for the large model: This model makes no assumptions
8211 about addresses and sizes of sections. Currently GCC does not implement
8216 @subsection HPPA Options
8217 @cindex HPPA Options
8219 These @samp{-m} options are defined for the HPPA family of computers:
8222 @item -march=@var{architecture-type}
8224 Generate code for the specified architecture. The choices for
8225 @var{architecture-type} are @samp{1.0} for PA 1.0, @samp{1.1} for PA
8226 1.1, and @samp{2.0} for PA 2.0 processors. Refer to
8227 @file{/usr/lib/sched.models} on an HP-UX system to determine the proper
8228 architecture option for your machine. Code compiled for lower numbered
8229 architectures will run on higher numbered architectures, but not the
8232 PA 2.0 support currently requires gas snapshot 19990413 or later. The
8233 next release of binutils (current is 2.9.1) will probably contain PA 2.0
8237 @itemx -mpa-risc-1-1
8238 @itemx -mpa-risc-2-0
8239 @opindex mpa-risc-1-0
8240 @opindex mpa-risc-1-1
8241 @opindex mpa-risc-2-0
8242 Synonyms for @option{-march=1.0}, @option{-march=1.1}, and @option{-march=2.0} respectively.
8245 @opindex mbig-switch
8246 Generate code suitable for big switch tables. Use this option only if
8247 the assembler/linker complain about out of range branches within a switch
8250 @item -mjump-in-delay
8251 @opindex mjump-in-delay
8252 Fill delay slots of function calls with unconditional jump instructions
8253 by modifying the return pointer for the function call to be the target
8254 of the conditional jump.
8256 @item -mdisable-fpregs
8257 @opindex mdisable-fpregs
8258 Prevent floating point registers from being used in any manner. This is
8259 necessary for compiling kernels which perform lazy context switching of
8260 floating point registers. If you use this option and attempt to perform
8261 floating point operations, the compiler will abort.
8263 @item -mdisable-indexing
8264 @opindex mdisable-indexing
8265 Prevent the compiler from using indexing address modes. This avoids some
8266 rather obscure problems when compiling MIG generated code under MACH@.
8268 @item -mno-space-regs
8269 @opindex mno-space-regs
8270 Generate code that assumes the target has no space registers. This allows
8271 GCC to generate faster indirect calls and use unscaled index address modes.
8273 Such code is suitable for level 0 PA systems and kernels.
8275 @item -mfast-indirect-calls
8276 @opindex mfast-indirect-calls
8277 Generate code that assumes calls never cross space boundaries. This
8278 allows GCC to emit code which performs faster indirect calls.
8280 This option will not work in the presence of shared libraries or nested
8283 @item -mlong-load-store
8284 @opindex mlong-load-store
8285 Generate 3-instruction load and store sequences as sometimes required by
8286 the HP-UX 10 linker. This is equivalent to the @samp{+k} option to
8289 @item -mportable-runtime
8290 @opindex mportable-runtime
8291 Use the portable calling conventions proposed by HP for ELF systems.
8295 Enable the use of assembler directives only GAS understands.
8297 @item -mschedule=@var{cpu-type}
8299 Schedule code according to the constraints for the machine type
8300 @var{cpu-type}. The choices for @var{cpu-type} are @samp{700}
8301 @samp{7100}, @samp{7100LC}, @samp{7200}, @samp{7300} and @samp{8000}. Refer
8302 to @file{/usr/lib/sched.models} on an HP-UX system to determine the
8303 proper scheduling option for your machine. The default scheduling is
8307 @opindex mlinker-opt
8308 Enable the optimization pass in the HP-UX linker. Note this makes symbolic
8309 debugging impossible. It also triggers a bug in the HP-UX 8 and HP-UX 9
8310 linkers in which they give bogus error messages when linking some programs.
8313 @opindex msoft-float
8314 Generate output containing library calls for floating point.
8315 @strong{Warning:} the requisite libraries are not available for all HPPA
8316 targets. Normally the facilities of the machine's usual C compiler are
8317 used, but this cannot be done directly in cross-compilation. You must make
8318 your own arrangements to provide suitable library functions for
8319 cross-compilation. The embedded target @samp{hppa1.1-*-pro}
8320 does provide software floating point support.
8322 @option{-msoft-float} changes the calling convention in the output file;
8323 therefore, it is only useful if you compile @emph{all} of a program with
8324 this option. In particular, you need to compile @file{libgcc.a}, the
8325 library that comes with GCC, with @option{-msoft-float} in order for
8330 Generate the predefine, @code{_SIO}, for server IO. The default is
8331 @option{-mwsio}. This generates the predefines, @code{__hp9000s700},
8332 @code{__hp9000s700__} and @code{_WSIO}, for workstation IO. These
8333 options are available under HP-UX and HI-UX.
8337 Use GNU ld specific options. This passes @option{-shared} to ld when
8338 building a shared library. It is the default when GCC is configured,
8339 explicitly or implicitly, with the GNU linker. This option does not
8340 have any affect on which ld is called, it only changes what parameters
8341 are passed to that ld. The ld that is called is determined by the
8342 @option{--with-ld} configure option, gcc's program search path, and
8343 finally by the user's @env{PATH}. The linker used by GCC can be printed
8344 using @samp{which `gcc -print-prog-name=ld`}.
8348 Use HP ld specific options. This passes @option{-b} to ld when building
8349 a shared library and passes @option{+Accept TypeMismatch} to ld on all
8350 links. It is the default when GCC is configured, explicitly or
8351 implicitly, with the HP linker. This option does not have any affect on
8352 which ld is called, it only changes what parameters are passed to that
8353 ld. The ld that is called is determined by the @option{--with-ld}
8354 configure option, gcc's program search path, and finally by the user's
8355 @env{PATH}. The linker used by GCC can be printed using @samp{which
8356 `gcc -print-prog-name=ld`}.
8359 @opindex mno-long-calls
8360 Generate code that uses long call sequences. This ensures that a call
8361 is always able to reach linker generated stubs. The default is to generate
8362 long calls only when the distance from the call site to the beginning
8363 of the function or translation unit, as the case may be, exceeds a
8364 predefined limit set by the branch type being used. The limits for
8365 normal calls are 7,600,000 and 240,000 bytes, respectively for the
8366 PA 2.0 and PA 1.X architectures. Sibcalls are always limited at
8369 Distances are measured from the beginning of functions when using the
8370 @option{-ffunction-sections} option, or when using the @option{-mgas}
8371 and @option{-mno-portable-runtime} options together under HP-UX with
8374 It is normally not desirable to use this option as it will degrade
8375 performance. However, it may be useful in large applications,
8376 particularly when partial linking is used to build the application.
8378 The types of long calls used depends on the capabilities of the
8379 assembler and linker, and the type of code being generated. The
8380 impact on systems that support long absolute calls, and long pic
8381 symbol-difference or pc-relative calls should be relatively small.
8382 However, an indirect call is used on 32-bit ELF systems in pic code
8383 and it is quite long.
8387 @node Intel 960 Options
8388 @subsection Intel 960 Options
8390 These @samp{-m} options are defined for the Intel 960 implementations:
8393 @item -m@var{cpu-type}
8401 Assume the defaults for the machine type @var{cpu-type} for some of
8402 the other options, including instruction scheduling, floating point
8403 support, and addressing modes. The choices for @var{cpu-type} are
8404 @samp{ka}, @samp{kb}, @samp{mc}, @samp{ca}, @samp{cf},
8405 @samp{sa}, and @samp{sb}.
8412 @opindex msoft-float
8413 The @option{-mnumerics} option indicates that the processor does support
8414 floating-point instructions. The @option{-msoft-float} option indicates
8415 that floating-point support should not be assumed.
8417 @item -mleaf-procedures
8418 @itemx -mno-leaf-procedures
8419 @opindex mleaf-procedures
8420 @opindex mno-leaf-procedures
8421 Do (or do not) attempt to alter leaf procedures to be callable with the
8422 @code{bal} instruction as well as @code{call}. This will result in more
8423 efficient code for explicit calls when the @code{bal} instruction can be
8424 substituted by the assembler or linker, but less efficient code in other
8425 cases, such as calls via function pointers, or using a linker that doesn't
8426 support this optimization.
8429 @itemx -mno-tail-call
8431 @opindex mno-tail-call
8432 Do (or do not) make additional attempts (beyond those of the
8433 machine-independent portions of the compiler) to optimize tail-recursive
8434 calls into branches. You may not want to do this because the detection of
8435 cases where this is not valid is not totally complete. The default is
8436 @option{-mno-tail-call}.
8438 @item -mcomplex-addr
8439 @itemx -mno-complex-addr
8440 @opindex mcomplex-addr
8441 @opindex mno-complex-addr
8442 Assume (or do not assume) that the use of a complex addressing mode is a
8443 win on this implementation of the i960. Complex addressing modes may not
8444 be worthwhile on the K-series, but they definitely are on the C-series.
8445 The default is currently @option{-mcomplex-addr} for all processors except
8449 @itemx -mno-code-align
8450 @opindex mcode-align
8451 @opindex mno-code-align
8452 Align code to 8-byte boundaries for faster fetching (or don't bother).
8453 Currently turned on by default for C-series implementations only.
8456 @item -mclean-linkage
8457 @itemx -mno-clean-linkage
8458 @opindex mclean-linkage
8459 @opindex mno-clean-linkage
8460 These options are not fully implemented.
8464 @itemx -mic2.0-compat
8465 @itemx -mic3.0-compat
8467 @opindex mic2.0-compat
8468 @opindex mic3.0-compat
8469 Enable compatibility with iC960 v2.0 or v3.0.
8473 @opindex masm-compat
8475 Enable compatibility with the iC960 assembler.
8477 @item -mstrict-align
8478 @itemx -mno-strict-align
8479 @opindex mstrict-align
8480 @opindex mno-strict-align
8481 Do not permit (do permit) unaligned accesses.
8485 Enable structure-alignment compatibility with Intel's gcc release version
8486 1.3 (based on gcc 1.37). This option implies @option{-mstrict-align}.
8488 @item -mlong-double-64
8489 @opindex mlong-double-64
8490 Implement type @samp{long double} as 64-bit floating point numbers.
8491 Without the option @samp{long double} is implemented by 80-bit
8492 floating point numbers. The only reason we have it because there is
8493 no 128-bit @samp{long double} support in @samp{fp-bit.c} yet. So it
8494 is only useful for people using soft-float targets. Otherwise, we
8495 should recommend against use of it.
8499 @node DEC Alpha Options
8500 @subsection DEC Alpha Options
8502 These @samp{-m} options are defined for the DEC Alpha implementations:
8505 @item -mno-soft-float
8507 @opindex mno-soft-float
8508 @opindex msoft-float
8509 Use (do not use) the hardware floating-point instructions for
8510 floating-point operations. When @option{-msoft-float} is specified,
8511 functions in @file{libgcc.a} will be used to perform floating-point
8512 operations. Unless they are replaced by routines that emulate the
8513 floating-point operations, or compiled in such a way as to call such
8514 emulations routines, these routines will issue floating-point
8515 operations. If you are compiling for an Alpha without floating-point
8516 operations, you must ensure that the library is built so as not to call
8519 Note that Alpha implementations without floating-point operations are
8520 required to have floating-point registers.
8525 @opindex mno-fp-regs
8526 Generate code that uses (does not use) the floating-point register set.
8527 @option{-mno-fp-regs} implies @option{-msoft-float}. If the floating-point
8528 register set is not used, floating point operands are passed in integer
8529 registers as if they were integers and floating-point results are passed
8530 in @code{$0} instead of @code{$f0}. This is a non-standard calling sequence,
8531 so any function with a floating-point argument or return value called by code
8532 compiled with @option{-mno-fp-regs} must also be compiled with that
8535 A typical use of this option is building a kernel that does not use,
8536 and hence need not save and restore, any floating-point registers.
8540 The Alpha architecture implements floating-point hardware optimized for
8541 maximum performance. It is mostly compliant with the IEEE floating
8542 point standard. However, for full compliance, software assistance is
8543 required. This option generates code fully IEEE compliant code
8544 @emph{except} that the @var{inexact-flag} is not maintained (see below).
8545 If this option is turned on, the preprocessor macro @code{_IEEE_FP} is
8546 defined during compilation. The resulting code is less efficient but is
8547 able to correctly support denormalized numbers and exceptional IEEE
8548 values such as not-a-number and plus/minus infinity. Other Alpha
8549 compilers call this option @option{-ieee_with_no_inexact}.
8551 @item -mieee-with-inexact
8552 @opindex mieee-with-inexact
8553 This is like @option{-mieee} except the generated code also maintains
8554 the IEEE @var{inexact-flag}. Turning on this option causes the
8555 generated code to implement fully-compliant IEEE math. In addition to
8556 @code{_IEEE_FP}, @code{_IEEE_FP_EXACT} is defined as a preprocessor
8557 macro. On some Alpha implementations the resulting code may execute
8558 significantly slower than the code generated by default. Since there is
8559 very little code that depends on the @var{inexact-flag}, you should
8560 normally not specify this option. Other Alpha compilers call this
8561 option @option{-ieee_with_inexact}.
8563 @item -mfp-trap-mode=@var{trap-mode}
8564 @opindex mfp-trap-mode
8565 This option controls what floating-point related traps are enabled.
8566 Other Alpha compilers call this option @option{-fptm @var{trap-mode}}.
8567 The trap mode can be set to one of four values:
8571 This is the default (normal) setting. The only traps that are enabled
8572 are the ones that cannot be disabled in software (e.g., division by zero
8576 In addition to the traps enabled by @samp{n}, underflow traps are enabled
8580 Like @samp{su}, but the instructions are marked to be safe for software
8581 completion (see Alpha architecture manual for details).
8584 Like @samp{su}, but inexact traps are enabled as well.
8587 @item -mfp-rounding-mode=@var{rounding-mode}
8588 @opindex mfp-rounding-mode
8589 Selects the IEEE rounding mode. Other Alpha compilers call this option
8590 @option{-fprm @var{rounding-mode}}. The @var{rounding-mode} can be one
8595 Normal IEEE rounding mode. Floating point numbers are rounded towards
8596 the nearest machine number or towards the even machine number in case
8600 Round towards minus infinity.
8603 Chopped rounding mode. Floating point numbers are rounded towards zero.
8606 Dynamic rounding mode. A field in the floating point control register
8607 (@var{fpcr}, see Alpha architecture reference manual) controls the
8608 rounding mode in effect. The C library initializes this register for
8609 rounding towards plus infinity. Thus, unless your program modifies the
8610 @var{fpcr}, @samp{d} corresponds to round towards plus infinity.
8613 @item -mtrap-precision=@var{trap-precision}
8614 @opindex mtrap-precision
8615 In the Alpha architecture, floating point traps are imprecise. This
8616 means without software assistance it is impossible to recover from a
8617 floating trap and program execution normally needs to be terminated.
8618 GCC can generate code that can assist operating system trap handlers
8619 in determining the exact location that caused a floating point trap.
8620 Depending on the requirements of an application, different levels of
8621 precisions can be selected:
8625 Program precision. This option is the default and means a trap handler
8626 can only identify which program caused a floating point exception.
8629 Function precision. The trap handler can determine the function that
8630 caused a floating point exception.
8633 Instruction precision. The trap handler can determine the exact
8634 instruction that caused a floating point exception.
8637 Other Alpha compilers provide the equivalent options called
8638 @option{-scope_safe} and @option{-resumption_safe}.
8640 @item -mieee-conformant
8641 @opindex mieee-conformant
8642 This option marks the generated code as IEEE conformant. You must not
8643 use this option unless you also specify @option{-mtrap-precision=i} and either
8644 @option{-mfp-trap-mode=su} or @option{-mfp-trap-mode=sui}. Its only effect
8645 is to emit the line @samp{.eflag 48} in the function prologue of the
8646 generated assembly file. Under DEC Unix, this has the effect that
8647 IEEE-conformant math library routines will be linked in.
8649 @item -mbuild-constants
8650 @opindex mbuild-constants
8651 Normally GCC examines a 32- or 64-bit integer constant to
8652 see if it can construct it from smaller constants in two or three
8653 instructions. If it cannot, it will output the constant as a literal and
8654 generate code to load it from the data segment at runtime.
8656 Use this option to require GCC to construct @emph{all} integer constants
8657 using code, even if it takes more instructions (the maximum is six).
8659 You would typically use this option to build a shared library dynamic
8660 loader. Itself a shared library, it must relocate itself in memory
8661 before it can find the variables and constants in its own data segment.
8667 Select whether to generate code to be assembled by the vendor-supplied
8668 assembler (@option{-malpha-as}) or by the GNU assembler @option{-mgas}.
8686 Indicate whether GCC should generate code to use the optional BWX,
8687 CIX, FIX and MAX instruction sets. The default is to use the instruction
8688 sets supported by the CPU type specified via @option{-mcpu=} option or that
8689 of the CPU on which GCC was built if none was specified.
8694 @opindex mfloat-ieee
8695 Generate code that uses (does not use) VAX F and G floating point
8696 arithmetic instead of IEEE single and double precision.
8698 @item -mexplicit-relocs
8699 @itemx -mno-explicit-relocs
8700 @opindex mexplicit-relocs
8701 @opindex mno-explicit-relocs
8702 Older Alpha assemblers provided no way to generate symbol relocations
8703 except via assembler macros. Use of these macros does not allow
8704 optimal instruction scheduling. GNU binutils as of version 2.12
8705 supports a new syntax that allows the compiler to explicitly mark
8706 which relocations should apply to which instructions. This option
8707 is mostly useful for debugging, as GCC detects the capabilities of
8708 the assembler when it is built and sets the default accordingly.
8712 @opindex msmall-data
8713 @opindex mlarge-data
8714 When @option{-mexplicit-relocs} is in effect, static data is
8715 accessed via @dfn{gp-relative} relocations. When @option{-msmall-data}
8716 is used, objects 8 bytes long or smaller are placed in a @dfn{small data area}
8717 (the @code{.sdata} and @code{.sbss} sections) and are accessed via
8718 16-bit relocations off of the @code{$gp} register. This limits the
8719 size of the small data area to 64KB, but allows the variables to be
8720 directly accessed via a single instruction.
8722 The default is @option{-mlarge-data}. With this option the data area
8723 is limited to just below 2GB. Programs that require more than 2GB of
8724 data must use @code{malloc} or @code{mmap} to allocate the data in the
8725 heap instead of in the program's data segment.
8727 When generating code for shared libraries, @option{-fpic} implies
8728 @option{-msmall-data} and @option{-fPIC} implies @option{-mlarge-data}.
8732 @opindex msmall-text
8733 @opindex mlarge-text
8734 When @option{-msmall-text} is used, the compiler assumes that the
8735 code of the entire program (or shared library) fits in 4MB, and is
8736 thus reachable with a branch instruction. When @option{-msmall-data}
8737 is used, the compiler can assume that all local symbols share the
8738 same @code{$gp} value, and thus reduce the number of instructions
8739 required for a function call from 4 to 1.
8741 The default is @option{-mlarge-text}.
8743 @item -mcpu=@var{cpu_type}
8745 Set the instruction set and instruction scheduling parameters for
8746 machine type @var{cpu_type}. You can specify either the @samp{EV}
8747 style name or the corresponding chip number. GCC supports scheduling
8748 parameters for the EV4, EV5 and EV6 family of processors and will
8749 choose the default values for the instruction set from the processor
8750 you specify. If you do not specify a processor type, GCC will default
8751 to the processor on which the compiler was built.
8753 Supported values for @var{cpu_type} are
8759 Schedules as an EV4 and has no instruction set extensions.
8763 Schedules as an EV5 and has no instruction set extensions.
8767 Schedules as an EV5 and supports the BWX extension.
8772 Schedules as an EV5 and supports the BWX and MAX extensions.
8776 Schedules as an EV6 and supports the BWX, FIX, and MAX extensions.
8780 Schedules as an EV6 and supports the BWX, CIX, FIX, and MAX extensions.
8783 @item -mtune=@var{cpu_type}
8785 Set only the instruction scheduling parameters for machine type
8786 @var{cpu_type}. The instruction set is not changed.
8788 @item -mmemory-latency=@var{time}
8789 @opindex mmemory-latency
8790 Sets the latency the scheduler should assume for typical memory
8791 references as seen by the application. This number is highly
8792 dependent on the memory access patterns used by the application
8793 and the size of the external cache on the machine.
8795 Valid options for @var{time} are
8799 A decimal number representing clock cycles.
8805 The compiler contains estimates of the number of clock cycles for
8806 ``typical'' EV4 & EV5 hardware for the Level 1, 2 & 3 caches
8807 (also called Dcache, Scache, and Bcache), as well as to main memory.
8808 Note that L3 is only valid for EV5.
8813 @node DEC Alpha/VMS Options
8814 @subsection DEC Alpha/VMS Options
8816 These @samp{-m} options are defined for the DEC Alpha/VMS implementations:
8819 @item -mvms-return-codes
8820 @opindex mvms-return-codes
8821 Return VMS condition codes from main. The default is to return POSIX
8822 style condition (e.g.@ error) codes.
8825 @node H8/300 Options
8826 @subsection H8/300 Options
8828 These @samp{-m} options are defined for the H8/300 implementations:
8833 Shorten some address references at link time, when possible; uses the
8834 linker option @option{-relax}. @xref{H8/300,, @code{ld} and the H8/300,
8835 ld.info, Using ld}, for a fuller description.
8839 Generate code for the H8/300H@.
8843 Generate code for the H8S@.
8847 Generate code for the H8S and H8/300H in the normal mode. This switch
8848 must be used either with -mh or -ms.
8852 Generate code for the H8S/2600. This switch must be used with @option{-ms}.
8856 Make @code{int} data 32 bits by default.
8860 On the H8/300H and H8S, use the same alignment rules as for the H8/300.
8861 The default for the H8/300H and H8S is to align longs and floats on 4
8863 @option{-malign-300} causes them to be aligned on 2 byte boundaries.
8864 This option has no effect on the H8/300.
8868 @subsection SH Options
8870 These @samp{-m} options are defined for the SH implementations:
8875 Generate code for the SH1.
8879 Generate code for the SH2.
8882 Generate code for the SH2e.
8886 Generate code for the SH3.
8890 Generate code for the SH3e.
8894 Generate code for the SH4 without a floating-point unit.
8896 @item -m4-single-only
8897 @opindex m4-single-only
8898 Generate code for the SH4 with a floating-point unit that only
8899 supports single-precision arithmetic.
8903 Generate code for the SH4 assuming the floating-point unit is in
8904 single-precision mode by default.
8908 Generate code for the SH4.
8912 Compile code for the processor in big endian mode.
8916 Compile code for the processor in little endian mode.
8920 Align doubles at 64-bit boundaries. Note that this changes the calling
8921 conventions, and thus some functions from the standard C library will
8922 not work unless you recompile it first with @option{-mdalign}.
8926 Shorten some address references at link time, when possible; uses the
8927 linker option @option{-relax}.
8931 Use 32-bit offsets in @code{switch} tables. The default is to use
8936 Enable the use of the instruction @code{fmovd}.
8940 Comply with the calling conventions defined by Hitachi.
8944 Mark the @code{MAC} register as call-clobbered, even if
8945 @option{-mhitachi} is given.
8949 Increase IEEE-compliance of floating-point code.
8953 Dump instruction size and location in the assembly code.
8957 This option is deprecated. It pads structures to multiple of 4 bytes,
8958 which is incompatible with the SH ABI@.
8962 Optimize for space instead of speed. Implied by @option{-Os}.
8966 When generating position-independent code, emit function calls using
8967 the Global Offset Table instead of the Procedure Linkage Table.
8971 Generate a library function call to invalidate instruction cache
8972 entries, after fixing up a trampoline. This library function call
8973 doesn't assume it can write to the whole memory address space. This
8974 is the default when the target is @code{sh-*-linux*}.
8977 @node System V Options
8978 @subsection Options for System V
8980 These additional options are available on System V Release 4 for
8981 compatibility with other compilers on those systems:
8986 Create a shared object.
8987 It is recommended that @option{-symbolic} or @option{-shared} be used instead.
8991 Identify the versions of each tool used by the compiler, in a
8992 @code{.ident} assembler directive in the output.
8996 Refrain from adding @code{.ident} directives to the output file (this is
8999 @item -YP,@var{dirs}
9001 Search the directories @var{dirs}, and no others, for libraries
9002 specified with @option{-l}.
9006 Look in the directory @var{dir} to find the M4 preprocessor.
9007 The assembler uses this option.
9008 @c This is supposed to go with a -Yd for predefined M4 macro files, but
9009 @c the generic assembler that comes with Solaris takes just -Ym.
9012 @node TMS320C3x/C4x Options
9013 @subsection TMS320C3x/C4x Options
9014 @cindex TMS320C3x/C4x Options
9016 These @samp{-m} options are defined for TMS320C3x/C4x implementations:
9020 @item -mcpu=@var{cpu_type}
9022 Set the instruction set, register set, and instruction scheduling
9023 parameters for machine type @var{cpu_type}. Supported values for
9024 @var{cpu_type} are @samp{c30}, @samp{c31}, @samp{c32}, @samp{c40}, and
9025 @samp{c44}. The default is @samp{c40} to generate code for the
9030 @itemx -msmall-memory
9032 @opindex mbig-memory
9034 @opindex msmall-memory
9036 Generates code for the big or small memory model. The small memory
9037 model assumed that all data fits into one 64K word page. At run-time
9038 the data page (DP) register must be set to point to the 64K page
9039 containing the .bss and .data program sections. The big memory model is
9040 the default and requires reloading of the DP register for every direct
9047 Allow (disallow) allocation of general integer operands into the block
9054 Enable (disable) generation of code using decrement and branch,
9055 DBcond(D), instructions. This is enabled by default for the C4x. To be
9056 on the safe side, this is disabled for the C3x, since the maximum
9057 iteration count on the C3x is @math{2^{23} + 1} (but who iterates loops more than
9058 @math{2^{23}} times on the C3x?). Note that GCC will try to reverse a loop so
9059 that it can utilize the decrement and branch instruction, but will give
9060 up if there is more than one memory reference in the loop. Thus a loop
9061 where the loop counter is decremented can generate slightly more
9062 efficient code, in cases where the RPTB instruction cannot be utilized.
9064 @item -mdp-isr-reload
9066 @opindex mdp-isr-reload
9068 Force the DP register to be saved on entry to an interrupt service
9069 routine (ISR), reloaded to point to the data section, and restored on
9070 exit from the ISR@. This should not be required unless someone has
9071 violated the small memory model by modifying the DP register, say within
9078 For the C3x use the 24-bit MPYI instruction for integer multiplies
9079 instead of a library call to guarantee 32-bit results. Note that if one
9080 of the operands is a constant, then the multiplication will be performed
9081 using shifts and adds. If the @option{-mmpyi} option is not specified for the C3x,
9082 then squaring operations are performed inline instead of a library call.
9085 @itemx -mno-fast-fix
9087 @opindex mno-fast-fix
9088 The C3x/C4x FIX instruction to convert a floating point value to an
9089 integer value chooses the nearest integer less than or equal to the
9090 floating point value rather than to the nearest integer. Thus if the
9091 floating point number is negative, the result will be incorrectly
9092 truncated an additional code is necessary to detect and correct this
9093 case. This option can be used to disable generation of the additional
9094 code required to correct the result.
9100 Enable (disable) generation of repeat block sequences using the RPTB
9101 instruction for zero overhead looping. The RPTB construct is only used
9102 for innermost loops that do not call functions or jump across the loop
9103 boundaries. There is no advantage having nested RPTB loops due to the
9104 overhead required to save and restore the RC, RS, and RE registers.
9105 This is enabled by default with @option{-O2}.
9107 @item -mrpts=@var{count}
9111 Enable (disable) the use of the single instruction repeat instruction
9112 RPTS@. If a repeat block contains a single instruction, and the loop
9113 count can be guaranteed to be less than the value @var{count}, GCC will
9114 emit a RPTS instruction instead of a RPTB@. If no value is specified,
9115 then a RPTS will be emitted even if the loop count cannot be determined
9116 at compile time. Note that the repeated instruction following RPTS does
9117 not have to be reloaded from memory each iteration, thus freeing up the
9118 CPU buses for operands. However, since interrupts are blocked by this
9119 instruction, it is disabled by default.
9121 @item -mloop-unsigned
9122 @itemx -mno-loop-unsigned
9123 @opindex mloop-unsigned
9124 @opindex mno-loop-unsigned
9125 The maximum iteration count when using RPTS and RPTB (and DB on the C40)
9126 is @math{2^{31} + 1} since these instructions test if the iteration count is
9127 negative to terminate the loop. If the iteration count is unsigned
9128 there is a possibility than the @math{2^{31} + 1} maximum iteration count may be
9129 exceeded. This switch allows an unsigned iteration count.
9133 Try to emit an assembler syntax that the TI assembler (asm30) is happy
9134 with. This also enforces compatibility with the API employed by the TI
9135 C3x C compiler. For example, long doubles are passed as structures
9136 rather than in floating point registers.
9142 Generate code that uses registers (stack) for passing arguments to functions.
9143 By default, arguments are passed in registers where possible rather
9144 than by pushing arguments on to the stack.
9146 @item -mparallel-insns
9147 @itemx -mno-parallel-insns
9148 @opindex mparallel-insns
9149 @opindex mno-parallel-insns
9150 Allow the generation of parallel instructions. This is enabled by
9151 default with @option{-O2}.
9153 @item -mparallel-mpy
9154 @itemx -mno-parallel-mpy
9155 @opindex mparallel-mpy
9156 @opindex mno-parallel-mpy
9157 Allow the generation of MPY||ADD and MPY||SUB parallel instructions,
9158 provided @option{-mparallel-insns} is also specified. These instructions have
9159 tight register constraints which can pessimize the code generation
9165 @subsection V850 Options
9166 @cindex V850 Options
9168 These @samp{-m} options are defined for V850 implementations:
9172 @itemx -mno-long-calls
9173 @opindex mlong-calls
9174 @opindex mno-long-calls
9175 Treat all calls as being far away (near). If calls are assumed to be
9176 far away, the compiler will always load the functions address up into a
9177 register, and call indirect through the pointer.
9183 Do not optimize (do optimize) basic blocks that use the same index
9184 pointer 4 or more times to copy pointer into the @code{ep} register, and
9185 use the shorter @code{sld} and @code{sst} instructions. The @option{-mep}
9186 option is on by default if you optimize.
9188 @item -mno-prolog-function
9189 @itemx -mprolog-function
9190 @opindex mno-prolog-function
9191 @opindex mprolog-function
9192 Do not use (do use) external functions to save and restore registers at
9193 the prolog and epilog of a function. The external functions are slower,
9194 but use less code space if more than one function saves the same number
9195 of registers. The @option{-mprolog-function} option is on by default if
9200 Try to make the code as small as possible. At present, this just turns
9201 on the @option{-mep} and @option{-mprolog-function} options.
9205 Put static or global variables whose size is @var{n} bytes or less into
9206 the tiny data area that register @code{ep} points to. The tiny data
9207 area can hold up to 256 bytes in total (128 bytes for byte references).
9211 Put static or global variables whose size is @var{n} bytes or less into
9212 the small data area that register @code{gp} points to. The small data
9213 area can hold up to 64 kilobytes.
9217 Put static or global variables whose size is @var{n} bytes or less into
9218 the first 32 kilobytes of memory.
9222 Specify that the target processor is the V850.
9225 @opindex mbig-switch
9226 Generate code suitable for big switch tables. Use this option only if
9227 the assembler/linker complain about out of range branches within a switch
9232 This option will cause r2 and r5 to be used in the code generated by
9233 the compiler. This setting is the default.
9236 @opindex -mno-app-regs
9237 This option will cause r2 and r5 to be treated as fixed registers.
9241 Specify that the target processor is the V850E. The preprocessor
9242 constant @samp{__v850e__} will be defined if this option is used.
9244 If neither @option{-mv850} nor @option{-mv850e} are defined
9245 then a default target processor will be chosen and the relevant
9246 @samp{__v850*__} preprocessor constant will be defined.
9248 The preprocessor constants @samp{__v850} and @samp{__v851__} are always
9249 defined, regardless of which processor variant is the target.
9251 @item -mdisable-callt
9252 @opindex -mdisable-callt
9253 This option will suppress generation of the CALLT instruction for the
9254 v850e flavors of the v850 architecture. The default is
9255 @option{-mno-disable-callt} which allows the CALLT instruction to be used.
9260 @subsection ARC Options
9263 These options are defined for ARC implementations:
9268 Compile code for little endian mode. This is the default.
9272 Compile code for big endian mode.
9275 @opindex mmangle-cpu
9276 Prepend the name of the cpu to all public symbol names.
9277 In multiple-processor systems, there are many ARC variants with different
9278 instruction and register set characteristics. This flag prevents code
9279 compiled for one cpu to be linked with code compiled for another.
9280 No facility exists for handling variants that are ``almost identical''.
9281 This is an all or nothing option.
9283 @item -mcpu=@var{cpu}
9285 Compile code for ARC variant @var{cpu}.
9286 Which variants are supported depend on the configuration.
9287 All variants support @option{-mcpu=base}, this is the default.
9289 @item -mtext=@var{text-section}
9290 @itemx -mdata=@var{data-section}
9291 @itemx -mrodata=@var{readonly-data-section}
9295 Put functions, data, and readonly data in @var{text-section},
9296 @var{data-section}, and @var{readonly-data-section} respectively
9297 by default. This can be overridden with the @code{section} attribute.
9298 @xref{Variable Attributes}.
9303 @subsection NS32K Options
9304 @cindex NS32K options
9306 These are the @samp{-m} options defined for the 32000 series. The default
9307 values for these options depends on which style of 32000 was selected when
9308 the compiler was configured; the defaults for the most common choices are
9316 Generate output for a 32032. This is the default
9317 when the compiler is configured for 32032 and 32016 based systems.
9323 Generate output for a 32332. This is the default
9324 when the compiler is configured for 32332-based systems.
9330 Generate output for a 32532. This is the default
9331 when the compiler is configured for 32532-based systems.
9335 Generate output containing 32081 instructions for floating point.
9336 This is the default for all systems.
9340 Generate output containing 32381 instructions for floating point. This
9341 also implies @option{-m32081}. The 32381 is only compatible with the 32332
9342 and 32532 cpus. This is the default for the pc532-netbsd configuration.
9346 Try and generate multiply-add floating point instructions @code{polyF}
9347 and @code{dotF}. This option is only available if the @option{-m32381}
9348 option is in effect. Using these instructions requires changes to
9349 register allocation which generally has a negative impact on
9350 performance. This option should only be enabled when compiling code
9351 particularly likely to make heavy use of multiply-add instructions.
9354 @opindex mnomulti-add
9355 Do not try and generate multiply-add floating point instructions
9356 @code{polyF} and @code{dotF}. This is the default on all platforms.
9359 @opindex msoft-float
9360 Generate output containing library calls for floating point.
9361 @strong{Warning:} the requisite libraries may not be available.
9363 @item -mieee-compare
9364 @itemx -mno-ieee-compare
9365 @opindex mieee-compare
9366 @opindex mno-ieee-compare
9367 Control whether or not the compiler uses IEEE floating point
9368 comparisons. These handle correctly the case where the result of a
9369 comparison is unordered.
9370 @strong{Warning:} the requisite kernel support may not be available.
9373 @opindex mnobitfield
9374 Do not use the bit-field instructions. On some machines it is faster to
9375 use shifting and masking operations. This is the default for the pc532.
9379 Do use the bit-field instructions. This is the default for all platforms
9384 Use a different function-calling convention, in which functions
9385 that take a fixed number of arguments return pop their
9386 arguments on return with the @code{ret} instruction.
9388 This calling convention is incompatible with the one normally
9389 used on Unix, so you cannot use it if you need to call libraries
9390 compiled with the Unix compiler.
9392 Also, you must provide function prototypes for all functions that
9393 take variable numbers of arguments (including @code{printf});
9394 otherwise incorrect code will be generated for calls to those
9397 In addition, seriously incorrect code will result if you call a
9398 function with too many arguments. (Normally, extra arguments are
9399 harmlessly ignored.)
9401 This option takes its name from the 680x0 @code{rtd} instruction.
9406 Use a different function-calling convention where the first two arguments
9407 are passed in registers.
9409 This calling convention is incompatible with the one normally
9410 used on Unix, so you cannot use it if you need to call libraries
9411 compiled with the Unix compiler.
9414 @opindex mnoregparam
9415 Do not pass any arguments in registers. This is the default for all
9420 It is OK to use the sb as an index register which is always loaded with
9421 zero. This is the default for the pc532-netbsd target.
9425 The sb register is not available for use or has not been initialized to
9426 zero by the run time system. This is the default for all targets except
9427 the pc532-netbsd. It is also implied whenever @option{-mhimem} or
9428 @option{-fpic} is set.
9432 Many ns32000 series addressing modes use displacements of up to 512MB@.
9433 If an address is above 512MB then displacements from zero can not be used.
9434 This option causes code to be generated which can be loaded above 512MB@.
9435 This may be useful for operating systems or ROM code.
9439 Assume code will be loaded in the first 512MB of virtual address space.
9440 This is the default for all platforms.
9446 @subsection AVR Options
9449 These options are defined for AVR implementations:
9452 @item -mmcu=@var{mcu}
9454 Specify ATMEL AVR instruction set or MCU type.
9456 Instruction set avr1 is for the minimal AVR core, not supported by the C
9457 compiler, only for assembler programs (MCU types: at90s1200, attiny10,
9458 attiny11, attiny12, attiny15, attiny28).
9460 Instruction set avr2 (default) is for the classic AVR core with up to
9461 8K program memory space (MCU types: at90s2313, at90s2323, attiny22,
9462 at90s2333, at90s2343, at90s4414, at90s4433, at90s4434, at90s8515,
9463 at90c8534, at90s8535).
9465 Instruction set avr3 is for the classic AVR core with up to 128K program
9466 memory space (MCU types: atmega103, atmega603, at43usb320, at76c711).
9468 Instruction set avr4 is for the enhanced AVR core with up to 8K program
9469 memory space (MCU types: atmega8, atmega83, atmega85).
9471 Instruction set avr5 is for the enhanced AVR core with up to 128K program
9472 memory space (MCU types: atmega16, atmega161, atmega163, atmega32, atmega323,
9473 atmega64, atmega128, at43usb355, at94k).
9477 Output instruction sizes to the asm file.
9479 @item -minit-stack=@var{N}
9480 @opindex minit-stack
9481 Specify the initial stack address, which may be a symbol or numeric value,
9482 @samp{__stack} is the default.
9484 @item -mno-interrupts
9485 @opindex mno-interrupts
9486 Generated code is not compatible with hardware interrupts.
9487 Code size will be smaller.
9489 @item -mcall-prologues
9490 @opindex mcall-prologues
9491 Functions prologues/epilogues expanded as call to appropriate
9492 subroutines. Code size will be smaller.
9494 @item -mno-tablejump
9495 @opindex mno-tablejump
9496 Do not generate tablejump insns which sometimes increase code size.
9499 @opindex mtiny-stack
9500 Change only the low 8 bits of the stack pointer.
9504 @subsection MCore Options
9505 @cindex MCore options
9507 These are the @samp{-m} options defined for the Motorola M*Core
9517 @opindex mno-hardlit
9518 Inline constants into the code stream if it can be done in two
9519 instructions or less.
9527 Use the divide instruction. (Enabled by default).
9529 @item -mrelax-immediate
9530 @itemx -mrelax-immediate
9531 @itemx -mno-relax-immediate
9532 @opindex mrelax-immediate
9533 @opindex mrelax-immediate
9534 @opindex mno-relax-immediate
9535 Allow arbitrary sized immediates in bit operations.
9537 @item -mwide-bitfields
9538 @itemx -mwide-bitfields
9539 @itemx -mno-wide-bitfields
9540 @opindex mwide-bitfields
9541 @opindex mwide-bitfields
9542 @opindex mno-wide-bitfields
9543 Always treat bit-fields as int-sized.
9545 @item -m4byte-functions
9546 @itemx -m4byte-functions
9547 @itemx -mno-4byte-functions
9548 @opindex m4byte-functions
9549 @opindex m4byte-functions
9550 @opindex mno-4byte-functions
9551 Force all functions to be aligned to a four byte boundary.
9553 @item -mcallgraph-data
9554 @itemx -mcallgraph-data
9555 @itemx -mno-callgraph-data
9556 @opindex mcallgraph-data
9557 @opindex mcallgraph-data
9558 @opindex mno-callgraph-data
9559 Emit callgraph information.
9563 @itemx -mno-slow-bytes
9564 @opindex mslow-bytes
9565 @opindex mslow-bytes
9566 @opindex mno-slow-bytes
9567 Prefer word access when reading byte quantities.
9569 @item -mlittle-endian
9570 @itemx -mlittle-endian
9572 @opindex mlittle-endian
9573 @opindex mlittle-endian
9574 @opindex mbig-endian
9575 Generate code for a little endian target.
9583 Generate code for the 210 processor.
9587 @subsection IA-64 Options
9588 @cindex IA-64 Options
9590 These are the @samp{-m} options defined for the Intel IA-64 architecture.
9594 @opindex mbig-endian
9595 Generate code for a big endian target. This is the default for HP-UX@.
9597 @item -mlittle-endian
9598 @opindex mlittle-endian
9599 Generate code for a little endian target. This is the default for AIX5
9606 Generate (or don't) code for the GNU assembler. This is the default.
9607 @c Also, this is the default if the configure option @option{--with-gnu-as}
9614 Generate (or don't) code for the GNU linker. This is the default.
9615 @c Also, this is the default if the configure option @option{--with-gnu-ld}
9620 Generate code that does not use a global pointer register. The result
9621 is not position independent code, and violates the IA-64 ABI@.
9623 @item -mvolatile-asm-stop
9624 @itemx -mno-volatile-asm-stop
9625 @opindex mvolatile-asm-stop
9626 @opindex mno-volatile-asm-stop
9627 Generate (or don't) a stop bit immediately before and after volatile asm
9632 Generate code that works around Itanium B step errata.
9634 @item -mregister-names
9635 @itemx -mno-register-names
9636 @opindex mregister-names
9637 @opindex mno-register-names
9638 Generate (or don't) @samp{in}, @samp{loc}, and @samp{out} register names for
9639 the stacked registers. This may make assembler output more readable.
9645 Disable (or enable) optimizations that use the small data section. This may
9646 be useful for working around optimizer bugs.
9649 @opindex mconstant-gp
9650 Generate code that uses a single constant global pointer value. This is
9651 useful when compiling kernel code.
9655 Generate code that is self-relocatable. This implies @option{-mconstant-gp}.
9656 This is useful when compiling firmware code.
9658 @item -minline-float-divide-min-latency
9659 @opindex minline-float-divide-min-latency
9660 Generate code for inline divides of floating point values
9661 using the minimum latency algorithm.
9663 @item -minline-float-divide-max-throughput
9664 @opindex minline-float-divide-max-throughput
9665 Generate code for inline divides of floating point values
9666 using the maximum throughput algorithm.
9668 @item -minline-int-divide-min-latency
9669 @opindex minline-int-divide-min-latency
9670 Generate code for inline divides of integer values
9671 using the minimum latency algorithm.
9673 @item -minline-int-divide-max-throughput
9674 @opindex minline-int-divide-max-throughput
9675 Generate code for inline divides of integer values
9676 using the maximum throughput algorithm.
9678 @item -mno-dwarf2-asm
9680 @opindex mno-dwarf2-asm
9681 @opindex mdwarf2-asm
9682 Don't (or do) generate assembler code for the DWARF2 line number debugging
9683 info. This may be useful when not using the GNU assembler.
9685 @item -mfixed-range=@var{register-range}
9686 @opindex mfixed-range
9687 Generate code treating the given register range as fixed registers.
9688 A fixed register is one that the register allocator can not use. This is
9689 useful when compiling kernel code. A register range is specified as
9690 two registers separated by a dash. Multiple register ranges can be
9691 specified separated by a comma.
9693 @item -mearly-stop-bits
9694 @itemx -mno-early-stop-bits
9695 @opindex mearly-stop-bits
9696 @opindex mno-early-stop-bits
9697 Allow stop bits to be placed earlier than immediately preceding the
9698 instruction that triggered the stop bit. This can improve instruction
9699 scheduling, but does not always do so.
9703 @subsection D30V Options
9704 @cindex D30V Options
9706 These @samp{-m} options are defined for D30V implementations:
9711 Link the @samp{.text}, @samp{.data}, @samp{.bss}, @samp{.strings},
9712 @samp{.rodata}, @samp{.rodata1}, @samp{.data1} sections into external
9713 memory, which starts at location @code{0x80000000}.
9717 Same as the @option{-mextmem} switch.
9721 Link the @samp{.text} section into onchip text memory, which starts at
9722 location @code{0x0}. Also link @samp{.data}, @samp{.bss},
9723 @samp{.strings}, @samp{.rodata}, @samp{.rodata1}, @samp{.data1} sections
9724 into onchip data memory, which starts at location @code{0x20000000}.
9726 @item -mno-asm-optimize
9727 @itemx -masm-optimize
9728 @opindex mno-asm-optimize
9729 @opindex masm-optimize
9730 Disable (enable) passing @option{-O} to the assembler when optimizing.
9731 The assembler uses the @option{-O} option to automatically parallelize
9732 adjacent short instructions where possible.
9734 @item -mbranch-cost=@var{n}
9735 @opindex mbranch-cost
9736 Increase the internal costs of branches to @var{n}. Higher costs means
9737 that the compiler will issue more instructions to avoid doing a branch.
9740 @item -mcond-exec=@var{n}
9742 Specify the maximum number of conditionally executed instructions that
9743 replace a branch. The default is 4.
9746 @node S/390 and zSeries Options
9747 @subsection S/390 and zSeries Options
9748 @cindex S/390 and zSeries Options
9750 These are the @samp{-m} options defined for the S/390 and zSeries architecture.
9755 @opindex mhard-float
9756 @opindex msoft-float
9757 Use (do not use) the hardware floating-point instructions and registers
9758 for floating-point operations. When @option{-msoft-float} is specified,
9759 functions in @file{libgcc.a} will be used to perform floating-point
9760 operations. When @option{-mhard-float} is specified, the compiler
9761 generates IEEE floating-point instructions. This is the default.
9764 @itemx -mno-backchain
9766 @opindex mno-backchain
9767 Generate (or do not generate) code which maintains an explicit
9768 backchain within the stack frame that points to the caller's frame.
9769 This is currently needed to allow debugging. The default is to
9770 generate the backchain.
9773 @itemx -mno-small-exec
9774 @opindex msmall-exec
9775 @opindex mno-small-exec
9776 Generate (or do not generate) code using the @code{bras} instruction
9777 to do subroutine calls.
9778 This only works reliably if the total executable size does not
9779 exceed 64k. The default is to use the @code{basr} instruction instead,
9780 which does not have this limitation.
9786 When @option{-m31} is specified, generate code compliant to the
9787 Linux for S/390 ABI@. When @option{-m64} is specified, generate
9788 code compliant to the Linux for zSeries ABI@. This allows GCC in
9789 particular to generate 64-bit instructions. For the @samp{s390}
9790 targets, the default is @option{-m31}, while the @samp{s390x}
9791 targets default to @option{-m64}.
9797 When @option{-mzarch} is specified, generate code using the
9798 instructions available on z/Architecture.
9799 When @option{-mesa} is specified, generate code using the
9800 instructions available on ESA/390. Note that @option{-mesa} is
9801 not possible with @option{-m64}.
9802 For the @samp{s390} targets, the default is @option{-mesa},
9803 while the @samp{s390x} targets default to @option{-mzarch}.
9809 Generate (or do not generate) code using the @code{mvcle} instruction
9810 to perform block moves. When @option{-mno-mvcle} is specified,
9811 use a @code{mvc} loop instead. This is the default.
9817 Print (or do not print) additional debug information when compiling.
9818 The default is to not print debug information.
9820 @item -march=@var{arch}
9822 Generate code that will run on @var{arch}, which is the name of system
9823 representing a certain processor type. Possible values for
9824 @var{cpu-type} are @samp{g5}, @samp{g6} and @samp{z900}.
9826 @item -mtune=@var{arch}
9828 Tune to @var{cpu-type} everything applicable about the generated code,
9829 except for the ABI and the set of available instructions.
9830 The list of @var{arch} values is the same as for @option{-march}.
9835 @subsection CRIS Options
9836 @cindex CRIS Options
9838 These options are defined specifically for the CRIS ports.
9841 @item -march=@var{architecture-type}
9842 @itemx -mcpu=@var{architecture-type}
9845 Generate code for the specified architecture. The choices for
9846 @var{architecture-type} are @samp{v3}, @samp{v8} and @samp{v10} for
9847 respectively ETRAX@w{ }4, ETRAX@w{ }100, and ETRAX@w{ }100@w{ }LX.
9848 Default is @samp{v0} except for cris-axis-linux-gnu, where the default is
9851 @item -mtune=@var{architecture-type}
9853 Tune to @var{architecture-type} everything applicable about the generated
9854 code, except for the ABI and the set of available instructions. The
9855 choices for @var{architecture-type} are the same as for
9856 @option{-march=@var{architecture-type}}.
9858 @item -mmax-stack-frame=@var{n}
9859 @opindex mmax-stack-frame
9860 Warn when the stack frame of a function exceeds @var{n} bytes.
9862 @item -melinux-stacksize=@var{n}
9863 @opindex melinux-stacksize
9864 Only available with the @samp{cris-axis-aout} target. Arranges for
9865 indications in the program to the kernel loader that the stack of the
9866 program should be set to @var{n} bytes.
9872 The options @option{-metrax4} and @option{-metrax100} are synonyms for
9873 @option{-march=v3} and @option{-march=v8} respectively.
9877 Enable CRIS-specific verbose debug-related information in the assembly
9878 code. This option also has the effect to turn off the @samp{#NO_APP}
9879 formatted-code indicator to the assembler at the beginning of the
9884 Do not use condition-code results from previous instruction; always emit
9885 compare and test instructions before use of condition codes.
9887 @item -mno-side-effects
9888 @opindex mno-side-effects
9889 Do not emit instructions with side-effects in addressing modes other than
9893 @itemx -mno-stack-align
9895 @itemx -mno-data-align
9896 @itemx -mconst-align
9897 @itemx -mno-const-align
9898 @opindex mstack-align
9899 @opindex mno-stack-align
9900 @opindex mdata-align
9901 @opindex mno-data-align
9902 @opindex mconst-align
9903 @opindex mno-const-align
9904 These options (no-options) arranges (eliminate arrangements) for the
9905 stack-frame, individual data and constants to be aligned for the maximum
9906 single data access size for the chosen CPU model. The default is to
9907 arrange for 32-bit alignment. ABI details such as structure layout are
9908 not affected by these options.
9916 Similar to the stack- data- and const-align options above, these options
9917 arrange for stack-frame, writable data and constants to all be 32-bit,
9918 16-bit or 8-bit aligned. The default is 32-bit alignment.
9920 @item -mno-prologue-epilogue
9921 @itemx -mprologue-epilogue
9922 @opindex mno-prologue-epilogue
9923 @opindex mprologue-epilogue
9924 With @option{-mno-prologue-epilogue}, the normal function prologue and
9925 epilogue that sets up the stack-frame are omitted and no return
9926 instructions or return sequences are generated in the code. Use this
9927 option only together with visual inspection of the compiled code: no
9928 warnings or errors are generated when call-saved registers must be saved,
9929 or storage for local variable needs to be allocated.
9935 With @option{-fpic} and @option{-fPIC}, don't generate (do generate)
9936 instruction sequences that load addresses for functions from the PLT part
9937 of the GOT rather than (traditional on other architectures) calls to the
9938 PLT. The default is @option{-mgotplt}.
9942 Legacy no-op option only recognized with the cris-axis-aout target.
9946 Legacy no-op option only recognized with the cris-axis-elf and
9947 cris-axis-linux-gnu targets.
9951 Only recognized with the cris-axis-aout target, where it selects a
9952 GNU/linux-like multilib, include files and instruction set for
9957 Legacy no-op option only recognized with the cris-axis-linux-gnu target.
9961 This option, recognized for the cris-axis-aout and cris-axis-elf arranges
9962 to link with input-output functions from a simulator library. Code,
9963 initialized data and zero-initialized data are allocated consecutively.
9967 Like @option{-sim}, but pass linker options to locate initialized data at
9968 0x40000000 and zero-initialized data at 0x80000000.
9972 @subsection MMIX Options
9973 @cindex MMIX Options
9975 These options are defined for the MMIX:
9979 @itemx -mno-libfuncs
9981 @opindex mno-libfuncs
9982 Specify that intrinsic library functions are being compiled, passing all
9983 values in registers, no matter the size.
9988 @opindex mno-epsilon
9989 Generate floating-point comparison instructions that compare with respect
9990 to the @code{rE} epsilon register.
9992 @item -mabi=mmixware
9994 @opindex mabi-mmixware
9996 Generate code that passes function parameters and return values that (in
9997 the called function) are seen as registers @code{$0} and up, as opposed to
9998 the GNU ABI which uses global registers @code{$231} and up.
10000 @item -mzero-extend
10001 @itemx -mno-zero-extend
10002 @opindex mzero-extend
10003 @opindex mno-zero-extend
10004 When reading data from memory in sizes shorter than 64 bits, use (do not
10005 use) zero-extending load instructions by default, rather than
10006 sign-extending ones.
10009 @itemx -mno-knuthdiv
10011 @opindex mno-knuthdiv
10012 Make the result of a division yielding a remainder have the same sign as
10013 the divisor. With the default, @option{-mno-knuthdiv}, the sign of the
10014 remainder follows the sign of the dividend. Both methods are
10015 arithmetically valid, the latter being almost exclusively used.
10017 @item -mtoplevel-symbols
10018 @itemx -mno-toplevel-symbols
10019 @opindex mtoplevel-symbols
10020 @opindex mno-toplevel-symbols
10021 Prepend (do not prepend) a @samp{:} to all global symbols, so the assembly
10022 code can be used with the @code{PREFIX} assembly directive.
10026 Generate an executable in the ELF format, rather than the default
10027 @samp{mmo} format used by the @command{mmix} simulator.
10029 @item -mbranch-predict
10030 @itemx -mno-branch-predict
10031 @opindex mbranch-predict
10032 @opindex mno-branch-predict
10033 Use (do not use) the probable-branch instructions, when static branch
10034 prediction indicates a probable branch.
10036 @item -mbase-addresses
10037 @itemx -mno-base-addresses
10038 @opindex mbase-addresses
10039 @opindex mno-base-addresses
10040 Generate (do not generate) code that uses @emph{base addresses}. Using a
10041 base address automatically generates a request (handled by the assembler
10042 and the linker) for a constant to be set up in a global register. The
10043 register is used for one or more base address requests within the range 0
10044 to 255 from the value held in the register. The generally leads to short
10045 and fast code, but the number of different data items that can be
10046 addressed is limited. This means that a program that uses lots of static
10047 data may require @option{-mno-base-addresses}.
10049 @item -msingle-exit
10050 @itemx -mno-single-exit
10051 @opindex msingle-exit
10052 @opindex mno-single-exit
10053 Force (do not force) generated code to have a single exit point in each
10057 @node PDP-11 Options
10058 @subsection PDP-11 Options
10059 @cindex PDP-11 Options
10061 These options are defined for the PDP-11:
10066 Use hardware FPP floating point. This is the default. (FIS floating
10067 point on the PDP-11/40 is not supported.)
10070 @opindex msoft-float
10071 Do not use hardware floating point.
10075 Return floating-point results in ac0 (fr0 in Unix assembler syntax).
10079 Return floating-point results in memory. This is the default.
10083 Generate code for a PDP-11/40.
10087 Generate code for a PDP-11/45. This is the default.
10091 Generate code for a PDP-11/10.
10093 @item -mbcopy-builtin
10094 @opindex bcopy-builtin
10095 Use inline @code{movstrhi} patterns for copying memory. This is the
10100 Do not use inline @code{movstrhi} patterns for copying memory.
10106 Use 16-bit @code{int}. This is the default.
10112 Use 32-bit @code{int}.
10115 @itemx -mno-float32
10117 @opindex mno-float32
10118 Use 64-bit @code{float}. This is the default.
10123 @opindex mno-float64
10124 Use 32-bit @code{float}.
10128 Use @code{abshi2} pattern. This is the default.
10132 Do not use @code{abshi2} pattern.
10134 @item -mbranch-expensive
10135 @opindex mbranch-expensive
10136 Pretend that branches are expensive. This is for experimenting with
10137 code generation only.
10139 @item -mbranch-cheap
10140 @opindex mbranch-cheap
10141 Do not pretend that branches are expensive. This is the default.
10145 Generate code for a system with split I&D.
10149 Generate code for a system without split I&D. This is the default.
10153 Use Unix assembler syntax. This is the default when configured for
10154 @samp{pdp11-*-bsd}.
10158 Use DEC assembler syntax. This is the default when configured for any
10159 PDP-11 target other than @samp{pdp11-*-bsd}.
10162 @node Xstormy16 Options
10163 @subsection Xstormy16 Options
10164 @cindex Xstormy16 Options
10166 These options are defined for Xstormy16:
10171 Choose startup files and linker script suitable for the simulator.
10175 @subsection FRV Options
10176 @cindex FRV Options
10182 Only use the first 32 general purpose registers.
10187 Use all 64 general purpose registers.
10192 Use only the first 32 floating point registers.
10197 Use all 64 floating point registers
10200 @opindex mhard-float
10202 Use hardware instructions for floating point operations.
10205 @opindex msoft-float
10207 Use library routines for floating point operations.
10212 Dynamically allocate condition code registers.
10217 Do not try to dynamically allocate condition code registers, only
10218 use @code{icc0} and @code{fcc0}.
10223 Change ABI to use double word insns.
10228 Do not use double word instructions.
10233 Use floating point double instructions.
10236 @opindex mno-double
10238 Do not use floating point double instructions.
10243 Use media instructions.
10248 Do not use media instructions.
10253 Use multiply and add/subtract instructions.
10256 @opindex mno-muladd
10258 Do not use multiply and add/subtract instructions.
10260 @item -mlibrary-pic
10261 @opindex mlibrary-pic
10263 Enable PIC support for building libraries
10268 Use only the first four media accumulator registers.
10273 Use all eight media accumulator registers.
10278 Pack VLIW instructions.
10283 Do not pack VLIW instructions.
10286 @opindex mno-eflags
10288 Do not mark ABI switches in e_flags.
10291 @opindex mcond-move
10293 Enable the use of conditional-move instructions (default).
10295 This switch is mainly for debugging the compiler and will likely be removed
10296 in a future version.
10298 @item -mno-cond-move
10299 @opindex mno-cond-move
10301 Disable the use of conditional-move instructions.
10303 This switch is mainly for debugging the compiler and will likely be removed
10304 in a future version.
10309 Enable the use of conditional set instructions (default).
10311 This switch is mainly for debugging the compiler and will likely be removed
10312 in a future version.
10317 Disable the use of conditional set instructions.
10319 This switch is mainly for debugging the compiler and will likely be removed
10320 in a future version.
10323 @opindex mcond-exec
10325 Enable the use of conditional execution (default).
10327 This switch is mainly for debugging the compiler and will likely be removed
10328 in a future version.
10330 @item -mno-cond-exec
10331 @opindex mno-cond-exec
10333 Disable the use of conditional execution.
10335 This switch is mainly for debugging the compiler and will likely be removed
10336 in a future version.
10338 @item -mvliw-branch
10339 @opindex mvliw-branch
10341 Run a pass to pack branches into VLIW instructions (default).
10343 This switch is mainly for debugging the compiler and will likely be removed
10344 in a future version.
10346 @item -mno-vliw-branch
10347 @opindex mno-vliw-branch
10349 Do not run a pass to pack branches into VLIW instructions.
10351 This switch is mainly for debugging the compiler and will likely be removed
10352 in a future version.
10354 @item -mmulti-cond-exec
10355 @opindex mmulti-cond-exec
10357 Enable optimization of @code{&&} and @code{||} in conditional execution
10360 This switch is mainly for debugging the compiler and will likely be removed
10361 in a future version.
10363 @item -mno-multi-cond-exec
10364 @opindex mno-multi-cond-exec
10366 Disable optimization of @code{&&} and @code{||} in conditional execution.
10368 This switch is mainly for debugging the compiler and will likely be removed
10369 in a future version.
10371 @item -mnested-cond-exec
10372 @opindex mnested-cond-exec
10374 Enable nested conditional execution optimizations (default).
10376 This switch is mainly for debugging the compiler and will likely be removed
10377 in a future version.
10379 @item -mno-nested-cond-exec
10380 @opindex mno-nested-cond-exec
10382 Disable nested conditional execution optimizations.
10384 This switch is mainly for debugging the compiler and will likely be removed
10385 in a future version.
10387 @item -mtomcat-stats
10388 @opindex mtomcat-stats
10390 Cause gas to print out tomcat statistics.
10392 @item -mcpu=@var{cpu}
10395 Select the processor type for which to generate code. Possible values are
10396 @samp{simple}, @samp{tomcat}, @samp{fr500}, @samp{fr400}, @samp{fr300},
10401 @node Xtensa Options
10402 @subsection Xtensa Options
10403 @cindex Xtensa Options
10405 The Xtensa architecture is designed to support many different
10406 configurations. The compiler's default options can be set to match a
10407 particular Xtensa configuration by copying a configuration file into the
10408 GCC sources when building GCC@. The options below may be used to
10409 override the default options.
10413 @itemx -mlittle-endian
10414 @opindex mbig-endian
10415 @opindex mlittle-endian
10416 Specify big-endian or little-endian byte ordering for the target Xtensa
10420 @itemx -mno-density
10422 @opindex mno-density
10423 Enable or disable use of the optional Xtensa code density instructions.
10429 Enable or disable use of the Xtensa MAC16 option. When enabled, GCC
10430 will generate MAC16 instructions from standard C code, with the
10431 limitation that it will use neither the MR register file nor any
10432 instruction that operates on the MR registers. When this option is
10433 disabled, GCC will translate 16-bit multiply/accumulate operations to a
10434 combination of core instructions and library calls, depending on whether
10435 any other multiplier options are enabled.
10441 Enable or disable use of the 16-bit integer multiplier option. When
10442 enabled, the compiler will generate 16-bit multiply instructions for
10443 multiplications of 16 bits or smaller in standard C code. When this
10444 option is disabled, the compiler will either use 32-bit multiply or
10445 MAC16 instructions if they are available or generate library calls to
10446 perform the multiply operations using shifts and adds.
10452 Enable or disable use of the 32-bit integer multiplier option. When
10453 enabled, the compiler will generate 32-bit multiply instructions for
10454 multiplications of 32 bits or smaller in standard C code. When this
10455 option is disabled, the compiler will generate library calls to perform
10456 the multiply operations using either shifts and adds or 16-bit multiply
10457 instructions if they are available.
10463 Enable or disable use of the optional normalization shift amount
10464 (@code{NSA}) instructions to implement the built-in @code{ffs} function.
10469 @opindex mno-minmax
10470 Enable or disable use of the optional minimum and maximum value
10477 Enable or disable use of the optional sign extend (@code{SEXT})
10481 @itemx -mno-booleans
10483 @opindex mno-booleans
10484 Enable or disable support for the boolean register file used by Xtensa
10485 coprocessors. This is not typically useful by itself but may be
10486 required for other options that make use of the boolean registers (e.g.,
10487 the floating-point option).
10490 @itemx -msoft-float
10491 @opindex mhard-float
10492 @opindex msoft-float
10493 Enable or disable use of the floating-point option. When enabled, GCC
10494 generates floating-point instructions for 32-bit @code{float}
10495 operations. When this option is disabled, GCC generates library calls
10496 to emulate 32-bit floating-point operations using integer instructions.
10497 Regardless of this option, 64-bit @code{double} operations are always
10498 emulated with calls to library functions.
10501 @itemx -mno-fused-madd
10502 @opindex mfused-madd
10503 @opindex mno-fused-madd
10504 Enable or disable use of fused multiply/add and multiply/subtract
10505 instructions in the floating-point option. This has no effect if the
10506 floating-point option is not also enabled. Disabling fused multiply/add
10507 and multiply/subtract instructions forces the compiler to use separate
10508 instructions for the multiply and add/subtract operations. This may be
10509 desirable in some cases where strict IEEE 754-compliant results are
10510 required: the fused multiply add/subtract instructions do not round the
10511 intermediate result, thereby producing results with @emph{more} bits of
10512 precision than specified by the IEEE standard. Disabling fused multiply
10513 add/subtract instructions also ensures that the program output is not
10514 sensitive to the compiler's ability to combine multiply and add/subtract
10517 @item -mserialize-volatile
10518 @itemx -mno-serialize-volatile
10519 @opindex mserialize-volatile
10520 @opindex mno-serialize-volatile
10521 When this option is enabled, GCC inserts @code{MEMW} instructions before
10522 @code{volatile} memory references to guarantee sequential consistency.
10523 The default is @option{-mserialize-volatile}. Use
10524 @option{-mno-serialize-volatile} to omit the @code{MEMW} instructions.
10526 @item -mtext-section-literals
10527 @itemx -mno-text-section-literals
10528 @opindex mtext-section-literals
10529 @opindex mno-text-section-literals
10530 Control the treatment of literal pools. The default is
10531 @option{-mno-text-section-literals}, which places literals in a separate
10532 section in the output file. This allows the literal pool to be placed
10533 in a data RAM/ROM, and it also allows the linker to combine literal
10534 pools from separate object files to remove redundant literals and
10535 improve code size. With @option{-mtext-section-literals}, the literals
10536 are interspersed in the text section in order to keep them as close as
10537 possible to their references. This may be necessary for large assembly
10540 @item -mtarget-align
10541 @itemx -mno-target-align
10542 @opindex mtarget-align
10543 @opindex mno-target-align
10544 When this option is enabled, GCC instructs the assembler to
10545 automatically align instructions to reduce branch penalties at the
10546 expense of some code density. The assembler attempts to widen density
10547 instructions to align branch targets and the instructions following call
10548 instructions. If there are not enough preceding safe density
10549 instructions to align a target, no widening will be performed. The
10550 default is @option{-mtarget-align}. These options do not affect the
10551 treatment of auto-aligned instructions like @code{LOOP}, which the
10552 assembler will always align, either by widening density instructions or
10553 by inserting no-op instructions.
10556 @itemx -mno-longcalls
10557 @opindex mlongcalls
10558 @opindex mno-longcalls
10559 When this option is enabled, GCC instructs the assembler to translate
10560 direct calls to indirect calls unless it can determine that the target
10561 of a direct call is in the range allowed by the call instruction. This
10562 translation typically occurs for calls to functions in other source
10563 files. Specifically, the assembler translates a direct @code{CALL}
10564 instruction into an @code{L32R} followed by a @code{CALLX} instruction.
10565 The default is @option{-mno-longcalls}. This option should be used in
10566 programs where the call target can potentially be out of range. This
10567 option is implemented in the assembler, not the compiler, so the
10568 assembly code generated by GCC will still show direct call
10569 instructions---look at the disassembled object code to see the actual
10570 instructions. Note that the assembler will use an indirect call for
10571 every cross-file call, not just those that really will be out of range.
10574 @node Code Gen Options
10575 @section Options for Code Generation Conventions
10576 @cindex code generation conventions
10577 @cindex options, code generation
10578 @cindex run-time options
10580 These machine-independent options control the interface conventions
10581 used in code generation.
10583 Most of them have both positive and negative forms; the negative form
10584 of @option{-ffoo} would be @option{-fno-foo}. In the table below, only
10585 one of the forms is listed---the one which is not the default. You
10586 can figure out the other form by either removing @samp{no-} or adding
10590 @item -fbounds-check
10591 @opindex fbounds-check
10592 For front-ends that support it, generate additional code to check that
10593 indices used to access arrays are within the declared range. This is
10594 currently only supported by the Java and Fortran 77 front-ends, where
10595 this option defaults to true and false respectively.
10599 This option generates traps for signed overflow on addition, subtraction,
10600 multiplication operations.
10603 @opindex fexceptions
10604 Enable exception handling. Generates extra code needed to propagate
10605 exceptions. For some targets, this implies GCC will generate frame
10606 unwind information for all functions, which can produce significant data
10607 size overhead, although it does not affect execution. If you do not
10608 specify this option, GCC will enable it by default for languages like
10609 C++ which normally require exception handling, and disable it for
10610 languages like C that do not normally require it. However, you may need
10611 to enable this option when compiling C code that needs to interoperate
10612 properly with exception handlers written in C++. You may also wish to
10613 disable this option if you are compiling older C++ programs that don't
10614 use exception handling.
10616 @item -fnon-call-exceptions
10617 @opindex fnon-call-exceptions
10618 Generate code that allows trapping instructions to throw exceptions.
10619 Note that this requires platform-specific runtime support that does
10620 not exist everywhere. Moreover, it only allows @emph{trapping}
10621 instructions to throw exceptions, i.e.@: memory references or floating
10622 point instructions. It does not allow exceptions to be thrown from
10623 arbitrary signal handlers such as @code{SIGALRM}.
10625 @item -funwind-tables
10626 @opindex funwind-tables
10627 Similar to @option{-fexceptions}, except that it will just generate any needed
10628 static data, but will not affect the generated code in any other way.
10629 You will normally not enable this option; instead, a language processor
10630 that needs this handling would enable it on your behalf.
10632 @item -fasynchronous-unwind-tables
10633 @opindex funwind-tables
10634 Generate unwind table in dwarf2 format, if supported by target machine. The
10635 table is exact at each instruction boundary, so it can be used for stack
10636 unwinding from asynchronous events (such as debugger or garbage collector).
10638 @item -fpcc-struct-return
10639 @opindex fpcc-struct-return
10640 Return ``short'' @code{struct} and @code{union} values in memory like
10641 longer ones, rather than in registers. This convention is less
10642 efficient, but it has the advantage of allowing intercallability between
10643 GCC-compiled files and files compiled with other compilers, particularly
10644 the Portable C Compiler (pcc).
10646 The precise convention for returning structures in memory depends
10647 on the target configuration macros.
10649 Short structures and unions are those whose size and alignment match
10650 that of some integer type.
10652 @strong{Warning:} code compiled with the @option{-fpcc-struct-return}
10653 switch is not binary compatible with code compiled with the
10654 @option{-freg-struct-return} switch.
10655 Use it to conform to a non-default application binary interface.
10657 @item -freg-struct-return
10658 @opindex freg-struct-return
10659 Return @code{struct} and @code{union} values in registers when possible.
10660 This is more efficient for small structures than
10661 @option{-fpcc-struct-return}.
10663 If you specify neither @option{-fpcc-struct-return} nor
10664 @option{-freg-struct-return}, GCC defaults to whichever convention is
10665 standard for the target. If there is no standard convention, GCC
10666 defaults to @option{-fpcc-struct-return}, except on targets where GCC is
10667 the principal compiler. In those cases, we can choose the standard, and
10668 we chose the more efficient register return alternative.
10670 @strong{Warning:} code compiled with the @option{-freg-struct-return}
10671 switch is not binary compatible with code compiled with the
10672 @option{-fpcc-struct-return} switch.
10673 Use it to conform to a non-default application binary interface.
10675 @item -fshort-enums
10676 @opindex fshort-enums
10677 Allocate to an @code{enum} type only as many bytes as it needs for the
10678 declared range of possible values. Specifically, the @code{enum} type
10679 will be equivalent to the smallest integer type which has enough room.
10681 @strong{Warning:} the @option{-fshort-enums} switch causes GCC to generate
10682 code that is not binary compatible with code generated without that switch.
10683 Use it to conform to a non-default application binary interface.
10685 @item -fshort-double
10686 @opindex fshort-double
10687 Use the same size for @code{double} as for @code{float}.
10689 @strong{Warning:} the @option{-fshort-double} switch causes GCC to generate
10690 code that is not binary compatible with code generated without that switch.
10691 Use it to conform to a non-default application binary interface.
10693 @item -fshort-wchar
10694 @opindex fshort-wchar
10695 Override the underlying type for @samp{wchar_t} to be @samp{short
10696 unsigned int} instead of the default for the target. This option is
10697 useful for building programs to run under WINE@.
10699 @strong{Warning:} the @option{-fshort-wchar} switch causes GCC to generate
10700 code that is not binary compatible with code generated without that switch.
10701 Use it to conform to a non-default application binary interface.
10703 @item -fshared-data
10704 @opindex fshared-data
10705 Requests that the data and non-@code{const} variables of this
10706 compilation be shared data rather than private data. The distinction
10707 makes sense only on certain operating systems, where shared data is
10708 shared between processes running the same program, while private data
10709 exists in one copy per process.
10712 @opindex fno-common
10713 In C, allocate even uninitialized global variables in the data section of the
10714 object file, rather than generating them as common blocks. This has the
10715 effect that if the same variable is declared (without @code{extern}) in
10716 two different compilations, you will get an error when you link them.
10717 The only reason this might be useful is if you wish to verify that the
10718 program will work on other systems which always work this way.
10722 Ignore the @samp{#ident} directive.
10724 @item -fno-gnu-linker
10725 @opindex fno-gnu-linker
10726 Do not output global initializations (such as C++ constructors and
10727 destructors) in the form used by the GNU linker (on systems where the GNU
10728 linker is the standard method of handling them). Use this option when
10729 you want to use a non-GNU linker, which also requires using the
10730 @command{collect2} program to make sure the system linker includes
10731 constructors and destructors. (@command{collect2} is included in the GCC
10732 distribution.) For systems which @emph{must} use @command{collect2}, the
10733 compiler driver @command{gcc} is configured to do this automatically.
10735 @item -finhibit-size-directive
10736 @opindex finhibit-size-directive
10737 Don't output a @code{.size} assembler directive, or anything else that
10738 would cause trouble if the function is split in the middle, and the
10739 two halves are placed at locations far apart in memory. This option is
10740 used when compiling @file{crtstuff.c}; you should not need to use it
10743 @item -fverbose-asm
10744 @opindex fverbose-asm
10745 Put extra commentary information in the generated assembly code to
10746 make it more readable. This option is generally only of use to those
10747 who actually need to read the generated assembly code (perhaps while
10748 debugging the compiler itself).
10750 @option{-fno-verbose-asm}, the default, causes the
10751 extra information to be omitted and is useful when comparing two assembler
10756 @cindex global offset table
10758 Generate position-independent code (PIC) suitable for use in a shared
10759 library, if supported for the target machine. Such code accesses all
10760 constant addresses through a global offset table (GOT)@. The dynamic
10761 loader resolves the GOT entries when the program starts (the dynamic
10762 loader is not part of GCC; it is part of the operating system). If
10763 the GOT size for the linked executable exceeds a machine-specific
10764 maximum size, you get an error message from the linker indicating that
10765 @option{-fpic} does not work; in that case, recompile with @option{-fPIC}
10766 instead. (These maximums are 16k on the m88k, 8k on the SPARC, and 32k
10767 on the m68k and RS/6000. The 386 has no such limit.)
10769 Position-independent code requires special support, and therefore works
10770 only on certain machines. For the 386, GCC supports PIC for System V
10771 but not for the Sun 386i. Code generated for the IBM RS/6000 is always
10772 position-independent.
10776 If supported for the target machine, emit position-independent code,
10777 suitable for dynamic linking and avoiding any limit on the size of the
10778 global offset table. This option makes a difference on the m68k, m88k,
10781 Position-independent code requires special support, and therefore works
10782 only on certain machines.
10784 @item -ffixed-@var{reg}
10786 Treat the register named @var{reg} as a fixed register; generated code
10787 should never refer to it (except perhaps as a stack pointer, frame
10788 pointer or in some other fixed role).
10790 @var{reg} must be the name of a register. The register names accepted
10791 are machine-specific and are defined in the @code{REGISTER_NAMES}
10792 macro in the machine description macro file.
10794 This flag does not have a negative form, because it specifies a
10797 @item -fcall-used-@var{reg}
10798 @opindex fcall-used
10799 Treat the register named @var{reg} as an allocable register that is
10800 clobbered by function calls. It may be allocated for temporaries or
10801 variables that do not live across a call. Functions compiled this way
10802 will not save and restore the register @var{reg}.
10804 It is an error to used this flag with the frame pointer or stack pointer.
10805 Use of this flag for other registers that have fixed pervasive roles in
10806 the machine's execution model will produce disastrous results.
10808 This flag does not have a negative form, because it specifies a
10811 @item -fcall-saved-@var{reg}
10812 @opindex fcall-saved
10813 Treat the register named @var{reg} as an allocable register saved by
10814 functions. It may be allocated even for temporaries or variables that
10815 live across a call. Functions compiled this way will save and restore
10816 the register @var{reg} if they use it.
10818 It is an error to used this flag with the frame pointer or stack pointer.
10819 Use of this flag for other registers that have fixed pervasive roles in
10820 the machine's execution model will produce disastrous results.
10822 A different sort of disaster will result from the use of this flag for
10823 a register in which function values may be returned.
10825 This flag does not have a negative form, because it specifies a
10828 @item -fpack-struct
10829 @opindex fpack-struct
10830 Pack all structure members together without holes.
10832 @strong{Warning:} the @option{-fpack-struct} switch causes GCC to generate
10833 code that is not binary compatible with code generated without that switch.
10834 Additionally, it makes the code suboptimal.
10835 Use it to conform to a non-default application binary interface.
10837 @item -finstrument-functions
10838 @opindex finstrument-functions
10839 Generate instrumentation calls for entry and exit to functions. Just
10840 after function entry and just before function exit, the following
10841 profiling functions will be called with the address of the current
10842 function and its call site. (On some platforms,
10843 @code{__builtin_return_address} does not work beyond the current
10844 function, so the call site information may not be available to the
10845 profiling functions otherwise.)
10848 void __cyg_profile_func_enter (void *this_fn,
10850 void __cyg_profile_func_exit (void *this_fn,
10854 The first argument is the address of the start of the current function,
10855 which may be looked up exactly in the symbol table.
10857 This instrumentation is also done for functions expanded inline in other
10858 functions. The profiling calls will indicate where, conceptually, the
10859 inline function is entered and exited. This means that addressable
10860 versions of such functions must be available. If all your uses of a
10861 function are expanded inline, this may mean an additional expansion of
10862 code size. If you use @samp{extern inline} in your C code, an
10863 addressable version of such functions must be provided. (This is
10864 normally the case anyways, but if you get lucky and the optimizer always
10865 expands the functions inline, you might have gotten away without
10866 providing static copies.)
10868 A function may be given the attribute @code{no_instrument_function}, in
10869 which case this instrumentation will not be done. This can be used, for
10870 example, for the profiling functions listed above, high-priority
10871 interrupt routines, and any functions from which the profiling functions
10872 cannot safely be called (perhaps signal handlers, if the profiling
10873 routines generate output or allocate memory).
10875 @item -fstack-check
10876 @opindex fstack-check
10877 Generate code to verify that you do not go beyond the boundary of the
10878 stack. You should specify this flag if you are running in an
10879 environment with multiple threads, but only rarely need to specify it in
10880 a single-threaded environment since stack overflow is automatically
10881 detected on nearly all systems if there is only one stack.
10883 Note that this switch does not actually cause checking to be done; the
10884 operating system must do that. The switch causes generation of code
10885 to ensure that the operating system sees the stack being extended.
10887 @item -fstack-limit-register=@var{reg}
10888 @itemx -fstack-limit-symbol=@var{sym}
10889 @itemx -fno-stack-limit
10890 @opindex fstack-limit-register
10891 @opindex fstack-limit-symbol
10892 @opindex fno-stack-limit
10893 Generate code to ensure that the stack does not grow beyond a certain value,
10894 either the value of a register or the address of a symbol. If the stack
10895 would grow beyond the value, a signal is raised. For most targets,
10896 the signal is raised before the stack overruns the boundary, so
10897 it is possible to catch the signal without taking special precautions.
10899 For instance, if the stack starts at absolute address @samp{0x80000000}
10900 and grows downwards, you can use the flags
10901 @option{-fstack-limit-symbol=__stack_limit} and
10902 @option{-Wl,--defsym,__stack_limit=0x7ffe0000} to enforce a stack limit
10903 of 128KB@. Note that this may only work with the GNU linker.
10905 @cindex aliasing of parameters
10906 @cindex parameters, aliased
10907 @item -fargument-alias
10908 @itemx -fargument-noalias
10909 @itemx -fargument-noalias-global
10910 @opindex fargument-alias
10911 @opindex fargument-noalias
10912 @opindex fargument-noalias-global
10913 Specify the possible relationships among parameters and between
10914 parameters and global data.
10916 @option{-fargument-alias} specifies that arguments (parameters) may
10917 alias each other and may alias global storage.@*
10918 @option{-fargument-noalias} specifies that arguments do not alias
10919 each other, but may alias global storage.@*
10920 @option{-fargument-noalias-global} specifies that arguments do not
10921 alias each other and do not alias global storage.
10923 Each language will automatically use whatever option is required by
10924 the language standard. You should not need to use these options yourself.
10926 @item -fleading-underscore
10927 @opindex fleading-underscore
10928 This option and its counterpart, @option{-fno-leading-underscore}, forcibly
10929 change the way C symbols are represented in the object file. One use
10930 is to help link with legacy assembly code.
10932 @strong{Warning:} the @option{-fleading-underscore} switch causes GCC to
10933 generate code that is not binary compatible with code generated without that
10934 switch. Use it to conform to a non-default application binary interface.
10935 Not all targets provide complete support for this switch.
10937 @item -ftls-model=@var{model}
10938 Alter the thread-local storage model to be used (@pxref{Thread-Local}).
10939 The @var{model} argument should be one of @code{global-dynamic},
10940 @code{local-dynamic}, @code{initial-exec} or @code{local-exec}.
10942 The default without @option{-fpic} is @code{initial-exec}; with
10943 @option{-fpic} the default is @code{global-dynamic}.
10948 @node Environment Variables
10949 @section Environment Variables Affecting GCC
10950 @cindex environment variables
10952 @c man begin ENVIRONMENT
10954 This section describes several environment variables that affect how GCC
10955 operates. Some of them work by specifying directories or prefixes to use
10956 when searching for various kinds of files. Some are used to specify other
10957 aspects of the compilation environment.
10959 Note that you can also specify places to search using options such as
10960 @option{-B}, @option{-I} and @option{-L} (@pxref{Directory Options}). These
10961 take precedence over places specified using environment variables, which
10962 in turn take precedence over those specified by the configuration of GCC@.
10963 @xref{Driver,, Controlling the Compilation Driver @file{gcc}, gccint,
10964 GNU Compiler Collection (GCC) Internals}.
10969 @c @itemx LC_COLLATE
10971 @c @itemx LC_MONETARY
10972 @c @itemx LC_NUMERIC
10977 @c @findex LC_COLLATE
10978 @findex LC_MESSAGES
10979 @c @findex LC_MONETARY
10980 @c @findex LC_NUMERIC
10984 These environment variables control the way that GCC uses
10985 localization information that allow GCC to work with different
10986 national conventions. GCC inspects the locale categories
10987 @env{LC_CTYPE} and @env{LC_MESSAGES} if it has been configured to do
10988 so. These locale categories can be set to any value supported by your
10989 installation. A typical value is @samp{en_UK} for English in the United
10992 The @env{LC_CTYPE} environment variable specifies character
10993 classification. GCC uses it to determine the character boundaries in
10994 a string; this is needed for some multibyte encodings that contain quote
10995 and escape characters that would otherwise be interpreted as a string
10998 The @env{LC_MESSAGES} environment variable specifies the language to
10999 use in diagnostic messages.
11001 If the @env{LC_ALL} environment variable is set, it overrides the value
11002 of @env{LC_CTYPE} and @env{LC_MESSAGES}; otherwise, @env{LC_CTYPE}
11003 and @env{LC_MESSAGES} default to the value of the @env{LANG}
11004 environment variable. If none of these variables are set, GCC
11005 defaults to traditional C English behavior.
11009 If @env{TMPDIR} is set, it specifies the directory to use for temporary
11010 files. GCC uses temporary files to hold the output of one stage of
11011 compilation which is to be used as input to the next stage: for example,
11012 the output of the preprocessor, which is the input to the compiler
11015 @item GCC_EXEC_PREFIX
11016 @findex GCC_EXEC_PREFIX
11017 If @env{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} is set, it specifies a prefix to use in the
11018 names of the subprograms executed by the compiler. No slash is added
11019 when this prefix is combined with the name of a subprogram, but you can
11020 specify a prefix that ends with a slash if you wish.
11022 If @env{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} is not set, GCC will attempt to figure out
11023 an appropriate prefix to use based on the pathname it was invoked with.
11025 If GCC cannot find the subprogram using the specified prefix, it
11026 tries looking in the usual places for the subprogram.
11028 The default value of @env{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} is
11029 @file{@var{prefix}/lib/gcc-lib/} where @var{prefix} is the value
11030 of @code{prefix} when you ran the @file{configure} script.
11032 Other prefixes specified with @option{-B} take precedence over this prefix.
11034 This prefix is also used for finding files such as @file{crt0.o} that are
11037 In addition, the prefix is used in an unusual way in finding the
11038 directories to search for header files. For each of the standard
11039 directories whose name normally begins with @samp{/usr/local/lib/gcc-lib}
11040 (more precisely, with the value of @env{GCC_INCLUDE_DIR}), GCC tries
11041 replacing that beginning with the specified prefix to produce an
11042 alternate directory name. Thus, with @option{-Bfoo/}, GCC will search
11043 @file{foo/bar} where it would normally search @file{/usr/local/lib/bar}.
11044 These alternate directories are searched first; the standard directories
11047 @item COMPILER_PATH
11048 @findex COMPILER_PATH
11049 The value of @env{COMPILER_PATH} is a colon-separated list of
11050 directories, much like @env{PATH}. GCC tries the directories thus
11051 specified when searching for subprograms, if it can't find the
11052 subprograms using @env{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX}.
11055 @findex LIBRARY_PATH
11056 The value of @env{LIBRARY_PATH} is a colon-separated list of
11057 directories, much like @env{PATH}. When configured as a native compiler,
11058 GCC tries the directories thus specified when searching for special
11059 linker files, if it can't find them using @env{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX}. Linking
11060 using GCC also uses these directories when searching for ordinary
11061 libraries for the @option{-l} option (but directories specified with
11062 @option{-L} come first).
11066 @cindex locale definition
11067 This variable is used to pass locale information to the compiler. One way in
11068 which this information is used is to determine the character set to be used
11069 when character literals, string literals and comments are parsed in C and C++.
11070 When the compiler is configured to allow multibyte characters,
11071 the following values for @env{LANG} are recognized:
11075 Recognize JIS characters.
11077 Recognize SJIS characters.
11079 Recognize EUCJP characters.
11082 If @env{LANG} is not defined, or if it has some other value, then the
11083 compiler will use mblen and mbtowc as defined by the default locale to
11084 recognize and translate multibyte characters.
11088 Some additional environments variables affect the behavior of the
11091 @include cppenv.texi
11095 @node Precompiled Headers
11096 @section Using Precompiled Headers
11097 @cindex precompiled headers
11098 @cindex speed of compilation
11100 Often large projects have many header files that are included in every
11101 source file. The time the compiler takes to process these header files
11102 over and over again can account for nearly all of the time required to
11103 build the project. To make builds faster, GCC allows users to
11104 `precompile' a header file; then, if builds can use the precompiled
11105 header file they will be much faster.
11107 To create a precompiled header file, simply compile it as you would any
11108 other file, if necessary using the @option{-x} option to make the driver
11109 treat it as a C or C++ header file. You will probably want to use a
11110 tool like @command{make} to keep the precompiled header up-to-date when
11111 the headers it contains change.
11113 A precompiled header file will be searched for when @code{#include} is
11114 seen in the compilation. As it searches for the included file
11115 (@pxref{Search Path,,Search Path,cpp.info,The C Preprocessor}) the
11116 compiler looks for a precompiled header in each directory just before it
11117 looks for the include file in that directory. The name searched for is
11118 the name specified in the @code{#include} with @samp{.pch} appended. If
11119 the precompiled header file can't be used, it is ignored.
11121 For instance, if you have @code{#include "all.h"}, and you have
11122 @file{all.h.pch} in the same directory as @file{all.h}, then the
11123 precompiled header file will be used if possible, and the original
11124 header will be used otherwise.
11126 Alternatively, you might decide to put the precompiled header file in a
11127 directory and use @option{-I} to ensure that directory is searched
11128 before (or instead of) the directory containing the original header.
11129 Then, if you want to check that the precompiled header file is always
11130 used, you can put a file of the same name as the original header in this
11131 directory containing an @code{#error} command.
11133 This also works with @option{-include}. So yet another way to use
11134 precompiled headers, good for projects not designed with precompiled
11135 header files in mind, is to simply take most of the header files used by
11136 a project, include them from another header file, precompile that header
11137 file, and @option{-include} the precompiled header. If the header files
11138 have guards against multiple inclusion, they will be skipped because
11139 they've already been included (in the precompiled header).
11141 If you need to precompile the same header file for different
11142 languages, targets, or compiler options, you can instead make a
11143 @emph{directory} named like @file{all.h.pch}, and put each precompiled
11144 header in the directory. (It doesn't matter what you call the files
11145 in the directory, every precompiled header in the directory will be
11146 considered.) The first precompiled header encountered in the
11147 directory that is valid for this compilation will be used; they're
11148 searched in no particular order.
11150 There are many other possibilities, limited only by your imagination,
11151 good sense, and the constraints of your build system.
11153 A precompiled header file can be used only when these conditions apply:
11157 Only one precompiled header can be used in a particular compilation.
11159 A precompiled header can't be used once the first C token is seen. You
11160 can have preprocessor directives before a precompiled header; you can
11161 even include a precompiled header from inside another header, so long as
11162 there are no C tokens before the @code{#include}.
11164 The precompiled header file must be produced for the same language as
11165 the current compilation. You can't use a C precompiled header for a C++
11168 The precompiled header file must be produced by the same compiler
11169 version and configuration as the current compilation is using.
11170 The easiest way to guarantee this is to use the same compiler binary
11171 for creating and using precompiled headers.
11173 Any macros defined before the precompiled header (including with
11174 @option{-D}) must either be defined in the same way as when the
11175 precompiled header was generated, or must not affect the precompiled
11176 header, which usually means that the they don't appear in the
11177 precompiled header at all.
11179 Certain command-line options must be defined in the same way as when the
11180 precompiled header was generated. At present, it's not clear which
11181 options are safe to change and which are not; the safest choice is to
11182 use exactly the same options when generating and using the precompiled
11186 For all of these but the last, the compiler will automatically ignore
11187 the precompiled header if the conditions aren't met. For the last item,
11188 some option changes will cause the precompiled header to be rejected,
11189 but not all incompatible option combinations have yet been found. If
11190 you find a new incompatible combination, please consider filing a bug
11191 report, see @ref{Bugs}.
11193 @node Running Protoize
11194 @section Running Protoize
11196 The program @code{protoize} is an optional part of GCC@. You can use
11197 it to add prototypes to a program, thus converting the program to ISO
11198 C in one respect. The companion program @code{unprotoize} does the
11199 reverse: it removes argument types from any prototypes that are found.
11201 When you run these programs, you must specify a set of source files as
11202 command line arguments. The conversion programs start out by compiling
11203 these files to see what functions they define. The information gathered
11204 about a file @var{foo} is saved in a file named @file{@var{foo}.X}.
11206 After scanning comes actual conversion. The specified files are all
11207 eligible to be converted; any files they include (whether sources or
11208 just headers) are eligible as well.
11210 But not all the eligible files are converted. By default,
11211 @code{protoize} and @code{unprotoize} convert only source and header
11212 files in the current directory. You can specify additional directories
11213 whose files should be converted with the @option{-d @var{directory}}
11214 option. You can also specify particular files to exclude with the
11215 @option{-x @var{file}} option. A file is converted if it is eligible, its
11216 directory name matches one of the specified directory names, and its
11217 name within the directory has not been excluded.
11219 Basic conversion with @code{protoize} consists of rewriting most
11220 function definitions and function declarations to specify the types of
11221 the arguments. The only ones not rewritten are those for varargs
11224 @code{protoize} optionally inserts prototype declarations at the
11225 beginning of the source file, to make them available for any calls that
11226 precede the function's definition. Or it can insert prototype
11227 declarations with block scope in the blocks where undeclared functions
11230 Basic conversion with @code{unprotoize} consists of rewriting most
11231 function declarations to remove any argument types, and rewriting
11232 function definitions to the old-style pre-ISO form.
11234 Both conversion programs print a warning for any function declaration or
11235 definition that they can't convert. You can suppress these warnings
11238 The output from @code{protoize} or @code{unprotoize} replaces the
11239 original source file. The original file is renamed to a name ending
11240 with @samp{.save} (for DOS, the saved filename ends in @samp{.sav}
11241 without the original @samp{.c} suffix). If the @samp{.save} (@samp{.sav}
11242 for DOS) file already exists, then the source file is simply discarded.
11244 @code{protoize} and @code{unprotoize} both depend on GCC itself to
11245 scan the program and collect information about the functions it uses.
11246 So neither of these programs will work until GCC is installed.
11248 Here is a table of the options you can use with @code{protoize} and
11249 @code{unprotoize}. Each option works with both programs unless
11253 @item -B @var{directory}
11254 Look for the file @file{SYSCALLS.c.X} in @var{directory}, instead of the
11255 usual directory (normally @file{/usr/local/lib}). This file contains
11256 prototype information about standard system functions. This option
11257 applies only to @code{protoize}.
11259 @item -c @var{compilation-options}
11260 Use @var{compilation-options} as the options when running @command{gcc} to
11261 produce the @samp{.X} files. The special option @option{-aux-info} is
11262 always passed in addition, to tell @command{gcc} to write a @samp{.X} file.
11264 Note that the compilation options must be given as a single argument to
11265 @code{protoize} or @code{unprotoize}. If you want to specify several
11266 @command{gcc} options, you must quote the entire set of compilation options
11267 to make them a single word in the shell.
11269 There are certain @command{gcc} arguments that you cannot use, because they
11270 would produce the wrong kind of output. These include @option{-g},
11271 @option{-O}, @option{-c}, @option{-S}, and @option{-o} If you include these in
11272 the @var{compilation-options}, they are ignored.
11275 Rename files to end in @samp{.C} (@samp{.cc} for DOS-based file
11276 systems) instead of @samp{.c}. This is convenient if you are converting
11277 a C program to C++. This option applies only to @code{protoize}.
11280 Add explicit global declarations. This means inserting explicit
11281 declarations at the beginning of each source file for each function
11282 that is called in the file and was not declared. These declarations
11283 precede the first function definition that contains a call to an
11284 undeclared function. This option applies only to @code{protoize}.
11286 @item -i @var{string}
11287 Indent old-style parameter declarations with the string @var{string}.
11288 This option applies only to @code{protoize}.
11290 @code{unprotoize} converts prototyped function definitions to old-style
11291 function definitions, where the arguments are declared between the
11292 argument list and the initial @samp{@{}. By default, @code{unprotoize}
11293 uses five spaces as the indentation. If you want to indent with just
11294 one space instead, use @option{-i " "}.
11297 Keep the @samp{.X} files. Normally, they are deleted after conversion
11301 Add explicit local declarations. @code{protoize} with @option{-l} inserts
11302 a prototype declaration for each function in each block which calls the
11303 function without any declaration. This option applies only to
11307 Make no real changes. This mode just prints information about the conversions
11308 that would have been done without @option{-n}.
11311 Make no @samp{.save} files. The original files are simply deleted.
11312 Use this option with caution.
11314 @item -p @var{program}
11315 Use the program @var{program} as the compiler. Normally, the name
11316 @file{gcc} is used.
11319 Work quietly. Most warnings are suppressed.
11322 Print the version number, just like @option{-v} for @command{gcc}.
11325 If you need special compiler options to compile one of your program's
11326 source files, then you should generate that file's @samp{.X} file
11327 specially, by running @command{gcc} on that source file with the
11328 appropriate options and the option @option{-aux-info}. Then run
11329 @code{protoize} on the entire set of files. @code{protoize} will use
11330 the existing @samp{.X} file because it is newer than the source file.
11334 gcc -Dfoo=bar file1.c -aux-info file1.X
11339 You need to include the special files along with the rest in the
11340 @code{protoize} command, even though their @samp{.X} files already
11341 exist, because otherwise they won't get converted.
11343 @xref{Protoize Caveats}, for more information on how to use
11344 @code{protoize} successfully.